M16C/6K9 Group REJ03B0041-0100Z Rev.1.00 2003.06.06 SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER Description Description The M16C/6K9 group of single-chip microcomputers are built using the high-performance silicon gate CMOS process using a M16C/60 Series CPU core and are packaged in a 144-pin plastic molded QFP. These single-chip microcomputers operate using sophisticated instructions featuring a high level of instruction efficiency. To communicate with host CPU, the LPC bus interface is built in. In this way, this MCU can work as slave controller in the personal computer system. The specification is target oriented specification for the development of M16C/6K9. Features • Memory capacity .................................... ROM (See Figure AA-4 ROM Expansion) RAM 3K to 5K bytes • The Min. time of instruction execution ... 62.5ns (f(XIN)=16MHz, with 0 wait, Vcc=3.3V) • Supply voltage ....................................... 3.0 to 3.6V (f(XIN)=8MHZ with 0 wait) • Supply voltage for Program/Erase ......... 3.0 to 3.6V (CPU reprogram mode, f(XIN)=16MHZ with 1 wait) • Low power consumption ........................ 52.8mW ( f(XIN)=16MHZ, with 0 wait, VCC = 3.3V) • Interrupts ................................................ 38 internal and 16 external interrupt sources, 4 software interrupt sources; 7 levels (including key input interrupt) • Key input interrupts .................................. 2 (8 inputs shared with1 interrupt request X 1; 8 inputs (with event latch) shared with1 interrupt request X 1) • Multifunction 16-bit timer ........................ 5 output timers + 6 input timers • Serial I/O ................................................ 5 channels (3 for UART or clock synchronous, 2 for clock synchronous) • DMAC .................................................... 2 channels • Host interface ......................................... LPC bus interface X 4 • A-D converter ......................................... 10 bits X 8 channels (Expandable up to 10 channels) • D-A converter ......................................... 8 bits X 2 channels • Comparator circuit ................................. 8 channels • PWM ...................................................... 8 bits X 6 channels • Watchdog timer ...................................... 1 • I2C bus interface .................................... 3 channels : M306K9FCLRP, 2 channels : M306K9F8LRP • PS/2 interface ........................................ 3 channels • Serial interrupt output ............................ 6 factors (2 fixed factors, 4 programmable factors) • Programmable I/O ................................. 129 _______ • Input port ................................................ 1 (P85 shared with NMI pin) • Clock generating circuit ......................... 2 built-in clock generation circuits (built-in feedback resistor, and external ceramic) Specifications written in this manual are believed to be accurate, but are not guaranteed to be entirely free of error. Specifications in this data sheet may be changed for functional or performance improvements. Please make sure your manual is the latest edition. Applications Notebook PC, others Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 1 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Description ------Table of Contents-----Central Processing Unit (CPU) ..................... 14 Reset ............................................................. 17 Processor Mode ............................................ 27 Clock Generating Circuit ............................... 30 Protection ...................................................... 39 Interrupts ....................................................... 40 Watchdog Timer ............................................ 68 DMAC ........................................................... 70 Timer ............................................................. 79 Serial I/O ....................................................... 97 A-D Converter ............................................. 131 D-A Converter ............................................. 141 Comparator Circuit ...................................... 143 PWM Output Circuit .................................... 145 LPC Bus Interface ....................................... 149 Serial interrupt output .................................. 167 MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface ............ 178 PS2 Interface .............................................. 209 Programmable I/O Ports ............................. 224 Electrical Characteristics ............................. 246 Flash Memory Version ................................ 259 Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 2 of 290 Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 3 of 290 Flash memory recognition register After reset 000000002 Vcc Not exist Not exist 129 Port 0 - Port 16 2 channels 8 inputs shared with 1 interrupt request X 1 8 inputs (with event latch) shared with 1 interrupt request X 1 Detected only in the falling edge Can not be selected with 1 bit unit Flash memory control register After reset XXXX00012 Flash memory control register After reset 000000002 Vcc 3.0 - 3.6V M2 pin 4.5 - 5.25V The input pin of power supply for program/erase Not exist 128 Port 0 - Port 16 without P84 3.3V/5V Exist Exist 14-bit X 4 2 channels 8 inputs shared with 1 interrupt request X 1 8 inputs (with event latch) shared with 1 interrupt request X 1 Detected only in the falling edge Can not be selected with 1 bit unit Not Exist Address 03B416 Address 03B716 After reset 000000002 The power supply for program/erase M2 pin FVCC pin Programmable I/O The I/O voltage in P2, P3 Programmable I/O ports ISA bus interface Serial interrupt output & LPC bus interface PWM output circuit I2C bus interface Key input interrupt Timer B TB2IN Exist 8 inputs shared with 1 interrupt request X 1 8 inputs (with event latch) shared with 1 interrupt request X 1 Detected in either of the edges by the dege selection Can be selected with 1 bit unit 3 channels 8-bit X 6 Exist Not Exist 3.3V Exist 8 inputs shared with 1 interrupt request X 1 8 inputs (with event latch) shared with 1 interrupt request X 1 Detected in either of the edges by the dege selection Can be selected with 1 bit unit 2 channels 8-bit X 6 Exist Not Exist 3.3V 129 Port 0 - Port 16 The input pin of power supply for program/erase The input pin of power supply for program/erase 129 Port 0 - Port 16 Not exist Vcc 3.0 - 3.6V FVCC 3.0 - 3.6V Flash memory control register After reset 000000012 Flash memory recognition register After reset XXXXXX102 Not exist Vcc 3.0 - 3.6V FVCC 3.0 - 3.6V Flash memory control register After reset 000000012 Flash memory recognition register After reset XXXXXX102 User ROM area Address 0F000016 - 0FFFFF16 Boot ROM area Address 0FF00016 - 0FFFFF16 NEW DINOR Flash memory 64K bytes 3K bytes 144-pin M306K9F8LRP(Under development) Note 1 : Timer B TB2IN refers to the count source input and pulse period measurement in event count mode/pulse input in pulse width measurement mode. Exist 14-bit X 4 Exist Not Exist 3.3V 3.0 - 3.6V Flash memory control register After reset XX0000012 User ROM area Address 0E000016 - 0FFFFF16 Boot ROM area Address 0FF00016 - 0FFFFF16 User ROM area Address 0EF00016 - 0FFFFF16 Boot ROM area Address 0FF00016 - 0FFFFF16 User ROM area Address 0E800016 - 0F5FFF16 Address 0FE00016 - 0FFFFF16 Boot ROM area In parallel I/O mode Address 0FE0016 - 0FFFFF16 In CPU reprogram mode & standard serial I/O mode Address 0DE00016 - 0DFFFF16 Built-in ROM area NEW DINOR Flash memory 128K bytes NEW DINOR Flash memory 68K bytes NEW DINOR Flash memory 64K bytes ROM 5K bytes 3K bytes 3K bytes 144-pin M306K9FCLRP(In mass production) RAM 144-pin M306K7F8LRP(In mass production) 144-pin M306K5F8LRP(In mass production) Pin numbers Type name The differences in M16C/6K group M16C/6K9 Group Description M16C/6K9 Group Description Pin configuration Fig. AA-1 shows the pin configuration (top view). P10/CTS01/RTS01 P126 P125/INT111 P124/INT102 P123/INT92 P122/INT82 P121/INT72 P120/INT61 P07 P06 P05 P04 P03 P02 P01 P00 P117 P116 P115 P114 P113 P112 P111/F1OUT1 P110/F1OUT0 P107/AN7/INT110 P106/AN6/INT100 P105/AN5/INT90 P104/AN4/INT80 P103/AN3/INT70 P102/AN2 P101/AN1 AVSS P100/AN0 VREF AVcc P97/ADTRG/SIN40/INT60 82 81 80 79 78 77 76 75 74 73 84 83 95 94 93 92 91 90 89 88 87 86 85 108 107 106 105 104 103 102 101 100 99 98 97 96 P11/CLK01 P12/RXD01 P13/TXD01 P14/INT71/CTS11/RTS11/CTS01/CLKS11 P15/INT81/CLK11 P16/INT91/RXD11 P17/INT101/TXD11 P20/TXD21 P21/RXD21 P22/CLK21 P23/CTS21/RTS21 P24 P25 P26 P27 VSS P30/LAD0 VCC P127 P31/LAD1 P32/LAD2 P33/LAD3 P34/LFRAME P35/LRESET P36/LCLK P37 P130 P131 P132 P133 P134 P135 P136 P137 P40/ TA00OUT/OBF00/PWM41 P41/TA10OUT/PWM51 PIN CONFIGURATION (top view) 109 111 112 113 72 71 70 69 68 114 115 67 66 116 117 118 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 110 119 120 121 122 123 124 125 M306K9FCLRP 126 127 128 129 130 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 136 137 138 139 140 40 39 141 142 143 38 37 144 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 P96/ANEX1/SOUT40/PWM30 P95/ANEX0/CLK40/PWM20 P94/DA1/TB40IN/PWM10 P93/DA0/TB30IN/PWM00 P92/SOUT30/INT5 P91/SIN30/INT4 P90/CLK30/INT3 P161/TB41IN/PWM50 P160/TB31IN/PWM40 P157/SIN41 P156/SOUT41 P155/CLK41 P154 P153 M1 M0 P87/XCIN P86/XCOUT RESET XOUT VSS XIN VCC P85/NMI P84/TB2IN P83/TB1IN P82/TB0IN P81/TA4IN P80/ICCK P77/TA3IN/SCL2 P76/SDA2 P75/TA2IN/INT2/PS2B2 P74/INT1/PS2B1 P73/CTS20/RTS20/TA1IN/INT0/PS2B0 P72/CLK20/PS2A2 P71/RXD20/TA0IN/TB5IN/PS2A1 2 3 4 5 Fig. AA-1 Pin configuration (top view) Jun 06, 2003 53 52 51 131 132 133 134 135 1 Rev.1.00 56 55 54 P42/TA20OUT/GATEA20 P43/OBF01/SERIRQ P44/PWM01/OBF1 P45/PWM11/OBF2/PRST P46/PWM21/OBF3/CLKRUN FVCC P47/PWM31 VSS P140/KI10 P141/KI11 P142/KI12 P143/KI13 P144/KI14 P145/KI15 P146/KI16 P147/KI17 P50/KI00 P51/KI01 P52/KI02 P53/KI03 P54/KI04 P55/KI05 P56/KI06 P57 /CLKOUT/KI07 P150/TA01OUT/CLK31 P151/TA11OUT/SIN31 P152/TA21OUT/SOUT31 P60/CTS00/RTS00/SDA0 P61/CLK00/SCL0 P62/RXD00/SDA1 P63/TXD00/SCL1 P64/CTS10/RTS10/CTS00/CLKS10 P65/CLK10 P66/RXD10/TA3OUT P67/TXD10/TA4OUT P70/TXD20/PS2A0 page 4 of 290 Package: 144PFB-A M16C/6K9 Group Description Pin configuration Fig. AA-2 shows the pin configuration (top view). P10/CTS01/RTS01 P126 P125/INT111 P124/INT102 P123/INT92 P122/INT82 P121/INT72 P120/INT61 P07 P06 P05 P04 P03 P02 P01 P00 P117 P116 P115 P114 P113 P112 P111/F1OUT1 P110/F1OUT0 P107/AN7/INT110 P106/AN6/INT100 P105/AN5/INT90 P104/AN4/INT80 P103/AN3/INT70 P102/AN2 P101/AN1 AVSS P100/AN0 VREF AVcc P97/ADTRG/SIN40/INT60 82 81 80 79 78 77 76 75 74 73 84 83 95 94 93 92 91 90 89 88 87 86 85 108 107 106 105 104 103 102 101 100 99 98 97 96 P11/CLK01 P12/RXD01 P13/TXD01 P14/INT71/CTS11/RTS11/CTS01/CLKS11 P15/INT81/CLK11 P16/INT91/RXD11 P17/INT101/TXD11 P20/TXD21 P21/RXD21 P22/CLK21 P23/CTS21/RTS21 P24 P25 P26 P27 VSS P30/LAD0 VCC P127 P31/LAD1 P32/LAD2 P33/LAD3 P34/LFRAME P35/LRESET P36/LCLK P37 P130 P131 P132 P133 P134 P135 P136 P137 P40/ TA00OUT/OBF00/PWM41 P41/TA10OUT/PWM51 PIN CONFIGURATION (top view) 109 111 112 113 72 71 70 69 68 114 115 67 66 116 117 118 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 110 119 120 121 122 123 124 125 M306K9F8LRP 126 127 128 129 130 56 55 54 53 52 51 131 50 49 132 133 48 134 135 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 136 137 138 139 140 40 39 141 142 143 38 37 144 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 P96/ANEX1/SOUT40/PWM30 P95/ANEX0/CLK40/PWM20 P94/DA1/TB40IN/PWM10 P93/DA0/TB30IN/PWM00 P92/SOUT30/INT5 P91/SIN30/INT4 P90/CLK30/INT3 P161/TB41IN/PWM50 P160/TB31IN/PWM40 P157/SIN41 P156/SOUT41 P155/CLK41 P154 P153 M1 M0 P87/XCIN P86/XCOUT RESET XOUT VSS XIN VCC P85/NMI P84/TB2IN P83/TB1IN P82/TB0IN P81/TA4IN P80/ICCK P77/TA3IN P76 P75/TA2IN/INT2/PS2B2 P74/INT1/PS2B1 P73/CTS20/RTS20/TA1IN/INT0/PS2B0 P72/CLK20/PS2A2 P71/RXD20/TA0IN/TB5IN/PS2A1 1 P42/TA20OUT/GATEA20 P43/OBF01/SERIRQ P44/PWM01/OBF1 P45/PWM11/OBF2/PRST P46/PWM21/OBF3/CLKRUN FVCC P47/PWM31 VSS P140/KI10 P141/KI11 P142/KI12 P143/KI13 P144/KI14 P145/KI15 P146/KI16 P147/KI17 P50/KI00 P51/KI01 P52/KI02 P53/KI03 P54/KI04 P55/KI05 P56/KI06 P57 /CLKOUT/KI07 P150/TA01OUT/CLK31 P151/TA11OUT/SIN31 P152/TA21OUT/SOUT31 P60/CTS00/RTS00/SDA0 P61/CLK00/SCL0 P62/RXD00/SDA1 P63/TXD00/SCL1 P64/CTS10/RTS10/CTS00/CLKS10 P65/CLK10 P66/RXD10/TA3OUT P67/TXD10/TA4OUT P70/TXD20/PS2A0 Package: 144PFB-A Fig. AA-2 Pin configuration (top view) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 5 of 290 Description M16C/6K9 Group Block Diagram Fig.AA-3 is a block diagram of the M16C/6K9 (144-pin version) group. 8 I/O ports 8 Port P0 Port P1 8 8 Port P2 8 Port P3 Port P4 Clock synchronous SI/O (8 bits x 2channels) Comparator (8 channels) I C bus interface (Note 3) Host interface (LPC bus interface x 4 channels) PWM output (8 bits x 6channels) 2 INTB Flag register FLG Port P14 Port P13 8 8 Note1 : ROM size depends on MCU type. Note2 : RAM size depends on MCU type. Note3 : A number of channels depends on MCU type. Fig.AA-3 Block diagram of M16C/6K9 (144-pin version) group Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 6 of 290 AAAA AAAA Multiplier Port P12 8 Port P11 8 8 8 RAM (Note2) Vector table SB Port P15 2 ISP USP ROM (Note1) 8 Serial interrupt output (6 factors) Stack pointer Port P10 PS2 interface (3 channels) Port P16 PC R0H R0 R0H R0L R1H LR1 R1H R1L R L R2 R 2 R3 A 3 A0 A 0 A1 F 1B FB D-A converter (8 bits x 2channels) Memory Program counter Registers Port P9 M16C/60 series 16-bit CPU core Port P85 Watchdog timer (15 bits) DMAC (2 channels) 7 UART/clock synchronous SI/O (8 bits x 3 channels) 8 XIN-XOUT XCIN-XCOUT Port P6 Port P8 System clock generator A-D converter (10 bits x 8 channels Expandable up to 10 channels) Timer TA0(16 bits) Timer TA1(16 bits) Timer TA2(16 bits) Timer TA3(16 bits) Timer TA4(16 bits) Timer TB0(16 bits) Timer TB1(16 bits) Timer TB2(16 bits) Timer TB3(16 bits) Timer TB4(16 bits) Timer TB5(16 bits) Port P5 8 Port P7 Internal peripheral function Timer 8 Description M16C/6K9 Group Performance Outline Table AA-1 is a performance outline of M16C/6K9 (144-pin version) group. Table AA-1 Performance outline of M16C/6K9 (144-pin version) group Item Performance Number of basic instructions 91 instructions The Min. time of instruction execution 62.5ns (f(XIN)=16MHz, with 0 wait, Vcc=3.3V) Memory ROM (See the figure of ROM Expansion) capacity RAM 3K to 5K bytes I/O port P0 to P10 (except P85) 8 bits x 10, 7 bits x 1 P11 to P16 8 bitsx5, 2 bitsx1 Input port P85 1 bit x 1 Multifunction TA0, TA1, TA2, TA3, TA4 16 bits x 5 timer TB0, TB1, TB2, TB3, TB4, TB5 16 bits x 6 Serial I/O UART0, UART1, UART2 (UART or clock synchronous) x 3 SI/O3, SI/O4 A-D converter D-A converter DMAC Watchdog timer Interrupt Host interface Comparator circuit PWM I2C bus interface PS2 interface Serial interrupt output Clock generating circuit (Clock synchronous) x 2 10 bits x (8 + 2) channels 8 bits x 2 2 channels (trigger: 24 sources) 15 bits x 1 (with prescaler) 38 internal and 16 external sources, 4 software sources, 7 levels 4 channels (LPC bus interface) 8 channels 8 bits x 6 3 channels : M306K9FCLRP, 2 channels : M306K9F8LRP 3 channels 6 factors (2 fixed factors, 4 programmable factors) 2 built-in clock generation circuits (built-in feedback resistor, and external ceramic) Program/erase supply voltage Power consumption I/O I/O withstand voltage characteristics Output current Device configuration Package Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 7 of 290 3.0 to 3.6V (CPU reprogram mode, f(XIN)=16MHz with 1 wait) 52.8mW (3.3V, f(XIN)=16MHz, with 0 wait) 3.3V 5mA CMOS high performance silicon gate 144-pin plastic mold QFP M16C/6K9 Group Description Renesas plans to release the following products in the M16C/6K9 (144-pin version) group: (1) Support for flash memory version (2) ROM capacity (3) Package 144PFB-A : Plastic molded QFP(flash memory version) ROM Size (Byte) External ROM 256K M306K9FCLRP 128K 96K 80K M306K9F8LRP 64K 32K Mask ROM version Flash version Fig.AA-4 ROM expansion Table AA-2 Product list Type No. M306K9FCLRP M306K9F8LRP** ROM size RAM size Jun 06, 2003 Package type I2C bus Interface Remarks 128K bytes 5K bytes 144PFB-A 3 channels Flash memory (NEW DINOR) version 64K bytes 3K bytes 144PFB-A 2 channels Flash memory (NEW DINOR) version **: Under development Rev.1.00 From June 2003 up to now page 8 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Description Type No. M30 6K 9 M 8 XXX RP Package type RP : 144PFB-A ROM No. ROM type 8 : 64Kbytes C : 128Kbytes Memory type M : Mask ROM version F : Flash version Shows RAM capacity, pin count, etc (The value itself has no specific maeaning) M16C/6K Group M16C Family Fig.AA-5 Type No., memory size, and package Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 9 of 290 Pin Description M16C/6K9 Group Pin Description Pin name Signal name I/O type Vcc, Vss Power supply input ____________ RESET Reset input Input XIN Clock input Input XOUT Clock output Output M0,M1 P00 to P07 Chip mode Input setting Power supply input for flash memory programming Analog power supply input Analog power supply input Reference Input voltage input I/O port P0 Input/output P10 to P17 I/O port P1 Input/output P20 to P27 I/O port P2 Input/output P30 to P37 I/O port P3 Input/output P40 to P47 I/O port P4 Input/output P50 to P57 I/O port P5 Input/output FVCC AVCC AVSS VREF Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 10 of 290 Function Apply 3.0 to 3.6 V to VCC . Apply 0V to VSS A “L” on this input resets the microcomputer. These pins are provided for the main clock generating circuit. Connect a ceramic resonator or crystal between the XIN and the XOUT pins. To use an externally derived clock, input it to the XIN pin and leave the XOUT pin open. Connect to VSS This pin is a power supply input for on-chip flash memory programming. During the normal operation, 0V to 3.6V can be applied. When programming on-chip flash memory, 3.0V to 3.6V should be applied. This pin is a power supply input for the A-D converter. Connect this pin to VCC. This pin is a power supply input for the A-D converter. Connect this pin to VSS. This pin is a reference voltage input for the A-D converter. This is an 8-bit CMOS I/O port. It has an input/output port direction register that allows the user to set each pin for input or output individually. When set for input, the user can specify in units of four bits via software whether or not they are tied to a pull-up resistor. This port supports CMOS input level. And output type supports CMOS 3 state or N channel open drain selectable. This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. Pins in this port also function as external interrupt pins as selected by software. This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that output type just supports CMOS 3 state only). P20-P27 are available for directly driving LED's.P20 to P24 also function as UART2 or SI/O pins as selected by software. This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that output type just supports CMOS 3 state only). The port can be used for LPC bus interface I/O pins by software selection. This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that output type just supports CMOS 3 state only). By software selecting, the port can also be used for LPC bus interface I/O pins, Timer A0 to A2 output pins PWM output pins or serial interrupt output I/O pins. P40 to P46 pins' level can be read regardless the setting of input port or output port. If P40 or P43 are used for output ports, the function that clears P40 or P43 to "0" after the read of output data buffer from host CPU is available. This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that output type is CMOS 3 state only). Key on wake interrupt 0 and comparator input function support. P57 in this port outputs a divide-by-8 or divide-by-32 clock of XIN or a clock of the same frequency as XCIN as selected by software. Pin Description M16C/6K9 Group Pin Description Pin name Signal name I/O type Function P60 to P67 I/O port P6 Input/output This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that P60 to P63's output type is N channel open drain only; P64 to P67's output type is CMOS 3 state only; P60 to P63 no internal pull-up registor support.) By software selecting, this port can be used for I2C-BUS interface, UART0/UART1 input/ output pin, timerA3,A4 output pin. When P60 to P63 used as I2C-BUS interface SDA,SCL, the input level of these pins are CMOS/SMBUS selectable. P70 to P77 I/O port P7 Input/output This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that P70 to P77 output type is N channel open drain only; no internal pull-up registor support.) By software selecting, this port can be used for external interrupt input pin, timerA0 to A3 and timer B5 input pin, PS2 interface input/output pin, I2C interface (M306K9FCLRP only) or UART2 input/output pin. P70 to P75 pins' level can be read regardless of the setting of input port or output port. P80 to P84, P86, P87, P85 I/O port P8 Input/output Input/output Input/output Input P90 to P97 I/O port P9 P100 to P107 I/O port P10 Rev.1.00 I/O port P85 Jun 06, 2003 P80 to P84, P86, and P87 are I/O ports with the same functions as P0. (Except that P86 to P87's output type is CMOS 3 state only; P80 to P84's output type is N channel open drain only; P85 is input port only; the P80 to P84 and P85 are no internal pull-up registor support.) By software selecting, this port can be used for timer A4, B0 to B2, I2C-BUS interface I/O pins. P86 and P87 can be set using software to function as the I/O pins for a sub clock generation circuit. In this case, connect a quartz oscillator between P86 (XCOUT pin) and P8 7 (XCIN pin). P85 is an input-only port that ______ ______ also functions for NMI. The NMI interrupt is generated when ______ the input at this pin changes from “H” to “L”. The NMI function cannot be cancelled using software. Input/output This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that output type is CMOS 3 state only.) By software selecting, the port can be used for external interrupt, timer B3 to B4, A-D converter extended input pins, A-D trigger, SI/O3, SI/O4 I/O pins, PWM, D-A converter output pins. Input/output This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that output type is CMOS 3 state only.) If the ports are set to input mode, the pull-up resistor can be set in bit unit. By software selecting, the port can be used for A-D converter, external interrupt input pins. page 11 of 290 Pin Description M16C/6K9 Group Pin Description Pin name Signal name I/O type Function P110 to P117 I/O port P11 Input/output This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. By software selecting, P110, P111 also function as clock output pins, which the frequency is the same with XIN (XCIN). P120 to P127 I/O port P12 Input/output This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that output type is CMOS 3 state only.) By software selecting, this port can be used for external interrupt input pin. P130 to P137 I/O port P13 Input/output This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that output type is N channel open drain only; no internal pull-up registor support.) P140 to P147 I/O port P14 P150 to P157 I/O port P15 P160, P161 I/O port P16 Input/output This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. The port can be used for key on wake-up interrupt 1 input pins. P140 to P143 are available for directly driving LED's. In input mode, the pull-up register can be set in one bit unit by software. Input/output This is an 8-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that output type is CMOS 3 state only.) By software selecting, these ports can be used for timer A0 to A2's output or SI/O3 and SI/O4 I/O pins. Input/output This is an 2-bit I/O port equivalent to P0. (Except that output type is CMOS 3 state only.) By software selecting, this port can be used for timer B3 and B4 input or PWM output pin. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 12 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Memory Operation of Functional Blocks The M16C/6K9 (144-pin version) group accommodates certain units in a single chip. These units include ROM and RAM to store instructions and data and the central processing unit (CPU) to execute arithmetic/ logic operations. Also peripheral units such as timers, serial I/O, D-A converter, DMAC, A-D converter, host bus interface, comparator, PWM output , I2C BUS interface, PS2 interface and I/O ports are included. The following explains each unit. Memory Fig.CA-1 is the memory map. The address space extends up to 1M bytes from address 0000016 to FFFFF16. From FFFFF16 to the address decreasing direction ROM is allocated. For example, in the M306K9FCLRP, there is 128K bytes of internal ROM from E000016 to FFFFF16. The vector table for fixed interrupts such as _______ the reset and NMI are mapped from FFFDC16 to FFFFF16. The starting address of the interrupt routine is stored here. The address of the vector table for timer interrupts, etc., can be set as desired using the internal register (INTB). See the section on interrupts for details. From 0040016 to the address increasing direction RAM is allocated. For example, in the M306K9FCLRP, 5K bytes of internal RAM is mapped to the space from 0040016 to 017FF16. In addition to storing data, the RAM also stores the stack used when calling subroutines and when interrupts are generated. The SFR area is mapped from 0000016 to 003FF16. This area accommodates the control registers for peripheral devices such as I/O ports, A-D converter, serial I/O, and timers, etc. Fig.CA-2 to CA-5 are location of peripheral unit control registers. Any part of the SFR area that is not occupied is reserved and cannot be used for other purposes. The special page vector table is mapped from FFE0016 to FFFDB16. If the starting addresses of subroutines or the destination addresses of jumps are stored here, subroutine call instructions and jump instructions can be used as 2-byte instructions, reducing the number of program steps. 0000016 SFR area For details, see Fig.CA-2 to Fig.CA-4 0040016 Internal RAM area FFE0016 XXXXX16 Type No. M306K9FCLRP M306K9F8LRP Address XXXXX16 Address YYYYY16 017FF16 E000016 00FFF16 Special page vector table FFFDC16 Inhibited Overflow BRK instruction Address match Single step F000016 YYYYY16 Internal ROM area FFFFF16 Fig.CA-1 Memory map Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 13 of 290 Undefined instruction FFFFF16 Watchdog timer DBC NMI Reset CPU M16C/6K9 Group Central Processing Unit (CPU) The CPU has a total of 13 registers shown in Fig.BA-1 Seven of these registers (R0, R1, R2, R3, A0, A1, and FB) come in two sets; therefore, these have two register banks. AAAAAA AAAAAA AAAAAA AAAAAA AAAAAA AAAAAA AAAAAA AAAAAA AAAAAA AAAAAA AAAAAA AAAAAA AAAAAA AAAAAA b15 R0(Note) b8 b7 b15 R1(Note) b8 b7 H b15 R2(Note) b15 R3(Note) b15 A0(Note) b15 A1(Note) b15 FB(Note) b0 L H b19 b0 L b0 Program counter Data registers b19 INTB b0 Interrupt table register L H b15 b0 b0 User stack pointer USP b15 b0 b0 b0 PC b0 Interrupt stack pointer ISP Address registers b15 b0 Static base register SB b15 b0 Frame base register b0 FLG Flag register AA AAAAAA AA AA AA A AA A AA AA AA AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AAA IPL U I O B S Z D C Note: These registers consist of two register banks. Fig.BA-1 Central processing unit register (1) Data registers (R0, R0H, R0L, R1, R1H, R1L, R2, and R3) Data registers (R0, R1, R2, and R3) are configured with 16 bits, and are used primarily for transfer and arithmetic/logic operations. Registers R0 and R1 each can be used as separate 8-bit data registers, high-order bits as (R0H/R1H), and low-order bits as (R0L/R1L). In some instructions, registers R2 and R0, as well as R3 and R1 can use as 32bit data registers (R2R0/R3R1). (2) Address registers (A0 and A1) Address registers (A0 and A1) are configured with 16 bits, and have functions equivalent to those of data registers. These registers can also be u2sed for address register indirect addressing and address register relative addressing. In some instructions, registers A1 and A0 can be combined for use as a 32-bit address register (A1A0). Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 14 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group CPU (3) Frame base register (FB) Frame base register (FB) is configured with 16 bits, and is used for FB relative addressing. (4) Program counter (PC) Program counter (PC) is configured with 20 bits, indicating the address of an instruction to be executed. (5) Interrupt table register (INTB) Interrupt table register (INTB) is configured with 20 bits, indicating the start address of an interrupt vector table. (6) Stack pointer (USP/ISP) Stack pointer comes in two types: user stack pointer (USP) and interrupt stack pointer (ISP), each configured with 16 bits. Your desired type of stack pointer (USP or ISP) can be selected by a stack pointer select flag (U flag). This flag is located at the position of bit 7 in the flag register (FLG). (7) Static base register (SB) Static base register (SB) is configured with 16 bits, and is used for SB relative addressing. (8) Flag register (FLG) Flag register (FLG) is configured with 11 bits, each bit is used as a flag. Fig.BA-2 shows the flag register (FLG). The following explains the function of each flag: • Bit 0: Carry flag (C flag) This flag retains a carry, borrow, or shift-out bit that has occurred in the arithmetic/logic unit. • Bit 1: Debug flag (D flag) This flag enables a single-step interrupt. When this flag is “1”, a single-step interrupt is generated after instruction execution. This flag is cleared to “0” when the interrupt is acknowledged. • Bit 2: Zero flag (Z flag) This flag is set to “1” when an arithmetic operation resulted in 0; otherwise, cleared to “0”. • Bit 3: Sign flag (S flag) This flag is set to “1” when an arithmetic operation resulted in a negative value; otherwise, cleared to “0”. • Bit 4: Register bank select flag (B flag) This flag chooses a register bank. Register bank 0 is selected when this flag is “0” ; register bank 1 is selected when this flag is “1”. • Bit 5: Overflow flag (O flag) This flag is set to “1” when an arithmetic operation resulted in overflow; otherwise, cleared to “0”. • Bit 6: Interrupt enable flag (I flag) This flag enables a maskable interrupt. An interrupt is disabled when this flag is “0”, and is enabled when this flag is “1”. This flag is cleared to “0” when the interrupt is acknowledged. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 15 of 290 CPU M16C/6K9 Group • Bit 7: Stack pointer select flag (U flag) Interrupt stack pointer (ISP) is selected when this flag is “0” ; user stack pointer (USP) is selected when this flag is “1”. This flag is cleared to “0” when a hardware interrupt is acknowledged or an INT instruction of software interrupt No. 0 to 31 is executed. • Bits 8 to 11: Reserved area • Bits 12 to 14: Processor interrupt priority level (IPL) Processor interrupt priority level (IPL) is configured with the three bits, for specification of up to eight processor interrupt priority levels from level 0 to level 7. If a requested interrupt has priority greater than the processor interrupt priority level (IPL), the interrupt is enabled. • Bit 15: Reserved area The C, Z, S, and O flags are changed when instructions are executed. See the software manual for details. AA AAAAAAAAAA AAA AA AAA b15 b0 IPL U I O B S Z D C Flag register (FLG) Carry flag Debug flag Zero flag Sign flag Register bank select flag Overflow flag Interrupt enable flag Stack pointer select flag Reserved area Processor interrupt priority level (CPU) Reserved area Fig.BA-2 Flag register (FLG) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 16 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Reset Reset There are two kinds of resets; hardware and software. In both cases, operation is the same after the reset. (See “Software Reset” for details of software resets.) This section explains the hardware reset. When the supply voltage is in the range where operation is guaranteed, a reset is effected by holding the reset pin level “L” (0.2VCC max.) for at least 20 cycles. When the reset pin level is then returned to the “H” level while main clock is stable, the reset status is cancelled and program execution resumes from the address in the reset vector table. Fig.VB-1 shows the example reset circuit. Fig.VB-2 shows the reset sequence. 3.3V 3.0V VCC 0V 3.3V VCC RESET RESET 0.6V 0V Example when VCC = 3.3V Fig.VB-1 Example reset circuit XIN More than 20 cycles are needed RESET BCLK 24cycles Internal clock Φ Single chip mode Address FFFFE16 Fig.VB-2 Reset sequence Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 Content of reset vector FFFFC16 page 17 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Reset ____________ Table VB-1 shows the statuses of the other pins while the RESET pin level is “L”. Fig.VB-3 and VB-4 show the internal status of the microcomputer immediately after the reset is cancelled. ____________ Table VB-1 Pin status when RESET pin level is “L” Status Pin name Rev.1.00 CNVSS = VSS (M0) P0 I/O port (floating) P1 I/O port (floating) P2, P3, P40 to P43 I/O port (floating) P44 I/O port (floating) P45 to P47 I/O port (floating) P50 I/O port (floating) P51 I/O port (floating) P52 I/O port (floating) P53 I/O port (floating) P54 I/O port (floating) P55 I/O port (floating) P56 I/O port (floating) P57 I/O port (floating) P6, P7, P80 to P84, P86, P87, P9, P10 I/O port (floating) P11, P12, P13, P14 I/O port (floating) P15, P16 I/O port (floating) Jun 06, 2003 page 18 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Reset (25) A-D conversion interrupt control register (004E16)··· ? 0 0 0 (26) UART2 transmit interrupt control register (004F16)··· ? 0 0 0 (000616)··· 0 1 0 0 1 0 0 0 (27) UART2 receive interrupt control register (005016)··· ? 0 0 0 (000716)··· 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 (28) UART0 transmit interrupt control register (005116)··· ? 0 0 0 (1) Processor mode register 0 (000416)··· 0016 (2) Processor mode register 1 (000516)··· 0 0 0 0 0 (3) System clock control register 0 (4) System clock control register 1 0 (5) Address match interrupt enable register (000916)··· 0 0 (29) UART0 receive interrupt control register (005216)··· 0 0 ? 0 0 0 (6) Protect register (000A16)··· 0 0 0 (30) UART1 transmit interrupt control register (005316)··· ? 0 0 0 (7) Watchdog timer control register (000F16)··· 0 0 0 ? ? ? ? ? (31) UART1 receive interrupt control register (005416)··· 0 0 ? 0 0 0 (8) Address match interrupt register 0 (001016)··· 0016 (32) Timer A0 interrupt control register (005516)··· ? 0 0 0 (001116)··· 0016 (33) Timer A1 interrupt control register (005616)··· 0 0 ? 0 0 0 (34) Timer A2 interrupt control register (005716)··· ? 0 0 0 (001216)··· (9) Address match interrupt register 1 0 0 0 0 (001416)··· 0016 (35) Timer A3 interrupt control register (005816)··· ? 0 0 0 (001516)··· 0016 (36) Timer A4 interrupt control register (005916)··· ? 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 (37) Timer B0 interrupt control register (005A16)··· 0 0 ? 0 0 0 (10) DMA0 control register (002C16)··· 0 0 0 0 0 ? 0 0 (38) Timer B1 interrupt control register (005B16)··· 0 0 ? 0 0 0 (11) DMA1 control register (001616)··· (003C16)··· 0 0 0 0 0 ? 0 0 (39) Timer B2 interrupt control register (005C16)··· 0 0 ? 0 0 0 (12) I2C interrupt control register (004116)··· ? 0 0 0 (40) INT0 interrupt control register (005D16)··· 0 0 ? 0 0 0 (13) SCL2, SDA2 interrupt control register (004216)··· ? 0 0 0 (41) INT1 interrupt control register (005E16)··· 0 0 ? 0 0 0 (42) INT2 interrupt control register (005F16)··· 0 0 ? 0 0 0 (14) Timer B5 interrupt control register (004316)··· ? 0 0 0 (15) INT3 interrupt control register (004416)··· 0 0 ? 0 0 0 (43) PS20 shift register (02A016)··· 0016 (16) INT9 interrupt control register (004516)··· 0 0 ? 0 0 0 (44) PS20 status register (02A116)··· 0016 ? 0 0 0 (45) PS20 control register (02A216)··· 0016 (17) Timer B4 interrupt control register (004616)··· (18) Timer B3 interrupt control register (004716)··· ? 0 0 0 (46) PS21 shift register (02A416)··· 0016 (19) SI/O4 interrupt control register (004816)··· 0 0 ? 0 0 0 (47) PS21 status register (02A516)··· 0016 (20) SI/O3 interrupt control register (004916)··· 0 0 ? 0 0 0 (48) PS21 control register (02A616)··· 0016 (02A816)··· 0016 (21) Bus collision detection interrupt control register (004A16)··· 0 0 ? 0 0 0 (49) PS22 shift register (22) DMA0 interrupt control register (004B16)··· 0 0 ? 0 0 0 (50) PS22 status register (02A916)··· 0016 (51) PS22 control register (02AA16)··· 0016 (52) PS2 mode register (02AC16)··· 0016 (23) DMA1 interrupt control register (004C16)··· 0 0 ? 0 0 0 (24) Key input interrupt control register 0 (004D16)··· ? 0 0 0 x : Nothing is mapped to this bit ? : Undefined The content of other registers and RAM is undefined when the microcomputer is reset. The initial values must therefore be set. Fig.VB-3 Device's internal status after a reset is cleared (1) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 19 of 290 Reset M16C/6K9 Group (53) Data bus buffer status register 0 (02C116)··· 0016 (87) PWM control register 1 (030D16)··· 0016 (54) Data bus buffer status register 1 (02C316)··· 0016 (88) I2C2 address register (031216)··· 0016 (55) Data bus buffer status register 2 (02C516)··· 0016 (89) I2C2 control register 0 (031316)··· 0016 (56) Data bus buffer status register 3 (02C716)··· 0016 (90) I2C2 clock control register (031416)··· 0016 (57) Data bus buffer control register 0 (02C816)··· 0016 (031516)··· 1A16 (58) Data bus buffer control register 1 (02C916)··· 0016 2 (91) I C2 start/stop condition control register 2 (92) I C2 control register 1 (031616)··· 3016 (59) GateA20 control register (02CA16)··· 0016 (93) I2C2 control register 2 (031716)··· 0016 (60) Port P11 direction register (02E216)··· 0016 (94) I2C2 status register (031816)··· 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 (61) Port P12 direction register (02E316)··· 0016 (95) I2C0 address register (032216)··· 0016 (62) Port P13 direction register (02E616)··· 0016 (96) I2C0 control register 0 (032316)··· 0016 (63) Port P14 direction register (02E716)··· 0016 (97) I2C0 clock control register (032416)··· 0016 (64) Port P15 direction register (02EA16)··· 0016 (032516)··· 1A16 (65) Port P16 direction register (02EB16)··· 2 (98) I C0 start/stop condition control register (99) I2C0 control register 1 (032616)··· 3016 (66) Port function selection register 0 (02F816)··· 0016 (100) I2C0 control register 2 (032716)··· 0016 (67) Port function selection register 1 (02F916)··· 0016 (101) I2C0 status register (032816)··· 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 (68) Port P4 input register (02FA16)··· 0 (102) I2C1 address register (033216)··· 0016 (69) Port P7 input register (02FB16)··· 0 0 (103) I2C1 control register 0 (033316)··· 0016 (70) Pull-up control register 3 (02FC16)··· 0016 (104) I2C1 clock control register (033416)··· 0016 (71) Pull-up control register 4 (02FD16)··· 0016 (033516)··· 1A16 (72) Port control register 1 (02FE16)··· 0016 2 (105) I C1 start/stop condition control register (106) I2C1 control register 1 (033616)··· 3016 (73) Port control register 2 (02FF16)··· 0016 (107) I2C1 control register 2 (033716)··· 0016 (74) PWM0 prescaler (030016)··· 0016 (108) I2C1 status register (033816)··· 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 (75) PWM0 register (030116)··· 0016 (109) TimerB3,4,5 count start flag (034016)··· 0 0 0 (76) PWM1 prescaler (030216)··· 0016 (110) Interrupt factor selection register 1 (035616)··· 0016 (77) PWM1 register (030316)··· 0016 (111) Interrupt factor selection register 2 (035716)··· 0016 (030416)··· 0016 (112) Interrupt factor selection register 3 (035816)··· 0016 (030516)··· 0016 (113) Interrupt factor selection register 4 (035916)··· 0016 (030616)··· 0016 (114) Interrupt factor selection register 5 (035A16)··· 0016 (81) PWM3 register (030716)··· 0016 (115) TimerB3 mode register (035B16)··· 0 0 ? 0 0 0 0 (82) PWM4 prescaler (030816)··· 0016 (116) TimerB4 mode register (035C16)··· 0 0 ? 0 0 0 0 (83) PWM4 register (030916)··· 0016 (117) TimerB5 mode register (035D16)··· 0 0 ? (84) PWM5 prescaler (030A16)··· 0016 (118) Interrupt factor selection register 0 (035F16)··· 0016 (85) PWM5 register (030B16)··· 0016 (119) SI/O3 control register (036216)··· 4016 (030C16)··· 0016 (120) SI/O4 control register (036616)··· 4016 (78) PWM2 prescaler (79) PWM2 register (80) PWM3 prescaler (86) PWM control register 0 0 0 0 0 x : Nothing is mapped to this bit ? : Undefined The content of other registers and RAM is undefined when the microcomputer is reset. The initial values must therefore be set. Fig.VB-4 Device's internal status after a reset is cleared (2) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 20 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Reset 0016 (149) A-D control register 2 (03D416)··· 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0016 (150) A-D control register 0 (03D616)··· 0 0 0 0 0 ? ? ? (037C16)··· 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 (151) A-D control register 1 (03D716)··· 0016 (124) UART2 transmit/receive control register 1 (037D16)··· 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 (152) D-A control register (03DC16)··· 0016 (125) Count start flag (038016)··· (153) Comparator control register (03DE16)··· 0016 0016 (121) UART2 special mode register (037716)··· (122) UART2 transmit/receive mode register (037816)··· (123) UART2 transmit/receive control register 0 0016 (126) Clock prescaler reset flag (038116)··· 0 (127) One-shot start flag (038216)··· 0 0 (128) Trigger select flag (038316)··· (154) Port P0 direction register (03E216)··· 0 0 0 0 0 (155) Port P1 direction register (03E316)··· 0016 0016 (156) Port P2 direction register (03E616)··· 0016 0016 (129) Up-down flag (038416)··· 0016 (157) Port P3 direction register (03E716)··· (130) Timer A0 mode register (039616)··· 0016 (158) Port P4 direction register (03EA16)··· 0016 0016 (159) Port P5 direction register (03EB16)··· 0016 0016 (131) Timer A1 mode register (039716)··· (132) Timer A2 mode register (039816)··· 0016 (160) Port P6 direction register (03EE16)··· (133) Timer A3 mode register (039916)··· 0016 (161) Port P7 direction register (03EF16)··· 0016 (134) Timer A4 mode register (039A16)··· 0016 (162) Port P8 direction register (03F216)··· 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 (135) Timer B0 mode register (039B16)··· 0 0 ? 0 0 0 0 (163) Port P9 direction register (03F316)··· 0016 (136) Timer B1 mode register (039C16)··· 0 0 ? 0 0 0 0 (164) Port P10 direction register (03F616)··· 0016 (137) Timer B2 mode register (039D16)··· 0 0 ? 0 0 0 0 (165) Pull-up control register 0 (03FC16)··· 0016 (138) UART0 transmit/receive mode register (03A016)··· (166) Pull-up control register 1 (03FD16)··· 0016 (139) UART0 transmit/receive control register 0 (03A416)··· 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 (167) Pull-up control register 2 (03FE16)··· 0016 (03A516)··· 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 (168) Port control register 0 (03FF16)··· (140) UART0 transmit/receive control register 1 0016 (141) UART1 transmit/receive mode register (03A816)··· (142) UART1 transmit/receive control register 0 (03AC16)··· 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 (143) UART1 transmit/receive control register 1 0016 (03AD16)··· 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 (144) UART transmit/receive control register 2 (03B016)··· 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 (145) Flash memory recognition register (Note1) (03B416)··· 1 0 (146) Flash memory control register (Note1) (03B716)··· 0 0 0 0 0 1 (147) DMA0 cause select register (03B816)··· 0016 (148) DMA1 cause select register (03BA16)··· 0016 000016 (170) Address registers (A0/A1) 000016 (171) Frame base register (FB) 000016 (172) Interrupt table register (INTB) 0000016 (173) User stack pointer (USP) 000016 (174) Interrupt stack pointer (ISP) 000016 (175) Static base register (SB) 000016 (176) Flag register (FLG) 000016 x : Nothing is mapped to this bit ? : Undefined The content of other registers and RAM is undefined when the microcomputer is reset. The initial values must therefore be set. (Note1) This register exists only in the flash memory version. Fig.VB-5 Device's internal status after a reset is cleared (3) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 21 of 290 0016 (169) Data registers (R0/R1/R2/R3) Reset M16C/6K9 Group (177) Serial interrupt control register 0 (02B016)··· 0016 (178) Serial interrupt control register 1 (02B116)··· 0016 (179) IRQ request register 0 (02B216)··· 0016 (180) IRQ request register 1 (02B316)··· 0016 (181) IRQ request register 2 (02B416)··· 0016 (182) IRQ request register 3 (02B516)··· 0016 (02B616)··· 0016 (184) Serial interrupt control register 2 (02B716)··· 1016 (185) LPC1 address register L (02D016)··· 0016 (186) LPC1 address register H (02D116)··· 0016 (187) LPC2 address register L (02D216)··· 0016 (188) LPC2 address register H (02D316)··· 0016 (189) LPC3 address register L (02D416)··· 0016 (190) LPC3 address register H (02D516)··· 0016 (191) LPC control register (02D616)··· 0016 (192) Port function selection register 2 (02F116)··· 0016 (193) Pull-up resistor control register 5 (02F216)··· 0016 (194) Pull-up resistor control register 6 (02F316)··· 0016 (195) Key input interrupt 1 enable register (02F416)··· 0016 (196) Key input interrupt 1 edge selection register (183) IRQ request register 4 (02F516)··· 0016 (197) P14 event register (02F616)··· 0016 (198) Port control register 3 (02F716)··· 0016 The content of other registers and RAM is undefined when the microcomputer is reset. The initial values must therefore be set. Fig.VB-6 Device's internal status after a reset is cleared (4) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 22 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group SFR SFR 000016 004016 000116 004116 I2C2 interrupt control register (IIC2IC) 000216 004216 SCL2,SDA2 interrupt control register (SCLDA2IC) DMA0 interrupt control register (DM0IC) Timer B5 interrupt control register (TB5IC) LRESET interrupt control register (LRSTIC) INT3 interrupt control register (INT3IC) INT9 interrupt control register (INT9IC) Timer B4 interrupt control register (TB4IC) 000316 000416 000516 000616 000716 Processor mode register 0 (PM0) Processor mode register 1(PM1) System clock control register 0 (CM0) System clock control register 1 (CM1) 000816 000916 000A16 004316 004416 004516 004616 Address match interrupt enable register (AIER) Protect register (PRCR) 000B16 UART1 receive interrupt control register (S1RIC) SI/O4 interrupt control register (S4IC) Timer B3 interrupt control register (TB3IC) 004716 000C16 UART1 transmit interrupt control register (S1TIC) 000D16 000E16 000F16 004816 Watchdog timer start register (WDTS) Watchdog timer control register (WDC) 004916 Address match interrupt register 0 (RMAD0) 004A16 SI/O4 interrupt control register (S4IC) INT6 interrupt control register (INT6IC) SI/O3 interrupt control register (S3IC) INT5 interrupt control register (INT5IC) 001016 001116 Bus collision detection interrupt control register (BCNIC) 001216 001316 001416 001516 INT4 interrupt control register (INT4IC) INT8 interrupt control register (INT8IC) DMA1 interrupt control register (DM1IC) INT7 interrupt control register (INT7IC) Key input interrupt 0 control register (KUP0IC) A-D conversion interrupt control register (ADIC) 004B16 004C16 Address match interrupt register 1 (RMAD1) 001616 004D16 001716 004E16 001816 004F16 UART2 transmit interrupt control register (S2TIC) 005016 UART2 receive interrupt control register (S2RIC) 005116 UART0 transmit interrupt control register (S0TIC) 001916 IBF0 interrupt control register (IBF0IC) 001A16 001B16 IBF1 interrupt control register (IBF1IC) 001C16 I2C0 interrupt control register (IIC0IC) 001D16 001E16 005216 001F16 002116 UART0 receive interrupt control register (S0RIC) SCL0,SDA0 interrupt control register (SCLDA0IC) 002016 DMA0 source pointer (SAR0) INT11 interrupt control register (INT11IC) 005316 UART1 transmit interrupt control register (S1TIC) I2C1 interrupt control register (IIC1IC) 002216 002316 005416 UART1 receive interrupt control register (S1RIC) 002416 002516 SCL1,SDA1 interrupt control register (SCLDA1IC) DMA0 destination pointer (DAR0) 002616 005516 002716 002816 002916 DMA0 transfer counter (TCR0) 002A16 005716 002B16 002C16 005616 005816 DMA0 control register (DM0CON) 002D16 005916 002E16 002F16 005A16 INT10 interrupt control register (INT10IC) Timer A0 interrupt control register (TA0IC) Timer A1 interrupt control register (TA1IC) INT7 interrupt control register (INT7IC) SI/O3 interrupt control register (S3IC) Timer A2 interrupt control register (TA2IC) Timer A3 interrupt control register (TA3IC) IBF2 interrupt control register (IBF2IC) Timer A4 interrupt control register (TA4IC) IBF3 interrupt control register (IBF3IC) Timer B0 interrupt control register (TB0IC) 003016 003116 SCL0,SDA0 interrupt control register (SCLDA0IC) DMA1 source pointer (SAR1) 003216 005B16 003316 SCL1,SDA1 interrupt control register (SCLDA1IC) 003416 003516 DMA1 destination pointer (DAR1) 005C16 003616 003716 003816 003916 005D16 DMA1 transfer counter (TCR1) 005E16 003A16 003B16 003C16 INT11 interrupt control register (INT11IC) Timer B1 interrupt control register (TB1IC) 005F16 DMA1 control register (DM1CON) 003D16 006016 003E16 006116 INT10 interrupt control register (INT10IC) Timer B2 interrupt control register (TB2IC) Key input interrupt 1 control register (KUP1IC) INT0 interrupt control register (INT0IC) PS20 interrupt control register (PS20IC) INT1 interrupt control register (INT1IC) PS21 interrupt control register (PS21IC) INT2 interrupt control register (INT2IC) PS22 interrupt control register (PS22IC) 003F16 027D16 027E16 027F16 Note 1: The areas that nothing are allocated in SFR are reserved. Read and Write to the areas are inhibited. Fig.CA-2 Location of peripheral unit control registers (1) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 23 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group SFR 028016 02C016 028116 02C116 028216 02C216 028316 02C316 028416 02C416 028516 02C516 028616 02C616 028716 02C716 028816 02C816 028916 02C916 028A16 02CA16 028B16 02CB16 028C16 02CC16 028D16 02CD16 028E16 02CE16 028F16 02CF16 029016 02D016 029116 02D116 029216 02D216 029316 02D316 029416 02D416 029516 02D516 029616 02D616 029716 02D716 029816 02D816 029916 02D916 029A16 02DA16 029B16 02DB16 029C16 02DC16 029D16 02DD16 029E16 02DE16 02A116 02A216 PS20 shift register (PS20SR) PS20 status register (PS20STS) PS20 control register (PS20CON) 02A516 02A616 PS21 shift register (PS21SR) PS21 status register (PS21STS) PS21 control register (PS21CON) 02A916 02AA16 PS22 shift register (PS22SR) PS22 status register (PS22STS) PS22 control register (PS22CON) 02E216 02E416 02E516 02E616 02E816 02E916 02EA16 02EB16 02AB16 02AC16 02E116 02E716 02A716 02A816 02E016 02E316 02A316 02A416 PS2 mode register (PS2MOD) 02ED16 02AE16 02EE16 02EF16 02AF16 02B116 02B216 02B316 02B416 02B516 02B616 02B716 Port P11 (P11) Port P12 (P12) Port P11 direction register (PD11) Port P12 direction register (PD12) Port P13 (P13) Port P14 (P14) Port P13 direction register (PD13) Port P14direction register (PD14) Port P15 (P15) Port P16 (P16) Port P15 direction register (PD15) Port P16 direction register (PD16) 02EC16 02AD16 02B016 LPC1 address registerL (LPC1ADL) LPC1 address registerH (LPC1ADH) LPC2 address registerL (LPC2ADL) LPC2 address registerH (LPC2ADH) LPC3 address registerL (LPC3ADL) LPC3 address registerH (LPC3ADH) LPC control register (LPCCON) 02DF16 029F16 02A016 Data bus buffer register0 (DBB0) Data bus buffer status register0 (DBBSTS0) Data bus buffer register1 (DBB1) Data bus buffer status register1 (DBBSTS1) Data bus buffer register2 (DBB2) Data bus buffer status register2 (DBBSTS2) Data bus buffer register3 (DBB3) Data bus buffer status register3 (DBBSTS3) Data bus buffer control register0 (DBBCON0) Data bus buffer control register1 (DBBCON1) Gate A20 control register (GA20CON) Serial Interrupt control register 0 (SERCON0) Serial Interrupt control register 1 (SERCON1) IRQ request register 0 (IRQ0) IRQ request register 1 (IRQ1) IRQ request register 2 (IRQ2) IRQ request register 3 (IRQ3) IRQ request register 4 (IRQ4) Serial Interrupt control register 2 (SERCON2) 02F016 02F416 Port function selection register 2 (PSL2) Pull-up resistor control register 5 (PUR5) Pull-up resistor control register 6 (PUR6) Key input interrupt 1 enable register (KIN1EN) 02F516 Key input interrupt 1 edge selection regiter (KINSEL) 02F616 P14 event register (P14EV) Port control register3 (PCR3) Port function selection register0 (PSL0) Port function selection register1 (PSL1) Port P4 input register (P4PIN) Port P7 input register (P7PIN) Pull-up control register3 (PUR3) Pull-up control register4 (PUR4) Port control register1 (PCR1) Port control register2 (PCR2) 02F116 02F216 02F316 02F716 02B816 02F816 02B916 02F916 02BA16 02FA16 02BB16 02FB16 02BC16 02FC16 02BD16 02FD16 02BE16 02FE16 02BF16 02FF16 Note 1: The areas that nothing are allocated in SFR are reserved. Read and Write to the areas are inhibited. Fig.CA-3 Location of peripheral unit control registers (2) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 24 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group 030016 030116 030216 030316 030416 030516 030616 030716 030816 030916 030A16 030B16 030C16 030D16 SFR PWM0 prescaler (PREPWM0) PWM0 register (PWM0) PWM1 prescaler (PREPWM1) PWM1 register (PWM1) PWM2 prescaler (PREPWM2) PWM2 register (PWM2) PWM3 prescaler (PREPWM3) PWM3 register (PWM3) PWM4 prescaler (PREPWM4) PWM4 register (PWM4) PWM5 prescaler (PREPWM5) PWM5 register (PWM5) PWM control register 0 (PWMCON0) PWM control register 1 (PWMCON1) I2C2 data shift register (S02) (Note2) 031416 031516 031616 031716 031816 034316 034416 034516 034616 034716 034816 034916 034A16 034B16 034C16 034D16 035016 035116 031116 031316 034216 034F16 030F16 031216 2 I C2 address register (S0D2) (Note2) I2C2 control register 0 (S1D2) (Note2) I2C2 clock control register (S22) (Note2) I2C2 start/stop condition control register (S2D2) (Note2) I2C2 control register 1 (S3D2) (Note2) I2C2 control register 2 (S4D2) (Note2) I2C2 status register (S12) (Note2) 035216 035316 035416 035516 035616 035716 035816 031916 035916 031A16 035A16 031B16 035B16 031C16 035C16 031D16 035D16 031E16 035E16 035F16 031F16 032016 I2C0 data shift register (S00) 032316 032416 032516 032616 032716 032816 036016 I2C0 address register (S0D0) I2C0 control register0 (S1D0) I2C0 clock control register (S20) I2C0 start/stop condition control register (S2D0) I2C0 control register1 (S3D0) I2C0 control register2 (S4D0) I2C0 status register (S10) 036216 036316 036416 036616 036716 036916 036A16 032B16 036B16 032C16 036C16 032D16 036D16 032E16 036E16 I2C1 data shift register (S01) 033516 033616 033716 033816 Interrupt event select register0 (IFSR0) SI/O3 transmit/receive register (S3TRR) SI/O3 control register (S3C) SI/O3 communication speed register (S3BRG) SI/O4 transmit/receive register (S4TRR) SI/O4 control register (S4C) SI/O4 communication speed register (S4BRG) 037016 037116 033116 033416 Interrupt event select register1 (IFSR1) Interrupt event select register2 (IFSR2) Interrupt event select register3 (IFSR3) Interrupt event select register4 (IFSR4) Interrupt event select register5 (IFSR5) TimerB3 mode register (TB3MR) TimerB4 mode register (TB4MR) TimerB5 mode register (TB5MR) 036F16 032F16 033316 TimerB5 register (TB5) 036816 032A16 033216 TimerB4 register (TB4) 036516 032916 033016 TimerB3 register (TB3) 036116 032116 032216 TimerB3,4,5 count start flag (TBSR) 034116 034E16 030E16 031016 034016 I2C1 address register (S0D1) I2C1 control register0 (S1D1) I2C1 clock control register (S21) I2C1 start/stop condition control register (S2D1) I2C1 control register1 (S3D1) I2C1 control register2 (S4D1) I2C1 status register (S11) 037216 037316 037416 037516 037616 037716 037816 033916 037916 033A16 037A16 033B16 037B16 033C16 037C16 033D16 037D16 033E16 037E16 033F16 037F16 UART2 special mode register (U2SMR) UART2 transmit/receive mode register (U2MR) UART2 communication speed register (U2BRG) UART2 tranmit buffer register (U2TB) UART2 transmit/receive control register0 (U2C0) UART2 transmit/receive control register1 (U2C1) UART2 receive buffer register (U2RB) Note 1: The areas that nothing are allocated in SFR are reserved. Read and Write to the areas are inhibited. Note 2: Nothing is allocated in M306K9F8LRP. Fig.CA-4 Location of peripheral unit control registers (3) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 25 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group 038016 038116 038216 038316 038416 SFR Count start flag (TABSR) Clock prescaler reset flag (CPSRF) One-shot start flag (ONSF) Trigger select register (TRGSR) Up-down flag (UDF) 03C016 03C116 03C216 03C316 03C416 038516 03C516 038616 TimerA0 (TA0) 03C616 TimerA1 (TA1) 03C816 TimerA2 (TA2) 03CA16 038716 038816 038916 038A16 03C716 03C916 038B16 03CB16 038C16 TimerA3 (TA3) 03CC16 038D16 03CD16 038E16 TimerA4 (TA4) 03CE16 TimerB0 (TB0) 03D016 038F16 039016 TimerB1 (TB1) 03D216 TimerB2 (TB2) 03D416 TimerA0 mode register (TA0MR) TimerA1 mode register (TA1MR) TimerA2 mode register (TA2MR) TimerA3 mode register (TA3MR) TimerA4 mode register (TA4MR) TimerB0 mode register (TB0MR) TimerB1 mode register (TB1MR) TimerB2 mode register (TB2MR) 03D616 039316 039416 039516 039616 039716 039816 039916 039A16 039B16 039C16 039D16 03D716 03D816 03DA16 03A416 03A516 03A616 03A716 03A816 03A916 03AA16 03AB16 03AC16 03AD16 03AE16 03AF16 03B016 03DC16 UART0 transmit/receive mode register (U0MR) UART0 communication speed register (U0BRG) UART0 tranmit buffer register (U0TB) UART0 transmit/receive control register0 (U0C0) UART0 transmit/receive control register1 (U0C1) UART0 receive buffer register (U0RB) UART1 transmit/receive mode register (U1MR) UART1 communication speed register (U1BRG) UART1 tranmit buffer register (U1TB) UART1 transmit/receive control register0 (U1C0) UART1 transmit/receive control register1 (U1C1) UART1 receive buffer register (U1RB) UART transmit/receive control register2 (UCON) 03E016 03E116 03E216 03E316 03E416 03E516 03E616 03E716 03E816 03E916 03EA16 03EB16 03EC16 03ED16 03EE16 03EF16 03F016 03F116 03B216 03F216 03F316 03B316 Flash memory recognition register (FMRR) Flash memory control register (FMCR) DMA0 request cacse select register (DM0SL) A-D control register2 (ADCON2) A-D control register0 (ADCON0) A-D control register1 (ADCON1) D-A register0 (DA0) D-A register1 (DA1) D-A control register (DACON) Comparator control register (CMPCON) Comparator data register (CMPD) Port P0 (P0) Port P1 (P1) Port P0 direction register (P0D) Port P1 direction register (P1D) Port P2 (P2) Port P3 (P3) Port P2 direction register (P2D) Port P3 direction register (P3D) Port P4 (P4) Port P5 (P5) Port P4 direction register (P4D) Port P5 direction register (P5D) Port P6 (P6) Port P7 (P7) Port P6 direction register (P6D) Port P7 direction register (P7D) Port P8 (P8) Port P9 (P9) Port P8 direction register (P8D) Port P9 direction register (P9D) Port P10 (P10) Port P10 direction register (P10D) 03F716 03F816 03F916 03B916 03BA16 03F416 03F616 03B616 03B816 A-D register7 (AD7) 03F516 03B516 03B716 A-D register6 (AD6) 03DD16 03B116 03B416 A-D register5 (AD5) 03DB16 03DF16 03A316 A-D register4 (AD4) 03D916 03DE16 03A216 A-D register3 (AD3) 03D516 039F16 03A116 A-D register2 (AD2) 03D316 039E16 03A016 A-D register1 (AD1) 03D116 039116 039216 03CF16 A-D register0 (AD0) DMA1 request cacse select register (DM1SL) 03FA16 03BB16 03FB16 03BC16 03FC16 03BD16 03FD16 03BE16 03FE16 03BF16 03FF16 Pull-up control register0 (PUR0) Pull-up control register1 (PUR1) Pull-up control register2 (PUR2) Port control register0 (PCR0) Note 1: The areas that nothing are allocated in SFR are reserved. Read and Write to the areas are inhibited. Fig.CA-5 Location of peripheral unit control registers (4) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 26 of 290 Software Reset M16C/6K9 Group Software Reset Writing “1” to bit 3 of the processor mode register 0 (address 000416) applies a (software) reset to the microcomputer. A software reset has almost the same effect as a hardware reset. The contents of internal RAM are retained. Processor Mode (1) Types of Processor Mode The single-chip mode is supported in processor mode. • Single-chip mode In single-chip mode, only internal memory space (SFR, internal RAM, and internal ROM) can be accessed. Ports P0 to P16 can be used as programmable I/O ports or as I/O ports for the internal peripheral functions. Fig. BG-1 shows the structure of processor mode register 0 and processor mode register 1. Processor mode register 0 (Note 1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 0 0 0 0 b2 b1 Symbol PM0 b0 0 Address 000416 Bit symbol PM00 Bit name Processor mode bit PM01 Reserved bit PM03 When reset 0016 (Note 2) Function b1 b0 0 0: Single-chip mode 0 1: Inhibited 1 0: Inhibited 1 1: Inhibited Must always be set to “0” Software reset bit Reserved bit The device is reset when this bit is set to “1”. The value of this bit is “0” when read. Must always be set to “0” AA A AA A R W Note 1: Set bit 1 of the protect register (address 000A16) to “1” when writing new values to this register. Processor mode register 1 (Note 1) b7 b6 b5 b4 0 0 0 b3 0 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol PM1 Address 000516 Bit symbol Bit name When reset 00000XX02 Function Must always be set to “0” Reserved bit Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate. Must always be set to “0” Reserved bit PM17 Wait bit 0 : No wait state 1 : Wait state inserted A AA A Note 1: Set bit 1 of the protect register (address 000A16) to “1” when writing new values to this register. Fig.BG-1 Processor mode register 0 and 1 Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 27 of 290 R W M16C/6K9 Group Bus control Bus control (1) Software wait A software wait can be inserted by setting the wait bit (bit 7) of the processor mode register 1 (address 000516) (Note) . A software wait is inserted in the internal ROM/RAM area by setting the wait bit of the processor mode register 1. When set to “0”, each bus cycle is executed in one BCLK cycle. When set to “1”, each bus cycle is executed in 2 BCLK cycles. After the microcomputer has been reset, this bit defaults to “0”. Set this bit after referring to the recommended operating conditions (main clock input oscillation frequency) of the electric characteristics. The SFR area is always accessed in two BCLK cycles regardless of the setting of these control bits. Table.EF-1 shows the software wait and bus cycles. Fig.EF-1 shows example bus timing when using software waits. Note: Before attempting to change the contents of the processor mode register 1, set bit 1 of the protect register (address 000A16) to “1”. Table.EF-1 Software waits and bus cycles Bus cycle Area Wait bit SFR Invalid 2 BCLK cycles 0 1 BCLK cycle 1 2 BCLK cycles Internal ROM/RAM Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 28 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Bus control No wait Bus cycle Bus cycle (Note 1) (Note 1) BCLK Write signal Read signal Output Data bus Address bus Address Input Address Chip select With wait Bus cycle Bus cycle (Note 1) (Note 1) BCLK Write signal Read signal Data bus Address bus Input Output Address Address Chip select Note 1: This timing sample shows the lenth of bus cycle. It is possible that the read cyles, write cycle comes after this cycle in succession. Fig.EF-1 Typical bus timings using software wait Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 29 of 290 Clock Generating Circuit M16C/6K9 Group Clock Generating Circuit The clock generating circuit contains two oscillator circuits that supply the operating clock sources to the CPU and internal peripheral units. Table.WA-1 Main clock and sub clock generating circuits Main clock generating circuit Sub clock generating circuit • CPU’s operating clock source • CPU’s operating clock source • Internal peripheral units’ • Timer A/B’s count clock operating clock source source Ceramic or crystal oscillator Crystal oscillator XIN, XOUT XCIN, XCOUT Available Available Oscillating Stopped Externally derived clock can be input Use of clock Usable oscillator Pins to connect oscillator Oscillation stop/restart function Oscillator status immediately after reset Other Example of oscillator circuit Fig.WA-1 shows some examples of the main clock circuit, one using an oscillator connected to the circuit, and the other one using an externally derived clock for input. Figure WA-2 shows some examples of sub clock circuits, one using an oscillator connected to the circuit, and the other one using an externally derived clock for input. Circuit constants in Fig.WA-1 and WA-2 vary with each oscillator used. Use the values recommended by the manufacturer of your oscillator. Microcomputer Microcomputer (Built-in feedback resistor) (Built-in feedback resistor) XIN XIN XOUT XOUT Open (Note) Rd Externally derived clock CIN COUT Vcc Vss Note: Insert a damping resistor if required. The resistance will vary depending on the oscillator and the oscillation drive capacity setting. Use the value recommended by the maker of the oscillator. When the oscillation drive capacity is set to low, check that oscillation is stable. Apply the feedback register between XIN and XOUT if required by oscillator maker. Fig.WA-1 Examples of main clock Microcomputer Microcomputer (Built-in feedback resistor) (Built-in feedback resistor) XCIN XCOUT XCIN XCOUT Open (Note) RCd Externally derived clock CCIN CCOUT Vcc Vss Note: Insert a damping resistor if required. The resistance will vary depending on the oscillator and the oscillation drive capacity setting. Use the value recommended by the maker of the oscillator. When the oscillation drive capacity is set to low, check that oscillation is stable. Apply the feedback register between XCIN and XCOUT if required by oscillator maker. Fig.WA-2 Examples of sub clock Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 30 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Clock Generating Circuit Clock Control Fig.WA-3 shows the block diagram of the clock generating circuit. XCOUT XCIN fC32 1/32 f1 CM04 f1SIO2 fAD fC f8SIO2 f8 Sub clock f32SIO2 CM10 “1” Write signal f32 S Q XIN AAAA AAAA AAAA XOUT b R a RESET Software reset NMI d CM07=0 BCLK fC CM07=1 Main clock CM02 CM05 Interrupt request level judgment output c Divider S Q WAIT instruction R c b a 1/2 1/2 1/2 1/2 1/2 CM06=0 CM17,CM16=11 CM06=1 CM06=0 CM17,CM16=10 d CM06=0 CM17,CM16=01 CM06=0 CM17,CM16=00 CM0i : Bit i at address 000616 CM1i : Bit i at address 000716 WDCi : Bit i at address 000F16 Fig.WA-3 Clock generating circuit Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 31 of 290 Details of divider M16C/6K9 Group Clock Generating Circuit The following paragraphs describes the clocks generated by the clock generating circuit. (1) Main clock The main clock is generated by the main clock oscillation circuit. After a reset, the clock is divided by 8 to the BCLK. The clock can be stopped using the main clock stop bit (bit 5 at address 000616). After switching the CPU operation clock to sub clock stopping the clock reduces the power dissipation. After the oscillation of the main clock oscillation circuit has stabilized, the drive capacity of the main clock oscillation circuit can be reduced using the XIN-XOUT drive capacity select bit (bit 5 at address 000716). Reducing the drive capacity of the main clock oscillation circuit reduces the power dissipation. This bit defaults to “1” when shifting from high speed mode or mid-speed mode to stop mode and after a reset. (2) Sub clock The sub clock is generated by the sub clock oscillation circuit. No sub clock is generated after a reset. After oscillation is started using the port Xc select bit (bit 4 at address 000616), the sub clock can be selected as the BCLK by using the system clock select bit (bit 7 at address 000616). However, be sure that the sub clock oscillation has fully stabilized before switching. After the oscillation of the sub clock oscillation circuit has stabilized, the drive capacity of the sub clock oscillation circuit can be reduced using the XCIN-XCOUT drive capacity select bit (bit 3 at address 000616). Reducing the drive capacity of the sub clock oscillation circuit reduces the power dissipation. This bit changes to “1” when shifting to stop mode and at a reset. (3) BCLK The BCLK is the clock that drives the CPU, and is either the main clock or fc or is derived by dividing the main clock by 2, 4, 8, or 16. The BCLK is derived by dividing the main clock by 8 after a reset. When shifting from high speed mode or mid-speed mode to stop mode, the main clock division select bit (bit 6 at 000616) is set to “1”. The bit maintains in low speed mode and low power save mode. (4) Peripheral function clock f1, f8, f32, f1SIO2, f8SIO2, f32SIO2, fAD The clock for the peripheral devices is derived from the main clock or by dividing it by 8 or 32. The peripheral function clock is stopped by stopping the main clock or by setting the WAIT peripheral function clock stop bit (bit 2 at 000616) to “1” and then executing a WAIT instruction. (5) fC32 This clock is derived by dividing the sub clock by 32. It is used for the timer A and timer B counts. (6) fC This clock has the same frequency as the sub clock. It is used for the BCLK and for the watchdog timer. Fig.WA-4 shows the system clock control registers 0 and 1. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 32 of 290 Clock Generating Circuit M16C/6K9 Group System clock control register 0 (Note 1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol CM0 Address 000616 Bit symbol CM00 Bit name Clock output function select bit CM01 CM02 CM03 CM04 When reset 4816 WAIT peripheral function clock stop bit XCIN-XCOUT drive capacity select bit (Note 2) Port XC select bit Function b1 b0 0 0 : I/O port P57 0 1 : fC output 1 0 : f8 output 1 1 : f32 output AA A AAA AA AA AA AA AA AA AAA AAA AA AAAA RW 0 :Do not stop peripheral clock in wait mode 1 :Stop peripheral clock in wait mode (Note8) 0 : LOW 1 : HIGH 0 : I/O port 1 : XCIN-XCOUT generation CM05 Main clock (XIN-XOUT) stop bit (Note 3) (Note 4) (Note 5) 0 : On 1 : Off CM06 Main clock division select bit 0 (Note 7) 0 : CM16 and CM17 valid 1 : Division by 8 mode CM07 System clock select bit (Note 6) 0 : XIN, XOUT 1 : XCIN, XCOUT Note 1: Set bit 0 of the protect register (address 000A16) to "1" before writing to this register. Note 2: Changes to "1" when shiffing to stop mode. Note 3: When entering power saving mode, main clock stops using this bit. When returning from stop mode and operating with XIN, set this bit to "0". When main clock oscillation is operating by itself, set system clock select bit (CM07) to "1" before setting this bit to "1". Note 4: When inputting external clock, only clock oscillation buffer is stopped and clock input is acceptable. Note 5: If this bit is set to "1", XOUT turns "H". The built-in feedback resistor remains ON, so XIN turns pulled up to XOUT ("H") via the feedback resistor. Note 6: In the case of setting the bit from "0" to "1", set port XC select bit (CM04) to "1" and wait for the subclock being stable before wrting the bit. Don't write in the same time. In the case of setting the bit from "1" to "0", set main clock stop bit (CM05) to "0" and wait for the main clock being stable before write the bit. Note 7: The bit is set to "1" when shifting from high speed mode or mid speed mode to stop mode and after reset. The bit maintains in low speed mode and power save mode. Note 8: fc32 is not included. Do not set to "1" when using low-speed or low power dissipation mode. System clock control register 1 (Note 1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 0 0 0 0 b0 Symbol CM1 Address 000716 Bit symbol CM10 When reset 2016 Bit name All clock stop control bit (Note4) Function 0 : Clock on 1 : All clocks off (stop mode) Reserved bit Always set to “0” Reserved bit Always set to “0” Reserved bit Always set to “0” Reserved bit CM15 XIN-XOUT drive capacity select bit (Note 2) CM16 Main clock division select bit 1 (Note 3) Always set to “0” 0 : LOW 1 : HIGH b7 b6 CM17 0 0 : No division mode 0 1 : Division by 2 mode 1 0 : Division by 4 mode 1 1 : Division by 16 mode AA A AA A AA AA AA AAA AA A AAA AAA Note 1: Set bit 0 of the protect register (address 000A16) to "1" before writing to this register. Note 2: Changes to "1" when shiffing to stop mode. Note 3: Can be selected when bit 6 of the system clock control register 0 (address 000616) is "0". If "1", division mode is fixed at 8. Note 4: If this bit is set to "1", XOUT turns "H", and the built-in feedback resistor turns null. Fig.WA-4 System clock control registers 0 and 1 Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 33 of 290 RW Clock Generating Circuit M16C/6K9 Group Clock Output In single-chip mode, the clock output function select bits (bits 0 and 1 at address 000616) enable f8, f32, or fc to be output from the P57/CLKOUT pin. When the WAIT peripheral function clock stop bit (bit 2 at address 000616) is set to “1”, the output of f8 and f32 stops when a WAIT instruction is executed. By setting the f1 output function selection bits (bit0 and bit1 of address 02F116) ,f1 can be output via P110 and P111. By setting P110 output clock selection bit (bit7 of address 02F816), the clock output via P110 can be selected to f1 or fc. Stop Mode Writing “1” to the all-clock stop control bit (bit 0 at address 000716) stops all oscillation and the microcomputer enters stop mode. In stop mode, the content of the internal RAM is retained provided that VCC remains above 2V. The oscillation , BCLK, f1 to f32, f1SIO2 to f32SIO2, fC, fC32, and fAD stop in stop mode, peripheral functions such as the A-D converter and watchdog timer do not function. However, timer A andºº timer B operate provided that the event counter mode is set to an external pulse, and UARTi(i = 0 to 2) ,SIO3,4 functions provided an external clock is selected. Table.WA-2 shows the status of the ports in stop mode. Stop mode is cancelled by a hardware reset or interrupt. If an interrupt is to be used to cancel stop mode, that interrupt must first have been enabled.After the restoration by interrupt, the corresponding interrupt routine will be processed.When shifting from high speed mode or mid-speed mode to stop mode, the main clock division select bit 0 (bit 6 at 000616) is set to “1”. Table.WA-2 Port status during stop mode Pin Port CLKOUT Rev.1.00 When fc selected When f8, f32 selected Jun 06, 2003 page 34 of 290 Single-chip mode Retains status before stop mode “H” Retains status before stop mode M16C/6K9 Group Wait Mode Wait Mode When a WAIT instruction is executed, the BCLK stops and the microcomputer enters the wait mode. In this mode, oscillation continues but the BCLK and watchdog timer stop. Writing “1” to the WAIT peripheral function clock stop bit and executing a WAIT instruction stops the clock being supplied to the internal peripheral functions, allowing power dissipation to be reduced. However, because the peripheral function clock (fc32) that is generated by sub clock does not stop, there is no reducing of power dissipation. Do not set the bit to "1" then enter wait mode in low speed mode and low power dissipation mode.Table.WA-3 shows the status of the ports in wait mode. Wait mode is cancelled by a hardware reset or interrupt. If an interrupt is used to cancel wait mode, the microcomputer restarts from interrupt routine using as BCLK, the clock that had been selected when the WAIT instruction was executed. Table.WA-3 Port status during wait mode Pin Single-chip mode CLKOUT When fC selected Does not stop When f8, f32 selected Does not stop when the WAIT peripheral function clock stop bit is “0”. When the WAIT peripheral function clock stop bit is “1”, the status immediately prior to entering wait mode is maintained. Port Rev.1.00 maintained the status immediately prior to enterig wait mode Jun 06, 2003 page 35 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Status Transition Of BCLK Status Transition Of BCLK Power dissipation can be reduced and low-voltage operation achieved by changing the count source for BCLK. Table.WA-4 shows the operating modes corresponding to the settings of system clock control registers 0 and 1. After a reset, operation defaults to division by 8 mode. When shifting from high speed mode or mid-speed mode to stop mode, and after a reset main clock division select bit 0 (bit 6 at address 000616) is set to “1”. It is matained in low speed mode and low power dissipation mode. (1) Division by 2 mode The main clock is divided by 2 to obtain the BCLK. (2) Division by 4 mode The main clock is divided by 4 to obtain the BCLK. (3) Division by 8 mode The main clock is divided by 8 to obtain the BCLK. After reset, it works in this mode. Note that oscillation of the main clock must have stabilized before transferring from this mode to No-division, Division by 2 and Division by 4 mode. Oscillation of the sub clock must have stabilized before transferring this mode to Lowspeed mode and Low power dissipation mode. (4) Division by 16 mode The main clock is divided by 16 to obtain the BCLK. (5) No-division mode The main clock is used as the BCLK. (6) Low-speed mode fC is used as the BCLK. Note that oscillation of both the main and sub clocks must have stabilized before transferring from this mode to another or vice versa. At least 2 to 3 seconds are required after the sub clock starts. Therefore, the program must be written to wait until this clock has stabilized immediately after powering up and after stop mode is cancelled. (7) Low power dissipation mode fC is the BCLK and the main clock is stopped. Precaution In the case of switching the BCLK count source from XIN to XCIN, or from XCIN to XIN, it is necessary that the destination clock count source be stable. The transition should be waited by software after the oscillation being stable. Table.WA-4 Operating modes dictated by settings of system clock control registers 0 and 1 CM17 CM16 CM07 CM06 CM05 CM04 0 1 Invalid 1 0 Invalid Invalid 1 0 Invalid 1 0 Invalid Invalid 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 0 0 Invalid Invalid 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 Invalid Invalid Invalid Invalid Invalid 1 1 Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 36 of 290 Operating mode of BCLK Division by 2 mode Division by 4 mode Division by 8 mode Division by 16 mode No-division mode Low-speed mode Low power dissipation mode M16C/6K9 Group Power control Power control The following is a description of the power control modes: Modes Power control is available in three modes. (1) Normal operation mode • High-speed mode Divide-by-1 frequency of the main clock becomes the BCLK. The CPU operates with the internal clock selected. Each peripheral function operates according to its assigned clock. • Medium-speed mode Divide-by-2, divide-by-4, divide-by-8, or divide-by-16 frequency of the main clock becomes the BCLK. The CPU operates according to the internal clock selected. Each peripheral function operates according to its assigned clock. • Low-speed mode fC becomes the BCLK. The CPU operates according to the fc clock. The fc clock is supplied by the sub clock. Each peripheral function operates according to its assigned clock. • Low power consumption mode The main clock operating in low-speed mode is stopped. The CPU operates according to the fC clock. The fc clock is supplied by the sub clock. The only peripheral functions that operate are those with the sub-clock selected as the count source. (2) Wait mode The CPU operation is stopped. The oscillators do not stop. (3) Stop mode All oscillators stop. The CPU and all built-in peripheral functions stop. This mode, among the three modes listed here, is the most effective in decreasing power consumption. Fig.WA-5 is the state transition diagram of (1) to (3). Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 37 of 290 Power control M16C/6K9 Group Transition of stop mode, wait mode Reset All oscillators stop WAIT command CM10 = “1” Medium-speed mode (Divided-by-8 mode) Stop mode Interrupt Wait mode Interrupt Interrupt WAIT command All oscillators stop CM10 = “1” High-speed/mediumspeed mode Stop mode All oscillators stop Wait mode WAIT command low-speed/low power dissipation mode Interrupt CPU operation stop Interrupt CM10 = “1” Stop mode CPU operation stop CPU operation stop Wait mode Interrupt Normal mode (Please see the diagram below on transition of normal mode) Transition of normal mode Main clock oscillation Sub clock stop Medium-speed mode (divided-by-8 mode) BCLK : f(XIN)/8 CM06 = “1” CM07 = “0” CM06 = “1” CM07 = “0” Note 1 CM06 = “1” CM04 = “0” Main clock is oscillating Sub clock is oscillating High-speed mode BCLK : f(XIN) CM07 = “0” CM06 = “0” CM17 = “0” CM16 = “0” Medium-speed mode (divided-by-4) BCLK : f(XIN)/4 CM07 = “0” CM17 = “1” CM06 = “0” CM16 = “0” Medium-speed mode (divided-by-2) BCLK : f(XIN)/2 CM07 = “0” CM06 = “0” CM17 = “0” CM16 = “1” Medium-speed mode (divided-by-8) Medium-speed mode (divided-by-16) BCLK : f(XIN)/8 CM07 = “0” CM06 = “1” CM07 = “0” Note1,Note3 CM05 = “0” CM04 = “1” CM07 = “1” Note 2 CM05 = “1” Main clock is oscillating Sub clock is stop High-speed mode BCLK : f(XIN) CM06 = “0” Note1,Note3 CM06 = “0” CM16 = “0” Medium-speed mode (divided-by-4) BCLK: f(XIN)/4 CM07 = “0” CM17 = “1” CM06 = “0” CM16 = “0” CM07 = “0” CM17 = “0” Jun 06, 2003 page 38 of 290 Main clock is stop Sub clock is oscillating CM07 = “0” Note 1 CM06 = “0” Note 3 CM04 = “1” BCLK : f(XCIN) CM07 = “1” CM06 = “0” CM16 = “1” Medium-speed mode (divided-by-16) BCLK : f(XIN)/16 CM07 = “0” CM17 = “1” CM05 = “1” Low power dissipation mode Medium-speed mode (divided-by-2) BCLK : f(XIN)/2 CM06 = “0” CM16 = “1” Note 1: Note 2: Note 3: Note 4: Fig.WA-5 State transition diagram of Power control mode Rev.1.00 BCLK : f(XCIN) CM07 = “1” BCLK : f(XIN)/16 CM07 = “0” CM06 = “0” CM17 = “1” CM16 = “1” CM04 = “0” CM07 = “0” CM17 = “0” CM07 = “1” Note2 Main clock is oscillating Sub clock is oscillating Low-speed mode Please switch after the main clock oscillation being stable. Please switch after the sub clock oscillation being stable. Please change the CM06 after CM16,CM17 being changed. Please transit following the arrow direction. Protection M16C/6K9 Group Protection The protection function is provided so that the values in important registers cannot be changed in the event that the program runs out of control. Fig.WA-6 shows the protect register. The values in the processor mode register 0 (address 000416), processor mode register 1 (address 000516), system clock control register 0 (address 000616), system clock control register 1 (address 000716) can only be changed when the respective bit in the protect register is set to “1”. Protect register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol PRCR Address 000A16 Bit symbol Bit name When reset XXXXX0002 Function PRC0 Enables writing to system clock control registers 0 and 1 (addresses 0 : Write-inhibited 1 : Write-enabled 000616 and 000716) PRC1 Enables writing to processor mode registers 0 and 1 (addresses 000416 0 : Write-inhibited 1 : Write-enabled and 000516) Reserved bit Must be "0" Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate. Fig.WA-6 Protect register Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 39 of 290 A A A AA A AA AA R W Interrupt M16C/6K9 Group Interrupt Type of Interrupts Fig.DD-1 lists the types of interrupts. Hardware Special Peripheral I/O (Note) Interrupt Software Undefined instruction (UND instruction) Overflow (INTO instruction) BRK instruction INT instruction Reset NMI ________ DBC Watchdog timer Single step Address matched _______ Note: Peripheral I/O interrupts are generated by the peripheral functions built into the microcomputer system. Fig.DD-1 Classification of interrupts • Maskable interrupt : An interrupt which can be enabled (disabled) by the interrupt enable flag (I flag) or whose interrupt priority can be changed by priority level. • Non-maskable interrupt : An interrupt which cannot be enabled (disabled) by the interrupt enable flag (I flag) or whose interrupt priority cannot be changed by priority level. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 40 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Interrupt Software Interrupts A software interrupt occurs when executing certain instructions. Software interrupts are non-maskable interrupts. • Undefined instruction interrupt An undefined instruction interrupt occurs when executing the UND instruction. • Overflow interrupt An overflow interrupt occurs when executing the INTO instruction with the overflow flag (O flag) set to “1”. The following are instructions whose O flag changes by arithmetic: ABS, ADC, ADCF, ADD, CMP, DIV, DIVU, DIVX, NEG, RMPA, SBB, SHA, SUB • BRK interrupt A BRK interrupt occurs when executing the BRK instruction. • INT interrupt An INT interrupt occurs when assigning one of software interrupt numbers 0 through 63 and executing the INT instruction. Software interrupt numbers 0 through 31 are assigned to peripheral I/O interrupts, so executing the INT instruction allows executing the same interrupt routine that a peripheral I/O interrupt does. The stack pointer (SP) used for the INT interrupt is dependent on which software interrupt number is involved. So far as software interrupt numbers 0 through 31 are concerned, the microcomputer saves the stack pointer assignment flag (U flag) when it accepts an interrupt request. If change the U flag to “0” and select the interrupt stack pointer (ISP), and then execute an interrupt sequence. When returning from the interrupt routine, the U flag is returned to the state it was before the acceptance of interrupt request. So far as software numbers 32 through 63 are concerned, the stack pointer does not make a shift. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 41 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Interrupt Hardware Interrupts Hardware interrupts are classified into two types — special interrupts and peripheral I/O interrupts. (1) Special interrupts Special interrupts are non-maskable interrupts. • Reset ____________ Reset occurs if an “L” is input to the RESET pin. _______ • NMI interrupt _______ _______ An NMI interrupt occurs if an “L” is input to the NMI pin. ________ • DBC interrupt This interrupt is exclusively for the debugger, do not use it in other circumstances. • Watchdog timer interrupt Generated by the watchdog timer. • Single-step interrupt This interrupt is exclusively for the debugger, do not use it in other circumstances. With the debug flag (D flag) set to “1”, a single-step interrupt occurs after one instruction is executed. • Address match interrupt An address match interrupt occurs immediately before the instruction held in the address indicated by the address match interrupt register is executed with the address match interrupt enable bit set to “1”. If an address other than the first address of the instruction in the address match interrupt register is set, no address match interrupt occurs. (2) Peripheral I/O interrupts A peripheral I/O interrupt is generated by one of built-in peripheral functions. Built-in peripheral functions are dependent on classes of products, so the interrupt factors are also dependent on classes of products. The interrupt vector table is the same as the one for software interrupt numbers 0 through 31 the INT instruction uses. Peripheral I/O interrupts are maskable interrupts. 1)Bus collision detection interrupt This is an interrupt that the serial I/O bus collision detection generates. 2)DMA0 interrupt, DMA1 interrupt These are interrupts that DMA generates. 3)Key-input interrupt 0 ___ A key-input interrupt occurs if an “L” is input to the KI pin. 4) Key-input interrupt 1 ___ A key-input interrupt occurs if an “L” or “H” is input to the KI pin. 5)A-D conversion interrupt This is an interrupt that the A-D converter generates. 6)UART0, UART1, UART2/NACK, SI/O3 and SI/O4 transmission interrupt These are interrupts that the serial I/O transmission generates. 7)UART0, UART1, UART2/ACK, SI/O3 and SI/O4 reception interrupt These are interrupts that the serial I/O reception generates. 8)Timer A0 interrupt through timer A4 interrupt These are interrupts that timer A generates 9)Timer B0 interrupt through timer B5 interrupt These are interrupts that timer B generates. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 42 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group ________ Interrupt __________ 10)INT0 interrupt through INT11 interrupt ______ ______ An INT interrupt occurs if either a rising edge or a falling edge or both edges are input to the INT pin. 11)IBF0 to IBF3 interrupt These are interrupts that host bus interface generates. ______________ 12) LRESET interrupt ______________ ______________ LRESET interrupt occurs if an “L” is input to LRESET pin. 13)I2C0,I2C1,I2C2,SCL0,SDA0,SCL1,SDA1,SCL2, SDA2 interrupt These are interrupts that I2C bus interface generates. 14)PS20 to PS22 interrupt These are interrupt that PS2 interface generates. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 43 of 290 Interrupt M16C/6K9 Group Interrupts and Interrupt Vector Tables If an interrupt request is accepted, a program branches to the interrupt routine set in the interrupt vector table. Set the first address of the interrupt routine in each vector table. Fig.DD-2 shows the format for specifying the address. Two types of interrupt vector tables are available — fixed vector table in which addresses are fixed and variable vector table in which addresses can be varied by the setting. AAAAAAAA AAAAAAAA AAAAAAAA AAAAAAAA AAAAAAAA LSB MSB Vector address + 0 Low address Mid address Vector address + 1 Vector address + 2 0000 High address 0000 0000 Fig.DD-2 Format for specifying interrupt vector addresses • Fixed vector tables The fixed vector table is a table in which addresses are fixed. The vector tables are located in an area extending from FFFDC16 to FFFFF16. One vector table comprises four bytes. Set the first address of interrupt routine in each vector table. Table.DD-1 shows the interrupts assigned to the fixed vector tables and addresses of vector tables. Table.DD-1 Interrupts assigned to the fixed vector tables and addresses of vector tables Interrupt source Undefined instruction Overflow BRK instruction Vector table addresses Address (L) to address (H) FFFDC16 to FFFDF16 FFFE016 to FFFE316 FFFE416 to FFFE716 Remarks Interrupt on UND instruction Interrupt on INTO instruction If the vector contains FF16, program execution starts from the address shown by the vector in the variable vector table There is an address-matching interrupt enable bit Do not use Address match FFFE816 to FFFEB16 Single step (Note) FFFEC16 to FFFEF16 Watchdog timer FFFF016 to FFFF316 ________ DBC (Note) FFFF416 to FFFF716 Do not use _______ _______ NMI FFFF816 to FFFFB16 External interrupt by input to NMI pin Reset FFFFC16 to FFFFF16 Note: Interrupts used for debugging purposes only. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 44 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Interrupt • Variable vector tables The addresses in the variable vector table can be modified, according to the user’s settings. The start address of vector table is set to the interrupt table register (INTB). The 256-byte area subsequent that the start address is indicated by the INTB becomes the area for the variable vector tables. One vector table comprises 4 bytes. Set the first address of the interrupt routine in each vector table. Table.DD-2 shows the interrupts assigned to the variable vector tables and addresses of vector tables. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 45 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Interrupt Table.DD-2 Interrupts assigned to the variable vector tables and addresses of vector Software interrupt number Vector table address Interrupt source Remarks Address (L) to address (H) Software interrupt number 0 +0 to +3 (Note 1) BRK instruction Software interrupt number 1 +4 to +7 (Note 1) I2 Cannot be masked by I flag Software interrupt number 2 +8 to +11 (Note 1) SCL2, SDA2/DMA0 (Note 2) Software interrupt number 3 +12 to +15 (Note 1) Timer B5/LRESET Software interrupt number 4 +16 to +19 (Note 1) INT3 Software interrupt number 5 +20 to +23 (Note 1) INT9 Software interrupt number 6 +24 to +27 (Note 1) Timer B4/UART1 reception/SIO4 (Note 3) Software interrupt number 7 +28 to +31 (Note 1) Timer B3/UART1 transmission (Note 3) Software interrupt number 8 +32 to +35 (Note 1) SIO4/INT6 (Note 3) Software interrupt number 9 +36 to +39 (Note 1) SIO3/INT5 (Note 3) Software interrupt number 10 +40 to +43 (Note 1) Bus collision detection/INT4 (Note 2) Software interrupt number 11 +44 to +47 (Note 1) INT8 Software interrupt number 12 +48 to +51 (Note 1) DMA1/INT7 Software interrupt number 13 +52 to +55 (Note 1) Key input interrupt 0 Software interrupt number 14 +56 to +59 (Note 1) A-D Software interrupt number 15 +60 to +63 (Note 1) UART2 transmit/IBF0 (Note 2) Software interrupt number 16 +64 to +67 (Note 1) UART2 receive/IBF1 (Note 2) Software interrupt number 17 +68 to +71 (Note 1) UART0 transmit/I2C0 (Note 2) Software interrupt number 18 +72 to +75 (Note 1) UART0 receive/SCL0,SDA0/INT11 (Note 3) Software interrupt number 19 +76 to +79 (Note 1) UART1 transmit/I2C1 (Note 3) Software interrupt number 20 +80 to +83 (Note 1) UART1 receive/SCL1,SDA1/INT10 (Note 3) Software interrupt number 21 +84 to +87 (Note 1) Timer A0 Software interrupt number 22 +88 to +91 (Note 1) Timer A1/INT7/SIO3 (Note 3) Software interrupt number 23 +92 to +95 (Note 1) Timer A2 Software interrupt number 24 +96 to +99 (Note 1) Timer A3/IBF2 (Note 2) Software interrupt number 25 +100 to +103 (Note 1) Timer A4/IBF3 (Note 2) Software interrupt number 26 +104 to +107 (Note 1) Timer B0/INT11/SCL0,SDA0 (Note 3) Software interrupt number 27 +108 to +111 (Note 1) Timer B1/INT10/SCL1,SDA1 (Note 3) Software interrupt number 28 +112 to +115 (Note 1) Timer B2/Key input interrupt 1 (Note 2) Software interrupt number 29 +116 to +119 (Note 1) INT0/PS20 (Note 2) Software interrupt number 30 +120 to +123 (Note 1) INT1/PS21 (Note 2) Software interrupt number 31 +124 to +127 (Note 1) INT2/PS22 (Note 2) Software interrupt number 32 +128 to +131 (Note 1) to Software interrupt number 63 to +252 to +255 (Note 1) C2 (Note 2) (Note 3) Software interrupt Cannot be masked by I flag Note 1: Address relative to address in interrupt table register (INTB). Note 2: It is selected by interrupt request cause bit. Note 3: Depend on interrupt event selection bit setting. Please do not set same interrupt event at the same time. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 46 of 290 Interrupt M16C/6K9 Group Interrupt Control Descriptions are given here regarding how to enable or disable maskable interrupts and how to set the priority to be accepted. What is described here does not apply to non-maskable interrupts. Enable or disable a maskable interrupt using the interrupt enable flag (I flag), interrupt priority level selection bits and processor interrupt priority level (IPL). Whether an interrupt request is present or absent is indicated by the interrupt request bit. The interrupt request bit and the interrupt priority level selection bits are located in the interrupt control register of each interrupt. The interrupt enable flag (I flag) and the IPL are located in the flag register (FLG). Fig.DD-3 and DD-4 shows the memory map of the interrupt control registers. The interrupt factors in the same vector share the same interrupt control register. Which factor to be used depends on interrupt factor selection bit of interrupt event selection register i(address:035F16 ,035616, to 035816, i = 0 to 3) setting. After setting the interrupt factor, the corresponding interrupt request bit must be set to "0" before changing the interrupt. Interrupt control register AAA AA A AAAA AA b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol IIC2IC SCLDA2IC/DM0IC TB5IC/LRSTIC TB4IC/S1RIC/S4IC TB3IC/S1TIC KUP0IC ADIC S2TIC/IBF0IC S2RIC/IBF1IC SiTIC/IICjIC(i=0,1) (j=0,1) TAiIC(i=0,2) TAiIC/IBFjIC(i=3,4) (j=2,3) TB2IC/KUP1IC b0 Bit symbol ILVL0 Address 004116 004216 004316 004616 004716 004D16 004E16 004F16 005016 005116,005316 005116,005316 005516,005716 005816,005916 005816,005916 005C16 Bit name Interrupt priority level select bit ILVL1 ILVL2 IR Interrupt request bit When reset XXXXX0002 XXXXX0002 XXXXX0002 XXXXX0002 XXXXX0002 XXXXX0002 XXXXX0002 XXXXX0002 XXXXX0002 XXXXX0002 XXXXX0002 XXXXX0002 XXXXX0002 XXXXX0002 XXXXX0002 Function b2 b1 b0 000: 001: 010: 011: 100: 101: 110: 111: Level 0 (interrupt disabled) Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Level 4 Level 5 Level 6 Level 7 0 : Interrupt not requested 1 : Interrupt requested Nothing is assigned. Note 1: Can only be writing by “0” (Please do not write “1” to this bit) Fig.DD-3 Interrupt control registers(1) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 47 of 290 AA AA A A AA AA AA R W (Note 1) Interrupt M16C/6K9 Group AAA A AA b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 0 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address INTiIC(i=3,9,8) 004416,004516,004B16 SiIC/INTjIC(i=4,3) 004816,004916 (j=6,5) 004816,004916 BCNIC/INT4IC 004A16 DM1IC/INT7IC 004C16 SiRIC/SCLDAjIC/INTkIC(i=0,1) 005216,005416 (j=0,1) 005216,005416 (k=11,10) 005216,005416 TA1IC/INT7IC/S3IC 005616 TBiIC/INTjIC/SCLDAkIC(i=0,1) 005A16,005B16 (j=11,10) 005A16,005B16 (k=0,1) 005A16,005B16 INTiIC/PS2jIC(i=0 to 2) 005D16 to 005F16 (j=0 to 2) 005D16 to 005F16 Bit symbol ILVL0 Bit name Interrupt priority level select bit ILVL1 ILVL2 IR POL Interrupt request bit Polarity select bit Reserved bit Function b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 : Level 0 (interrupt disabled) 0 0 1 : Level 1 0 1 0 : Level 2 0 1 1 : Level 3 1 0 0 : Level 4 1 0 1 : Level 5 1 1 0 : Level 6 1 1 1 : Level 7 0: Interrupt not requested 1: Interrupt requested 0 : Selects falling edge 1 : Selects rising edge Always set to “0” Nothing is assigned. Note 1: Can only be written by "0" (Please do not write "1" to this bit) Fig.DD-4 Interrupt control registers (2) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 48 of 290 When reset XX00X0002 XX00X0002 XX00X0002 XX00X0002 XX00X0002 XX00X0002 XX00X0002 XX00X0002 XX00X0002 XX00X0002 XX00X0002 XX00X0002 XX00X0002 XX00X0002 A A A A AA AA AA A A A A AA R W (Note 1) Interrupt M16C/6K9 Group Interrupt Enable Flag (I flag) The interrupt enable flag (I flag) controls the enabling and disabling of maskable interrupts. Setting this flag to “1” enables all maskable interrupts; setting it to “0” disables all maskable interrupts. This flag is set to “0” after reset. Interrupt Request Bit The interrupt request bit is set to "1" by hardware when an interrupt is requested. After the interrupt is accepted and jumps to the corresponding interrupt vector, the request bit is set to "0" by hardware. The interrupt request bit can also be set to "0" by software. (Do not set this bit to "1"). Interrupt Priority Level Select Bits and Processor Interrupt Priority Level (IPL) Set the interrupt priority level using the interrupt priority level select bits in the interrupt control register. When an interrupt request occurs, the interrupt priority level is compared with the IPL. The interrupt is enabled only when the priority level of the interrupt is higher than the IPL. Therefore, setting the interrupt priority level to “0” disables the interrupt. Table.DD-3 shows the settings of interrupt priority levels and Table.DD-4 shows the interrupt levels enabled, according to the consist of the IPL. The following are conditions under which an interrupt is accepted: · interrupt enable flag (I flag) = 1 · interrupt request bit = 1 · interrupt priority level > processor interrupt priority level (IPL) The interrupt enable flag (I flag), the interrupt request bit, the interrupt priority select bits, and the IPL are independent, and they are not affected each other. Table.DD-3 Settings of interrupt priority levels Interrupt priority level select bit Interrupt priority level Table.DD-4 Interrupt levels enabled according to the contents of the IPL Priority order b2 b1 b0 IPL Enabled interrupt priority levels IPL2 IPL1 IPL0 0 0 0 Level 0 (interrupt disabled) 0 0 1 Level 1 0 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 Interrupt levels 1 and above are enabled 0 0 1 Interrupt levels 2 and above are enabled Level 2 0 1 0 Interrupt levels 3 and above are enabled 1 Level 3 0 1 1 Interrupt levels 4 and above are enabled 0 0 Level 4 1 0 0 Interrupt levels 5 and above are enabled 1 0 1 Level 5 1 0 1 Interrupt levels 6 and above are enabled 1 1 0 Level 6 1 1 0 Interrupt levels 7 and above are enabled 1 1 1 Level 7 1 1 1 All maskable interrupts are disabled Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 49 of 290 Low High M16C/6K9 Group Interrupt Rewrite the interrupt control register To rewrite the interrupt control register, do so at a point that does not generate the interrupt request for that register. If there is possibility of the interrupt request occurrence, rewrite the interrupt control register after the interrupt is disabled. The program examples are described as follow: Example 1: INT_SWITCH1: FCLR I AND.B #00h, 0055h NOP NOP FSET I ; Disable interrupts. ; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit. ; Four NOP instructions are required when using HOLD function. ; Enable interrupts. Example 2: INT_SWITCH2: FCLR I AND.B #00h, 0055h MOV.W MEM, R0 FSET I ; Disable interrupts. ; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit. ; Dummy read. ; Enable interrupts. Example 3: INT_SWITCH3: PUSHC FLG FCLR I AND.B #00h, 0055h POPC FLG ; Push Flag register onto stack ; Disable interrupts. ; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit. ; Enable interrupts. The reason why two NOP instructions (four when using the HOLD function) or dummy read are inserted before FSET I in Examples 1 and 2 is to prevent the interrupt enable flag I from being set before the interrupt control register is rewritten due to effects of the instruction queue. When a instruction to rewrite the interrupt control register is executed but the interrupt is disabled, the interrupt request bit is not set sometimes even if the interrupt request for that register has been generated. This will depend on the instruction. If this creates problems, use the below instructions to change the register. Instructions : AND, OR, BCLR, BSET Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 50 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Interrupt Interrupt Sequence An interrupt sequence — what are performed over a period from the instant an interrupt is accepted to the instant the interrupt routine is executed — is described here. If an interrupt occurs during execution of an instruction, the processor determines its priority when the execution of the instruction is completed, and transfers control to the interrupt sequence from the next cycle. If an interrupt occurs during execution of either the SMOVB, SMOVF, SSTR or RMPA instruction, the processor temporarily suspends the instruction being executed, and transfers control to the interrupt sequence. In the interrupt sequence, the processor carries out the following in sequence given: (1) CPU gets the interrupt information (the interrupt number and interrupt request level) by reading address 0000016. (2) Saves the content of the flag register (FLG) as it was immediately before the start of interrupt sequence in the temporary register (Note) within the CPU. (3) Sets the interrupt enable flag (I flag), the debug flag (D flag), and the stack pointer select flag (U flag) to “0” (the U flag, however does not change if the INT instruction, in software interrupt numbers 32 through 63, is executed) (4) Saves the content of the temporary register (Note) within the CPU in the stack area. (5) Saves the content of the program counter (PC) in the stack area. (6) Sets the interrupt priority level of the accepted instruction in the IPL. After the procession of interrupt sequence the processor executes instructions from the first address of the interrupt routine. Note: This register cannot be utilized by the user. Interrupt Response Time 'Interrupt response time' is the period between the instant an interrupt occurs and the instant the first instruction within the interrupt routine has been executed. This time comprises the period from the occurrence of an interrupt to the completion of the instruction under execution at that moment (a) and the time required for executing the interrupt sequence (b). Fig.DD-5 shows the interrupt response time. Interrupt request generated Interrupt request acknowledged Time Instruction (a) Interrupt sequence (b) Interrupt response time Fig.DD-5 Interrupt response time Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 51 of 290 Instruction in interrupt routine M16C/6K9 Group Interrupt Time (a) is dependent on the instruction under execution. 30 cycles is the maximum required for the DIVX instruction (without wait). Time (b) is as shown in Table.DD-5 Table.DD-5 Time required for executing the interrupt sequence Interrupt vector address Stack pointer (SP) value 16-Bit bus, without wait 8-Bit bus, without wait Even Even 18 cycles (Note 1) 20 cycles (Note 1) Even Odd 19 cycles (Note 1) 20 cycles (Note 1) Odd (Note 2) Even 19 cycles (Note 1) 20 cycles (Note 1) Odd (Note 2) Odd 20 cycles (Note 1) 20 cycles (Note 1) ________ Note 1: Add 2 cycles in the case of a DBC interrupt; add 1 cycle in the case either of an address coincidence interrupt or of a single-step interrupt. Note 2: Locate an interrupt vector address in an even address, if possible. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 BCLK Address bus Address 0000 Interrupt information Data bus R Indeterminate Indeterminate SP-2 SP-4 SP-2 contents SP-4 contents vec vec+2 vec contents PC vec+2 contents Indeterminate W The indeterminate segment is dependent on the queue buffer. If the queue buffer is ready to take an instruction, a read cycle occurs. Fig.DD-6 Time required for executing the interrupt sequence Variation of IPL when Interrupt Request is Accepted If an interrupt request is accepted, the interrupt priority level of the accepted interrupt is set in the IPL. If an interrupt request, that does not have an interrupt priority level, is accepted, one of the values shown in Table.DD-6 is set in the IPL. Table.DD-6 Relationship between interrupts without interrupt priority levels and IPL Interrupt sources without priority levels Value set in the IPL _______ Watchdog timer, NMI 7 Reset 0 Not changed Other Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 52 of 290 Interrupt M16C/6K9 Group Saving Registers In the interrupt sequence, only the contents of the flag register (FLG) and that of the program counter (PC) are saved in the stack area. First, the processor saves the four higher-order bits of the program counter, and 4 upper-order bits and 8 lower-order bits of the FLG register, 16 bits in total, in the stack area, then saves 16 lower-order bits of the program counter. Fig.DD-7 shows the state of the stack as it was before the acceptance of the interrupt request, and the state the stack after the acceptance of the interrupt request. Save other necessary registers at the beginning of the interrupt routine using software. Using the PUSHM instruction alone can save all the registers except the stack pointer (SP). Address MSB Stack area Address MSB LSB Stack area LSB m–4 m–4 Program counter (PCL) m–3 m–3 Program counter (PCM) m–2 m–2 Flag register (FLGL) m–1 m–1 m Content of previous stack m+1 Content of previous stack [SP] Stack pointer value before interrupt occurs Stack status before interrupt request is acknowledged Flag register (FLGH) [SP] New stack pointer value Program counter (PCH) m Content of previous stack m+1 Content of previous stack Stack status after interrupt request is acknowledged Fig.DD-7 State of stack before and after acceptance of interrupt request The operation of saving registers carried out in the interrupt sequence is dependent on whether the content of the stack pointer, at the time of acceptance of an interrupt request, is even or odd. If the content of the stack pointer (Note) is even, the content of the flag register (FLG) and the content of the program counter (PC) are saved, 16 bits at a time. If odd, their contents are saved in two steps, 8 bits at a time. Fig.DD-8 shows the operation of the saving registers. Note: Stack pointer is indicated by U flag when software number 32 - 63 INT command is executed, otherwise is indicated by ISP. (1) Stack pointer (SP) contains even number Stack area Address [SP] – 3 (Odd) Program counter (PCL) (2) Saved simultaneously, all 16 bits Program counter (PCM) [SP] – 2 (Even) Flag register (FLGL) [SP] – 1 (Odd) [SP] Address Stack area (1) Saved simultaneously, all 16 bits Flag register Program (FLGH) counter (PCH) [SP] – 4 (Odd) Program counter (PCL) [SP] – 3 (Even) Program counter (PCM) (4) [SP] – 2 (Odd) Flag register (FLGL) (1) [SP] – 1 (Even) Flag register (FLGH) [SP] (Even) Program counter (PCH) Note: [SP] denotes the initial value of the stack pointer (SP) when interrupt request is acknowledged. After registers are saved, the SP content is [SP] minus 4. Fig.DD-8 Operation of saving registers Jun 06, 2003 page 53 of 290 (3) Saved simultaneously, all 8 bits (2) (Odd) Finished saving registers in two operations. Rev.1.00 Sequence in which order registers are saved [SP] – 5 (Even) [SP] – 5 (Odd) [SP] – 4 (Even) (2) Stack pointer (SP) contains odd number Sequence in which order registers are saved Finished saving registers in four operations. M16C/6K9 Group Interrupt Returning from an Interrupt Routine Executing the REIT instruction at the end of an interrupt routine returns the contents of the flag register (FLG) as it was immediately before the start of interrupt sequence and the contents of the program counter (PC), both of which have been saved in the stack area. Then control returns to the program that was being executed before the acceptance of the interrupt request, so that the suspended process resumes. Return the other registers saved by software within the interrupt routine using the POPM or similar instruction before executing the REIT instruction. Interrupt Priority If there are two or more interrupt requests occurring at a point in time within a single sampling (checking whether interrupt requests are made), the interrupt assigned a higher priority is accepted. Assign an arbitrary priority to maskable interrupts (peripheral I/O interrupts) using the interrupt priority level select bits. If the same interrupt priority level is assigned, however, the interrupt with higher hardware priority is accepted. Priorities of the special interrupts, such as Reset (dealt with as an interrupt assigned the highest priority), watchdog timer interrupt, etc. are regulated by hardware. Fig.DD-9 shows the priorities of hardware interrupts. Software interrupts are not affected by the interrupt priority. If an instruction is executed, control branches invariably to the interrupt routine Interrupt priority level judgement circuit When two or more interrupts are generated simultaneously, this circuit selects the interrupt with the highest priority level. Fig.DD-10 shows the circuit that judges the interrupt priority level.. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 54 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group _______ Interrupt ________ Reset > NMI > DBC > Watchdog timer > Peripheral I/O > Single step > Address match Fig.DD-9 Hardware interrupts priorities Priority level of each interrupt Level 0 (initial value) INT1/PS21 High Timer B2/Key input interrupt 1 Timer B0/INT11/SCL0,SDA0 Timer A3/IBF2 Timer A1/INT7/SIO3 UART1 reception/SCL1,SDA1/INT10 UART0 reception/SCL0,SDA0/INT11 UART2 reception/ IBF1 INT2/PS22 INT0/PS20 Timer B1/INT10/SCL1,SDA1 Timer A4/IBF3 Timer A2 Timer A0 UART1 transmission/ I2C1 UART0 transmission/ I2C0 Priority of peripheral I/O interrupts (if priority levels are same) A-D conversion DMA1/INT7 Bus collision detection/INT4 SIO4/INT6 Timer B4/ UART1 reception/ SIO4 INT3 SCL2, SDA2/ DMA0 UART2 transmission/IBF0 Key input interrupt 0 INT8 SIO3/INT5 Timer B3/ UART1 transmission INT9 Timer B5/ LRESET I2C2 Processor interrupt priority level (IPL) Interrupt enable flag (I flag) Address match Watchdog timer DBC NMI Reset Note 1: I2C exist in M306K9FCLRP Fig.DD-10 Interrupt priority judgement circuit Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 55 of 290 Low (Note 1) To interrupt request level judgment output clock generation circuit (Fig. WA-3) Interrupt request accepted Interrupt M16C/6K9 Group ______ INT Interrupt Factor selection Numbers of interrupt factors share the same interrupt registers in the addresses of 004516, 004816 - 004C16, 004F16 - 005616, 005816 -005F16. The setting of interrupt factor selection bits of interrupt factor selection registers 0 - 3 (addresses of 035F16, 035616 - 035816) select the interrupt factor. After the selection of interrupt factor, the corresponding interrupt request bit must be "0" before enabling the interrupt. Fig.DD-11 - Fig.DD-13 show the structure of interrupt factor selection register 0 - 3. ______ INT Interrupt ________ ________ INT0 to INT11 are triggered by the edges of external inputs. The edge polarity can be selected using the polarity select bit. _______ _______ _______ ________ INT0 to INT2 and INT4 to INT11 have polarity switching bit in the interrupt event select register. The polarity ______ switching bit has to set to "0" when INT interrupt event is not selected. As for external interrupt input, an interrupt can be generated both at the rising edge and at the falling edge by ________ setting “1” in the INTi interrupt polarity switching bit of the interrupt factor selection register0,4 (035F16,035916). To select both edges, set the polarity switching bit of the corresponding interrupt control register to ‘falling edge’ (“0”). Fig.DD-11, Fig.DD-13 show the Interrupt factor selection register 0, 4. AAA AA A AAA AA A Interrupt factor selection register 0 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol IFSR0 Bit symbol Address 035F16 When reset 0016 Bit name Function IFSR00 INT0 interrupt polarity switching bit 0 : One edge 1 : Two edges IFSR01 INT1 interrupt polarity switching bit 0 : One edge 1 : Two edges IFSR02 INT2 interrupt polarity switching bit 0 : One edge 1 : Two edges IFSR03 INT3 interrupt polarity switching bit 0 : One edge 1 : Two edges IFSR04 INT4 interrupt polarity switching bit 0 : One edge 1 : Two edges IFSR05 INT5 interrupt polarity switching bit 0 : One edge 1 : Two edges IFSR06 Interrupt factor selection bit (Selecting interrupt factor in the address of 004916) 0 : SIO3 1 : INT5 (Note 1) IFSR07 Interrupt factor selection bit (Selecting interrupt factor in the address of 004816) 0 : SIO4 1 : INT6 (Note 2) AA A A A A A AA A AA AA AA A A A AA A AA R W Note 1: Do not select the bit if SIO3 is selected by interrupt factor selection register 3. Note 2: Do not select the bit if SIO4 is selected by interrupt factor selection register 5. Fig.DD-11 Interrupt factor selection register(1) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 56 of 290 Interrupt M16C/6K9 Group AA AA A AA AAAA A AA Interrupt factor selection register 1 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 0 b0 0 Symbol IFSR1 Bit symbol Address 035616 Bit name Reserved bit IFSR11 When reset 0016 Function Must be "0" Interrupt factor selection bit (Selecting interrupt factor in the address of 004A16) Reserved bit 0 : Bus collision detection 1 : INT4 Must be "0" IFSR13 Interrupt factor selection bit 0 : DMA1 (Selecting interrupt factor in the 1 : INT7 (Note 1) address of 004C16) IFSR14 Interrupt factor selection bit (Selecting interrupt factor in the address of 004F16) Interrupt factor selection bit (Selecting interrupt factor in the address of 005016) IFSR15 IFSR16 IFSR17 Interrupt factor selection bit (Selecting interrupt factor in the address of 005116) Interrupt factor selection bit (Selecting interrupt factor in the address of 005316) 0 : UART2 transmission 1 : IBF0 0 : UART2 reception 1 : IBF1 0 : UART0 transmission 1 : I2C0 R W AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A 0 : UART1 transmission (Note 2) 1 : I2C1 Note 1: Do not select the bit if INT7 is selected by interrupt factor selection register 3. Note 2: Do not select the bit if UART1 transmission is selected by interrupt factor selection register 5. AA AA A AA AAAA A AA Interrupt factor selection register 2 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol IFSR2 Bit symbol IFSR20 IFSR21 IFSR22 IFSR23 IFSR24 IFSR25 IFSR26 IFSR27 Address 035716 When reset 0016 Bit name Interrupt factor selection bit (Selecting interrupt factor in the address of 005216) Interrupt factor selection bit (Selecting interrupt factor in the address of 005416) Interrupt factor selection bit (Selecting interrupt factor in the address of 005A16) Interrupt factor selection bit (Selecting interrupt factor in the address of 005B16) Function b1 b0 0 0 : UART0 reception 0 1 : SCL0,SDA0 (Note1) 1 0 : INT11 (Note1) 1 1 : Inhibited b3 b2 AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A R W 0 0 : UART1 reception (Note 2) 0 1 : SCL1,SDA1 (Note1) 1 0 : INT10 (Note1) 1 1 : Inhibited b5 b4 0 0 : Timer B0 0 1 : INT11 (Note1) 1 0 : SCL0,SDA0 (Note1) 1 1 : Inhibited b7 b6 0 0 : Timer B1 0 1 : INT10 (Note1) 1 0 : SCL1,SDA1 (Note1) 1 1 : Inhibited Note1 : Do not select INT10, INT11, SCL0, SDA0, SCL1, SDA1 simultaneously in the interrupt control registers. Note 2: Do not select the bit if UART1 reception is selected by interrupt factor selection register 5. Fig.DD-12 Interrupt factor selection register(2) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 57 of 290 Interrupt M16C/6K9 Group AA A AA A AAAA AA Interrupt factor selection register 3 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol IFSR3 Address 035816 Bit symbol Bit name IFSR30 Interrupt factor selection bits (Selecting interrupt factor in the address of 005616) IFSR31 IFSR32 IFSR33 IFSR34 IFSR35 IFSR36 IFSR37 Interrupt factor selection bit (Selecting interrupt factor in the address of 005816) Interrupt factor selection bit (Selecting interrupt factor in the address of 005916) Interrupt factor selection bit (Selecting interrupt factor in the address of 005C16) Interrupt factor selection bit (Selecting interrupt factor in the address of 005D16) Interrupt factor selection bit (Selecting interrupt factor in the address of 005E16) Interrupt factor selection bit (Selecting interrupt factor in the address of 005F16) When reset 0016 Function b1 b0 0 0 : Timer A1 0 1 : INT7 (Note 1) 1 0 : SIO3 (Note 2) 1 1 : Inhibited 0 : Timer A3 1 : IBF2 0 : Timer A4 1 : IBF3 0 : Timer B2 1 : Key input interrupt 1 0 : INT0 1 : PS20 0 : INT1 1 : PS21 0 : INT2 1 : PS22 AA AA A A A A AA AA A A A A A A AA R W Note 1: Do not select the bit if INT7 are selected by interrupt factor selection register 1. Note 2: Do not select the bit if SIO3 is selected by interrupt factor selection register 0. Interrupt factor selection register 4 AAAA b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol IFSR4 0 0 Bit symbol Address 035916 Bit name INT6 Interrupt polarity switching bit 0 : One edge 1 : Two edges IFSR41 INT7 Interrupt polarity switching bit 0 : One edge 1 : Two edges IFSR42 INT8 Interrupt polarity switching bit 0 : One edge 1 : Two edges IFSR43 INT9 Interrupt polarity switching bit 0 : One edge 1 : Two edges IFSR44 INT10 Interrupt polarity switching bit 0 : One edge 1 : Two edges IFSR45 INT11 Interrupt polarity switching bit 0 : One edge 1 : Two edges Fig.DD-13 Interrupt factor selection register(3) Jun 06, 2003 Function IFSR40 Reserved bits Rev.1.00 When reset 0016 page 58 of 290 Must be "0" AA A A A A AA AA AA A A AA R W Interrupt M16C/6K9 Group AA A AA A AAA AA A Interrupt factor selection register 5 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 0 0 0 b2 b1 b0 Symbol IFSR 5 Bit symbol Address 035A16 When reset 0016 Bit name Function AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A IFSR50 Interrupt factor selection bit 0 : SCL2,SDA2 (Selecting interrupt factor in the 1 : DMA0 address of 004216) IFSR51 Interrupt factor selection bit 0 : Timer B5 (Selecting interrupt factor in the 1 : LRESET address of 004316) IFSR52 b1 b0 Interrupt factor selection bit (Selecting interrupt factor in the 0 0 : Timer B4 0 1 : UART1 reception (Note 1) address of 004616) 1 0 : SIO4(Note 2) 1 1 : Inhibited IFSR53 IFSR54 R W Interrupt factor selection bit 0 : Timer B3 (Selecting interrupt factor in the 1 : UART1 transmission (Note 3) address of 004716) Reserved bits Must be "0" Note 1. Do not select the bit if UART1 reception is selected by interrupt factor selection register 2. Note 2. Do not select the bit if SIO4 is selected by interrupt factor selection register 0. Note 3. Do not select the bit if UART1 transmission is selected by interrupt factor selection register 1. Fig. DD-14 Interrupt factor selection register(4) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 59 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Interrupt ________ NMI Interrupt ______ NMI Interrupt ______ ______ ______ An NMI interrupt is generated when the input to the P85/NMI pin changes from “H” to “L”. The NMI interrupt is a non-maskable external interrupt. The pin level can be checked in the port P85 register (bit 5 at address 03F016). This pin cannot be used as a normal port input. Key Input Interrupt 0 If the direction register of any of P50 to P57 is set for input and a falling edge is input to that port, a key input interrupt 0 is generated. A key input interrupt 0 can also be used as a key-on wakeup function for cancelling the wait mode or stop mode. Fig.DD-14 shows the block diagram of the key input interrupt 0. Note that if an “L” level is input to any pin that has not been disabled for input, inputs to the other pins are not detected as an interrupt. Pull-up select bit Pull-up transistor Key input interrupt 0 control register (address 004D16) Port P57 direction register Port P57 direction register P57/KI07 Pull-up transistor Port P56 direction register P56/KI06 Interrupt control circuit Pull-up transistor Port P55 direction register P55/KI05 Pull-up transistor Port P54 direction register P54/KI04 Pull-up transistor Port P53 direction register P53/KI03 Pull-up transistor Port P52 direction register P52/KI02 Pull-up transistor Port P51 direction register P51/KI01 Pull-up transistor Port P50 direction register P50/KI00 Fig.DD-15 Block diagram of key input interrupt 0 Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 60 of 290 Key input interrupt 0 request Interrupt M16C/6K9 Group Key Input Interrupt 1 If any of the bits of key input interrupt 1 enable register (Address: 02F416) are set to “1”, the key input interrupt 1 request occurs when a falling or a rising edge is input to one of the corresponding pins. The effective input edge of key input interrupt 1 is determined by the edge selection bit of key input interrupt 1 edge selection register (Address: 02F516). When the bit is set to “0”, at the falling edge, when the bit is set to “1”, at the rising edge of the input signal to the corresponding pin, the interrupt request occurs respectively. When an effective rising edge or falling edge is input, “1” is set to the corresponding bit of P14 event register (Address: 02F616). By reading the register after the interrupt occurs, the pin, which the effective edge is input, can be confirmed even if the status of that pin has been changed. At the completion of the reading of P14 event register, the bits, whose value is “1” in reading, will be cleared automatically. A dummy write clears the register too. The registers, the block diagram and the timing of key input interrupt 1 are shown in Fig. DD-17, Fig. DD-18 and Fig. DD-19 respectively. After changing the effective edge by modifying key input interrupt 1 edge selection register, the value of P14 event register and interrupt request bit may become “1”. A dummy write to the P14 event register and a clear to the interrupt request bit should be done after changing the effective edge. Same as key input interrupt edge selection register, when enabling/disabling key input interrupt 1 by setting key input interrupt 1 enable register, the value of P14 event register and interrupt request bit may become “1”. A dummy write to the P14 event register and a clear to the interrupt request bit should be done after the setting of enabling/disabling. P14 event register AA A AA AA AAAA AAA b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol KIN1EV Bit symbol Address 02F616 When reset 0016 Bit name Function KIN1EV0 P14 event bit0 0 : Without event 1 : with an event KIN1EV1 P14 event bit1 0 : Without event 1 : with an event KIN1EV2 P14 event bit2 0 : Without event 1 : with an event KIN1EV3 P14 event bit3 0 : Without event 1 : with an event KIN1EV4 P14 event bit4 0 : Without event 1 : with an event KIN1EV5 P14 event bit5 0 : Without event 1 : with an event KIN1EV6 P14 event bit6 0 : Without event 1 : with an event KIN1EV7 P14 event bit7 0 : Without event 1 : with an event Note : The register is "0" cleared by dummy write. Fig.DD-16 P14 event register Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 61 of 290 A A A A A A A A A A R W(Note) Interrupt M16C/6K9 Group AAA Key input interrupt 1 enable register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol KIN1EN Address 02F416 Bit Symbol AAA When reset 0016 Bit name Function KIN1EN0 0 : Disable Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 0 1 : Enable KIN1EN1 0 : Disable Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 1 1 : Enable KIN1EN2 0 : Disable Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 2 1 : Enable KIN1EN3 0 : Disable Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 3 1 : Enable KIN1EN4 0 : Disable Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 4 1 : Enable KIN1EN5 0 : Disable Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 5 1 : Enable KIN1EN6 Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 6 0 : Disable 1 : Enable KIN1EN7 Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 7 0 : Disable 1 : Enable AA A A A A AA AA AA AA AA AA R W Key input interrupt 1 edge selection register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol KIN1SEL Address 02F516 Bit Symbol Bit name Jun 06, 2003 Function KIN1SEL0 Key input interrupt 1 edge selection bit 0 0 : Falling edge 1 : Rising edge KIN1SEL1 Key input interrupt 1 edge selection bit 1 0 : Falling edge 1 : Rising edge KIN1SEL2 Key input interrupt 1 edge selection bit 2 0 : Falling edge 1 : Rising edge KIN1SEL3 Key input interrupt 1 edge selection bit 3 0 : Falling edge 1 : Rising edge KIN1SEL4 Key input interrupt 1 edge selection bit 4 0 : Falling edge 1 : Rising edge KIN1SEL5 Key input interrupt 1 edge selection bit 5 0 : Falling edge 1 : Rising edge KIN1SEL6 Key input interrupt 1 edge selection bit 6 0 : Falling edge 1 : Rising edge KIN1SEL7 Key input interrupt 1 edge selection bit 7 0 : Falling edge 1 : Rising edge Fig.DD-17 Key input interrupt 1 registers Rev.1.00 When reset 0016 page 62 of 290 AA A A A A AA AA AA AA AA AA R W Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 63 of 290 Fig.DD-18 The block diagram of key input interrupt 1 P140/KI10 P141/KI11 P142/KI12 P143/KI13 P144/KI14 P145/KI15 P146/KI16 P147/KI17 Pull-up transistor Pull-up transistor Pull-up transistor Pull-up transistor Pull-up transistor Pull-up transistor Pull-up transistor Pull-up transistor Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 0 Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 1 Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 2 Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 3 Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 4 Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 5 Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 6 Key input interrupt 1 enable bit 7 Edge selection one-shot generation circuit Key input interrupt 1 edge selection bit0 Edge selection one-shot generation circuit Key input interrupt 1 edge selection bit1 Edge selection one-shot generation circuit Key input interrupt 1 edge selection bit2 Edge selection one-shot generation circuit Key input interrupt 1 edge selection bit3 Edge selection one-shot generation circuit Key input interrupt 1 edge selection bit4 Edge selection one-shot generation circuit Key input interrupt 1 edge selection bit5 Edge selection one-shot generation circuit Key input interrupt 1 edge selection bit6 Edge selection one-shot generation circuit Key input interrupt 1 edge selection bit7 P147 direction register Pull-up selection bit Q R D The write to address 02F616 The read from address 02F616 P140 event latch circuit The write to address 02F616 The read from address 02F616 P141 event latch circuit The write to address 02F616 The read from address 02F616 P142 event latch circuit The write to address 02F616 The read from address 02F616 P143 event latch circuit The write to address 02F616 The read from address 02F616 P144 event latch circuit The write to address 02F616 The read from address 02F616 P145 event latch circuit The write to address 02F616 The read from address 02F616 P146 event latch circuit Delay circuit RESET The read from address 02F616 P147 event latch circuit Interrupt control circuit D R DB0 The read from address 02F616 DB1 The read from address 02F616 DB2 The read from address 02F616 DB3 The read from address 02F616 DB4 The read from address 02F616 DB5 The read from address 02F616 DB6 The read from address 02F616 Q Event register The read from address 02F616 Q The read from address 02F616 R S Event data Key input interrupt 1 request Key input interrupt 1 control register (Address 005C16) The read from address 02F616 DB7 M16C/6K9 Group Interrupt Interrupt M16C/6K9 Group P140 P141 (Note 1) P140 request P141 request Interrupt request bit P140 event data (Note 2) P141 event data P14 event register 0016 0116 0316 0016 The read signal from 02F616 The read from 02F616 0116 Interrupt procession 0316 Interrupt procession 0016 Interrupt procession Note 1: If there are several effective edge inputs, the input sequential order can not be confirmed. Note 2: If another interrupt request occurs between the setting of prior key input interrupt 1 request bit and the read of P14 event register, the interrupt request bit will be set again same as P14 event register. After the read of P14 event register, both the bits, which were set to “1”, will be automatically cleared. However, the interrupt processing will be executed twice because of the re-setting of interrupt request bit (the value of P14 event register in the 2nd reading will be “0”). Fig.DD-19 The timing of key input interrupt 1 Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 64 of 290 Interrupt M16C/6K9 Group Address Match Interrupt An address match interrupt is generated when the address match interrupt address register contents match the program counter value. Two address match interrupts can be set, each of which can be enabled and disabled by an address match interrupt enable bit. Address match interrupts are not affected by the interrupt enable flag (I flag) and processor interrupt priority level (IPL). The stacked value of the program counter (PC) for an address match interrupt varies depending on the instruction being executed. Fig.DD-20 shows the address match interrupt-related registers. Address match interrupt enable register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol AIER Address 000916 When reset XXXXXX002 A AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA A AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA Bit symbol Bit name Function AIER0 Address match interrupt 0 enable bit 0 : Interrupt disabled 1 : Interrupt enabled AIER1 Address match interrupt 1 enable bit 0 : Interrupt disabled 1 : Interrupt enabled RW Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate. Address match interrupt register i (i = 0, 1) (b23) b7 (b19) b3 (b16)(b15) b0 b7 (b8) b0 b7 b0 Symbol RMAD0 RMAD1 Address 001216 to 001016 001616 to 001416 Function Address setting register for address match interrupt When reset X0000016 X0000016 0000016 to FFFFF16 Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate. Fig.DD-20 Address match interrupt-related registers Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 65 of 290 A A Values that can be set R W M16C/6K9 Group Interrupt Precautions for Interrupts (1) Reading address 0000016 • When maskable interrupt is occurred, CPU read the interrupt information (the interrupt number and interrupt request level) in the interrupt sequence. The interrupt request bit of the certain interrupt written in address 0000016 will then be set to “0”. Reading address 0000016 by software sets the request bit, which the interrupt source is enabled with the highest priority, to “0”. Though the interrupt is generated, the interrupt routine may not be executed. Hence do not read address 0000016 by software. (2) Setting the stack pointer • The value of the stack pointer is initialized to 0000 16 right after the reset. Accepting an interrupt before setting a value in the stack pointer may become a factor of runaway. Be sure to set a value in the _______ stack pointer before accepting an interrupt. When using the NMI interrupt, initialize the stack point at the beginning of a program. Concerning the first instruction immediately after reset, generating any interrupts _______ including the NMI interrupt is prohibited. _______ (3) The NMI interrupt _______ • As for the NMI interrupt pin, an interrupt cannot be disabled. Connect it to the Vcc pin via a resistor (pullup) if unused. Be sure to work on it. _______ • The NMI pin also serves as P85, which is exclusively input. Reading the contents of the P8 register allows reading the pin value. Use the reading of this pin only for establishing the pin level at the time _______ when the NMI interrupt is input. _______ • Do not reset the CPU with the input to the NMI pin being in the “L” state. _______ • Do not attempt to go into stop mode with the input to the NMI pin being in the “L” state. With the input to the _______ NMI being in the “L” state, the CM10 is fixed to “0”, so attempting to go into stop mode is turned down. _______ • Do not attempt to go into wait mode with the input to the NMI pin being in the “L” state. With the input to the _______ NMI pin being in the “L” state, the CPU stops but the oscillation does not stop, so no power is saved. In this instance, the CPU is returned to the normal state by a later interrupt. _______ • Signals input to the NMI pin require an "L" level of 1 clock or more, from the operation clock of the CPU. (4) External interrupt ________ • Either an “L” level or an “H” level of at least 380 ns width is necessary for the signal input to pins INT0 _________ through INT11 regardless of the CPU operation clock. ________ _________ • When the polarity of the INT0 to INT11 pins is changed, the interrupt request bit is sometimes set to "1". After changing the polarity, set the interrupt request bit to "0". Fig.DD-21 shows the procedure for changing ______ the INT interrupt generate factor. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 66 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Interrupt Clear the interrupt enable flag to “0” (Disable interrupt) Set the interrupt priority level to level 0 (Disable INTi interrupt) Set the polarity select bit Clear the interrupt request bit to “0” Set the interrupt priority level to level 1 to 7 (Enable the accepting of INTi interrupt request) Set the interrupt enable flag to “1” (Enable interrupt) ______ Fig.DD-21 Switching condition of INT interrupt request (5) Rewrite the interrupt control register • To rewrite the interrupt control register, do so at a point that does not generate the interrupt request for that register. If there is possibility of the interrupt request occurs, rewrite the interrupt control register after the interrupt is disabled. The program examples are described as follow: • When a instruction to rewrite the interrupt control register is executed when the interrupt is disabled, the Example 1: INT_SWITCH1: FCLR I AND.B #00h, 0055h NOP NOP FSET I ; Disable interrupts. ; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit. ; Four NOP instructions are required when using HOLD function. ; Enable interrupts. Example 2: INT_SWITCH2: FCLR I AND.B #00h, 0055h MOV.W MEM, R0 FSET I ; Disable interrupts. ; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit. ; Dummy read. ; Enable interrupts. Example 3: INT_SWITCH3: PUSHC FLG FCLR I AND.B #00h, 0055h POPC FLG ; Push Flag register onto stack ; Disable interrupts. ; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit. ; Enable interrupts. The reason why two NOP instructions (four when using the HOLD function) or dummy read are inserted before FSET I in Examples 1 and 2 is to prevent the interrupt enable flag I from being set before the interrupt control register is rewritten due to effects of the instruction queue. interrupt request bit is not set sometimes even if the interrupt request for that register has been generated. This will depend on the instruction. If this creates problems, use the below instructions to change the register. Instructions : AND, OR, BCLR, BSET Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 67 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Watchdog Timer Watchdog Timer The watchdog timer has the function of detecting when the program is out of control. The watchdog timer is a 15-bit counter which down-counts the clock derived by dividing the BCLK using the prescaler. A watchdog timer interrupt is generated when an underflow occurs in the watchdog timer. When XIN is selected for the BCLK, bit 7 of the watchdog timer control register (address 000F16) selects the prescaler division ratio (by 16 or by 128). When XCIN is selected as the BCLK, the prescaler is set for division by 2 regardless of bit 7 of the watchdog timer control register (address 000F16). Thus the watchdog timer's period can be calculated as given below. The watchdog timer's period is, however, subject to an error due to the prescaler. With XIN chosen for BCLK Watchdog timer period = prescaler dividing ratio (16 or 128) X watchdog timer count (32768) BCLK With XCIN chosen for BCLK Watchdog timer period = prescaler dividing ratio (2) X watchdog timer count (32768) BCLK For example, suppose that BCLK runs at 16 MHz and that 16 has been chosen for the dividing ratio of the prescaler, then the watchdog timer's period becomes approximately 32.7 ms. The watchdog timer is initialized by writing to the watchdog timer start register (address 000E16) and when a watchdog timer interrupt request is generated. The prescaler is initialized only when the microcomputer is reset. After a reset is cancelled, the watchdog timer and prescaler are both stopped. The count is started by writing to the watchdog timer start register (address 000E16). Fig.DG-1 shows the block diagram of the watchdog timer. Fig.DG-2 shows the watchdog timer-related registers. Prescaler 1/16 BCLK 1/128 “CM07 = 0” “WDC7 = 0” “CM07 = 0” “WDC7 = 1” Watchdog timer HOLD “CM07 = 1” 1/2 Write to the watchdog timer start register (address 000E16) Set to “7FFF16” RESET Fig.DG-1 Block diagram of watchdog timer Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 68 of 290 Watchdog timer interrupt request Watchdog Timer M16C/6K9 Group Watchdog timer control register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol WDC 0 0 Bit symbol Address 000F16 When reset 000XXXXX2 Bit name Function High-order bit of watchdog timer Reserved bit Must always be set to “0” Reserved bit Must always be set to “0” WDC7 Prescaler select bit 0 : Divided by 16 1 : Divided by 128 AA AA A AA A AA A R W Watchdog timer start register b7 b0 Symbol WDTS Address 000E16 When reset Indeterminate Function The watchdog timer is initialized and starts counting after a write instruction to this register. The watchdog timer value is always initialized to “7FFF16” regardless of whatever value is written. Fig.DG-2 Watchdog timer control and start registers Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 69 of 290 A RW M16C/6K9 Group DMAC DMAC This microcomputer has two DMAC (direct memory access controller) channels that allow data to be sent to memory without using the CPU. DMAC shares the same data bus with the CPU. The DMAC is given a higher right of using the bus than the CPU, which leads to working the cycle stealing method. On this account, the operation from the occurrence of DMA transfer request signal to the completion of 1-word (16-bit) or 1-byte (8-bit) data transfer can be performed at high speed. Fig.EC-1 shows the block diagram of the DMAC. Table.EC-1 shows the DMAC specifications. Fig.EC-2 to EC-4 show the registers used by the DMAC. AA AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA A AAAAAAA AA A AA AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA A AA A AAA A AAA AAA A AA AAA A AA AA AA AAA AA A A AA AA A A AAAA A AA AA A AA A AA AA A A AA A AA AA A A A AA A A AA AA Address bus DMA0 source pointer SAR0(20) (addresses 002216 to 002016) DMA0 destination pointer DAR0 (20) (addresses 002616 to 002416) DMA0 forward address pointer (20) (Note) DMA0 transfer counter reload register TCR0 (16) DMA1 source pointer SAR1 (20) (addresses 003216 to 003016) (addresses 002916, 002816) DMA0 transfer counter TCR0 (16) DMA1 destination pointer DAR1 (20) DMA1 transfer counter reload register TCR1 (16) DMA1 forward address pointer (20) (Note) (addresses 003616 to 003416) (addresses 003916, 003816) DMA1 transfer counter TCR1 (16) Data bus low-order bits Data bus high-order bits DMA latch high-order bits DMA latch low-order bits AA AA Note: Pointer is incremented by a DMA request. Fig.EC-1 Block diagram of DMAC Either a write signal to the software DMA request bit or an interrupt request signal is used as a DMA transfer request signal. But the DMA transfer is affected neither by the interrupt enable flag (I flag) nor by the interrupt priority level. The DMA transfer doesn't affect any interrupts neither. If the DMAC is active (the DMA enable bit is set to 1), data transfer starts every time a DMA transfer request signal occurs. If the cycle of the occurrences of DMA transfer request signals is higher than the DMA transfer cycle, there can be instances in which the number of transfer requests doesn't agree with the number of transfers. For details, see the description of the DMA request bit. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 70 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group DMAC Table.EC-1 DMAC specifications Item Specification No. of channels 2 (cycle steal method) Transfer memory space • From any address in the 1M bytes space to a fixed address • From a fixed address to any address in the 1M bytes space • From a fixed address to a fixed address (Note that DMA-related registers [002016 to 003F16] cannot be accessed) Maximum No. of bytes transferred 128K bytes (with 16-bit transfers) or 64K bytes (with 8-bit transfers) ________ ________ DMA request factors (Note) Falling edge of INT0 or INT1 or both edge Timer A0 to timer A4 interrupt requests Timer B0 to timer B5 interrupt requests UART0 transfer and reception interrupt requests UART1 transfer and reception interrupt requests UART2 transfer and reception interrupt requests Serial I/O3, 4 interrupt requests A-D conversion interrupt requests IBF0 to IBF3 interrupt requests Software triggers Channel priority DMA0 takes precedence if DMA0 and DMA1 requests are generated simultaneously Transfer unit 8 bits or 16 bits Transfer address direction forward/fixed (forward direction cannot be specified for both source and destination simultaneously) Transfer mode • Single transfer mode After the transfer counter underflows, the DMA enable bit turns to “0”, and the DMAC turns inactive • Repeat transfer mode After the transfer counter underflows, the value of the transfer counter reload register is reloaded to the transfer counter. The DMAC remains active unless a “0” is written to the DMA enable bit. DMA interrupt request generation timing When an underflow occurs in the transfer counter Active When the DMA enable bit is set to “1”, the DMAC is active. When the DMAC is active, data transfer starts every time a DMA transfer request signal occurs. Inactive • When the DMA enable bit is set to “0”, the DMAC is inactive. • After the transfer counter underflows in single transfer mode At the time of starting data transfer immediately after turning the DMAC active, the Forward address pointer and value of one of source pointer and destination pointer - the one specified for the reload timing for transfer forward direction - is reloaded to the forward direction address pointer, and the value counter of the transfer counter reload register is reloaded to the transfer counter. Writing to register Registers specified for forward direction transfer are always write enabled. Registers specified for fixed address transfer are write-enabled when the DMA enable bit is “0”. Reading the register Can be read at any time. However, when the DMA enable bit is “1”, reading the register set up as the forward register is the same as reading the value of the forward address pointer. Note: DMA transfer is not effective to any interrupt. DMA transfer is affected neither by the interrupt enable flag (I flag) nor by the interrupt priority level. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 71 of 290 DMAC M16C/6K9 Group DMA0 request factor selection register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol DM0SL b0 Bit symbol DSEL0 Address 03B816 When reset 0016 Function Bit name DMA request factor selection bits DSEL1 DSEL2 DSEL3 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 : Falling edge of INT0 pin 0 0 0 1 : Software trigger 0 0 1 0 : Timer A0 0 0 1 1 : Timer A1 0 1 0 0 : Timer A2 0 1 0 1 : Timer A3 0 1 1 0 : Timer A4 (DMS=0) /two edges of INT0 pin (DMS=1) 0 1 1 1 : Timer B0 (DMS=0) Timer B3 (DMS=1) 1 0 0 0 : Timer B1 (DMS=0) Timer B4 (DMS=1) 1 0 0 1 : Timer B2 (DMS=0) Timer B5 (DMS=1) 1 0 1 0 : UART0 transmit (DMS=0) /IBF0(DMS=1) 1 0 1 1 : UART0 receive (DMS=0) /IBF1(DMS=1) 1 1 0 0 : UART2 transmit (DMS=0) /IBF2(DMS=1) 1 1 0 1 : UART2 receive(DMS=0) /IBF3(DMS=1) 1 1 1 0 : A-D conversion 1 1 1 1 : UART1 transmit Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”. DMS DMA request factor expansion bit 0 : Normal 1 : Expanded factor DSR Software DMA request bit If software trigger is selected, a DMA request is generated by setting this bit to “1” (When read, the value of this bit is always “0”) Fig.EC-2 DMAC register (1) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 72 of 290 AAA A AA AA AA AA R W AA AA DMAC M16C/6K9 Group DMA1 request factor selection register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol DM1SL b0 Address 03BA16 Function Bit name Bit symbol DSEL0 When reset 0016 DMA request factor selection bits DSEL1 DSEL2 DSEL3 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 : Falling edge of INT1 pin 0 0 0 1 : Software trigger 0 0 1 0 : Timer A0 0 0 1 1 : Timer A1 0 1 0 0 : Timer A2 0 1 0 1 : Timer A3(DMS=0) /serial I/O3 (DMS=1) 0 1 1 0 : Timer A4 (DMS=0) /serial I/O4 (DMS=1) 0 1 1 1 : Timer B0 (DMS=0) /two edges of INT1 (DMS=1) 1 0 0 0 : Timer B1 1 0 0 1 : Timer B2 1 0 1 0 : UART0 transmit (DMS=0) /IBF0(DMS=1) 1 0 1 1 : UART0 receive (DMS=0) /IBF1(DMS=1) 1 1 0 0 : UART2 transmit(DMS=0) /IBF2(DMS=1) 1 1 0 1 : UART2 receive(DMS=0) /IBF3(DMS=1) 1 1 1 0 : A-D conversion 1 1 1 1 : UART1 receive Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”. DMS DMA request factor expansion bit 0 : Normal 1 : Expanded factor DSR Software DMA request bit If software trigger is selected, a DMA request is generated by setting this bit to “1” (When read, the value of this bit is always “0”) AA A A AA AA AA R W AA AA DMAi control register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol DMiCON(i=0,1) b0 Address 002C16, 003C16 When reset 00000X002 Bit symbol Bit name DMBIT Transfer unit bit select bit 0 : 16 bits 1 : 8 bits DMASL Repeat transfer mode select bit 0 : Single transfer 1 : Repeat transfer DMAS DMA request bit (Note 1) 0 : DMA not requested 1 : DMA requested DMA enable bit 0 : Disabled 1 : Enabled DSD Source address direction select bit (Note 3) 0 : Fixed 1 : Forward DAD Destination address 0 : Fixed direction select bit (Note 3) 1 : Forward DMAE Function Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”. AA AA AA AA AA A A AA R W (Note 2) Note 1: DMA request can be cleared by resetting the bit to "0". Note 2: This bit can only be set to “0”. Note 3: Source address direction select bit and destination address direction select bit cannot be set to “1” simultaneously. Fig.EC-3 DMAC register (2) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 73 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group DMAC DMAi source pointer (i = 0, 1) (b23) b7 (b19) b3 (b16)(b15) b0 b7 (b8) b0 b7 b0 Symbol SAR0 SAR1 Address 002216 to 002016 003216 to 003016 When reset Indeterminate Indeterminate Transfer count specification Function • Source pointer Stores the source address A RW 0000016 to FFFFF16 Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”. DMAi destination pointer (i = 0, 1) (b23) b7 (b19) b3 (b16) (b15) b0 b7 (b8) b0 b7 b0 Symbol DAR0 DAR1 Address 002616 to 002416 003616 to 003416 When reset Indeterminate Indeterminate Transfer count specification Function • Destination pointer Stores the destination address 0000016 to FFFFF16 Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”. A RW DMAi transfer counter (i = 0, 1) (b15) b7 (b8) b0 b7 b0 Symbol TCR0 TCR1 Address 002916, 002816 003916, 003816 Function • Transfer counter Set a value one less than the transfer count Fig.EC-4 DMAC register (3) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 74 of 290 When reset Indeterminate Indeterminate Transfer count specification 000016 to FFFF16 A R W M16C/6K9 Group DMAC (1) Transfer cycle The transfer cycle consists of the bus cycle in which data is read from memory or from the SFR area (source read) and the bus cycle in which the data is written to memory or to the SFR area (destination write). The number of read and write bus cycles depends on the source and destination addresses. * Effect of source and destination addresses When 16-bit data is transferred on a 16-bit data bus, and the source and destination both start at odd addresses, there are one more source read cycle and destination write cycle than when the source and destination both start at even addresses. Fig.EC-5 shows the example of the transfer cycles for a source read. For convenience, the destination write cycle is shown as one cycle and the source read cycles for the different conditions are shown. In reality, the destination write cycle is subject to the same conditions as the source read cycle, with the transfer cycle changing accordingly. When calculating the transfer cycle, remember to apply the respective conditions to both the destination write cycle and the source read cycle. (2) DMAC transfer cycles Any combination of even or odd transfer read and write addresses is possible. Table.EC-2 shows the number of DMAC transfer cycles. The number of DMAC transfer cycles can be calculated as follows: No. of transfer cycles per transfer unit = No. of read cycles x j + No. of write cycles x k Table.EC-2 No. of DMAC transfer cycles Transfer unit Bus width Access address 8-bit transfers (DMBIT= “1”) 16-bit transfers (DMBIT= “0”) 16-bit (BYTE= “L”) 16-bit (BYTE= “L”) Even Odd Even Odd Coefficient j, k Internal memory Internal ROM/RAM Internal ROM/RAM No wait With wait 1 2 Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 75 of 290 SFR area 2 Single-chip mode No. of read No. of write cycles cycles 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 DMAC M16C/6K9 Group (1) 8-bit transfers 16-bit transfers from even address and the source address is even. BCLK Address bus CPU use Source Destination Dummy cycle CPU use RD signal WR signal Data bus CPU use Source Destination Dummy cycle CPU use (2) One wait is inserted into the source read under the conditions in (1) BCLK Address bus CPU use Source Destination Dummy cycle CPU use RD signal WR signal Data bus CPU use Source Destination Dummy cycle CPU use Note: The same thing changes occur with the respective conditions at the destination as at the source. Fig.EC-5 Example of the transfer cycles for a source read Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 76 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group DMAC DMA enable bit Setting the DMA enable bit to "1" makes the DMAC active. The DMAC carries out the following operations at the time data transfer starts immediately after DMAC is turned active. (1) Reloads the value of one of the source pointer and the destination pointer - the one specified for the forward direction - to the forward direction address pointer. (2) Reloads the value of the transfer counter reload register to the transfer counter. Thus overwriting "1" to the DMA enable bit with the DMAC being active carries out the operations given above, so the DMAC operates again from the initial state at the instant "1" is overwritten to the DMA enable bit. DMA request bit The DMAC can generate a DMA transfer request signal triggered by a factor chosen in advance out of DMA request factors for each channel. DMA request factors include the following. * Factors effected by using the interrupt request signals from the built-in peripheral functions and software DMA factors (internal factors) effected by a program. * External factors effected by utilizing the input from external interrupt signals. For the selection of DMA request factors, see the descriptions of the DMAi factor selection register. The DMA request bit turns to "1" if the DMA transfer request signal occurs regardless of the DMAC's state (regardless of whether the DMA enable bit is set "1" or to "0"). It turns to "0" immediately before data transfer starts. In addition, it can be set to "0" by use of a program, but cannot be set to "1". There can be instances in which a change in DMA request factor selection bit causes the DMA request bit to turn to "1". So be sure to set the DMA request bit to "0" after the DMA request factor selection bit is changed. The DMA request bit turns to "1" if a DMA transfer request signal occurs, and turns to "0" immediately just before data transfer starts. If the DMAC is active, data transfer starts immediately, so the value of the DMA request bit, if read by use of a program, turns out to be "0" in most cases. To examine whether the DMAC is active, read the DMA enable bit. Here follows the timing of changes in the DMA request bit. (1) Internal factors Except the DMA request factors triggered by software, the timing for the DMA request bit to turn to "1" due to an internal factor is the same as the timing for the interrupt request bit of the interrupt control register to turn to "1" due to several factors. Turning the DMA request bit to "0" due to an internal factor is timed to be effected immediately just before the transfer starts. (2) External factors An external factor is a factor caused to occur by the edge of input from the INTi pin (i depends on which DMAC channel is used). Selecting the INTi pins as external factors using the DMA request factor selection bit causes input from these pins to become the DMA transfer request signals. The timing for the DMA request bit to turn to "1" when an external factor is selected synchronizes with the signal's edge applicable to the function specified by the DMA request factor selection bit (synchronizes with the falling edge of the input signal to each INTi pin, for example). With an external factor selected, the DMA request bit is timed to turn to "0" immediately just before data transfer starts similarly to the state in which an internal factor is selected. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 77 of 290 DMAC M16C/6K9 Group (3) The priorities of channels and DMA transfer timing If a DMA transfer request signal falls on the same sampling cycle (a sampling cycle means one period from the rising edge to the falling edge of BCLK), the DMA request bits of applicable channels concurrently turn to "1". If the channels are active at that moment, DMA0 is given a high priority to start data transfer. When DMA0 finishes data transfer, it gives the bus right to the CPU. When the CPU finishes single bus access, then DMA1 starts data transfer and gives the bus right to the CPU. An example in which DMA transfer is carried out in minimum cycles at the time when DMA transfer request signals due to external factors concurrently occur. Fig.EC-6 An example of DMA transfer effected by external factors. An example in which DMA transmission is carried out in minimum cycles at the time when DMA transmission request signals due to external factors concurrently occur. BCLK DMA0 DMA1 CPU INT0 AAAA AAAA AAAAAA AAA AAAAAA AA AAAAAA AAA AAAAAA AA Obtaining the bus right DMA0 request bit INT1 DMA1 request bit Fig.EC-6 An example of DMA transfer effected by external factors Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 78 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Timer Timer There are eleven 16-bit timers. These timers can be classified by function into timers A (five) and timers B (six). All these timers function independently. Fig.FB-1 and FB-2 show the block diagram of timers. Clock prescaler f1 XIN f8 1/8 1/4 f32 XCIN Clock prescaler reset flag (bit 7 at address 038116) set to “1” 1/32 Reset fC32 f1 f8 f32 fC32 • Timer mode • One-shot mode • PWM mode Noise filter TA0IN Timer A0 interrupt Timer A0 • Event counter mode • Timer mode • One-shot mode • PWM mode Noise filter TA1IN Timer A1 interrupt Timer A1 • Event counter mode • Timer mode • One-shot mode • PWM mode Noise filter TA2IN Timer A2 interrupt Timer A2 • Event counter mode • Timer mode • One-shot mode • PWM mode Noise filter TA3IN Timer A3 interrupt Timer A3 • Event counter mode • Timer mode • One-shot mode • PWM mode Timer A4 interrupt Noise filter TA4IN Timer A4 • Event counter mode Timer B2 overflow Note 1: The TA0IN pin (P71) is shared with RxD2 and the TB5IN pin, so be careful. Fig.FB-1 Timer A block diagram Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 79 of 290 Timer M16C/6K9 Group Clock prescaler f1 XIN f8 1/8 1/4 f32 XCIN Clock prescaler reset flag (bit 7 at address 038116) set to “1” 1/32 Reset fC32 f1 f8 f32 fC32 Timer A • Timer mode • Pulse width measuring mode Noise filter TB0IN Timer B0 interrupt Timer B0 • Event counter mode • Timer mode • Pulse width measuring mode Noise filter TB1IN Timer B1 interrupt Timer B1 • Event counter mode • Timer mode • Pulse width measuring mode Noise filter TB2IN Timer B2 interrupt Timer B2 • Event counter mode • Timer mode • Pulse width measuring mode Noise filter TB3IN Timer B3 interrupt Timer B3 • Event counter mode • Timer mode • Pulse width measuring mode Noise filter TB4IN Timer B4 interrupt Timer B4 • Event counter mode • Timer mode • Pulse width measuring mode Noise filter TB5IN Timer B5 • Event counter mode Note 1: The TB5IN pin (P71) is shared with RxD2 and the TA0IN pin, so be careful. Fig.FB-2 Timer B block diagram Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 80 of 290 Timer B5 interrupt Timer A M16C/6K9 Group Timer A Fig.FB-3 shows the block diagram of timer A. Fig.FB-4 to FB-6 show the timer A-related registers. Except in event counter mode, timers A0 through A4 all have the same function. Use the timer Ai mode register (i = 0 to 4) bits 0 and 1 to choose the desired mode. Timer A has the four operation modes listed as follows: • Timer mode: The timer counts an internal count source. • Event counter mode: The timer counts pulses from an external source or a timer over flow. • One-shot timer mode: The timer stops counting when the count reaches “000016”. • Pulse width modulation (PWM) mode: The timer continually outputs pulse with arbitrary width. Data bus high-order bits Clock source selection Low-order 8 bits • Timer (gate function) fC32 AAA A AAA A Data bus low-order bits • Timer • One shot • PWM f1 f8 f32 High-order 8 bits Reload register (16) • Event counter Counter (16) Polarity selection Up count/down count Clock selection TAiIN (i = 0 to 4) Always down count except in event counter mode Count start flag (Address 038016) Down count TB2 overflow External trigger TAj overflow (j = i – 1. Note, however, that j = 4 when i = 0) Up/down flag (Address 038416) TAi Timer A0 Timer A1 Timer A2 Timer A3 Timer A4 Addresses 038716 038616 038916 038816 038B16 038A16 038D16 038C16 038F16 038E16 TAj Timer A4 Timer A0 Timer A1 Timer A2 Timer A3 TAk Timer A1 Timer A2 Timer A3 Timer A4 Timer A0 TAk overflow (k = i + 1. Note, however, that k = 0 when i = 4) Pulse output TAiOUT (i = 0 to 4) Toggle flip-flop Fig.FB-3 Block diagram of timer A Timer Ai mode register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol TAiMR(i=0 to 4) b0 Bit symbol TMOD0 TMOD1 MR0 MR1 Address When reset 039616 to 039A16 0016 Bit name Function b1 b0 Operation mode selection bits 0 0 : Timer mode 0 1 : Event counter mode 1 0 : One-shot timer mode 1 1 : Pulse width modulation (PWM) mode Function varies with each operation mode MR2 MR3 TCK0 TCK1 Fig.FB-4 Timer A-related registers (1) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 81 of 290 Count source selection bits (Function varies with each operation mode) AA A A AA A A AA A AA A AA AA R W Timer A M16C/6K9 Group Timer Ai register (Note) (b15) b7 (b8) b0 b7 Symbol TA0 TA1 TA2 TA3 TA4 b0 Address 038716,038616 038916,038816 038B16,038A16 038D16,038C16 038F16,038E16 When reset Indeterminate Indeterminate Indeterminate Indeterminate Indeterminate Function AA AAA AA AAA AA AA AA Values that can be set • Timer mode Count the internal count source 000016 to FFFF16 • Event counter mode Count pulses from external input or the overflow of timer 000016 to FFFF16 • One-shot timer mode Count one shot width 000016 to FFFF16 • Pulse width modulation mode (16-bit PWM) Function as a 16-bit pulse width modulator 000016 to FFFE16 • Pulse width modulation mode (8-bit PWM) Timer low-order address functions as an 8-bit prescaler and high-order address functions as an 8-bit pulse width modulator 0016 to FE16 (Both high-order and low-order addresses) RW Note: Read and write data in 16-bit units. Count start flag b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol TABSR b0 Address 038016 When reset 0016 AA AAA A AA A AA A AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA A A AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AA Bit symbol Bit name TA0S Timer A0 count start flag TA1S Timer A1 count start flag TA2S Timer A2 count start flag TA3S Timer A3 count start flag TA4S Timer A4 count start flag TB0S Timer B0 count start flag TB1S Timer B1 count start flag TB2S Timer B2 count start flag Function RW 0 : Stop count 1 : Start count Up/down flag b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol UDF b0 Bit symbol Timer A0 up/down flag TA1UD Timer A1 up/down flag TA2UD Timer A2 up/down flag TA3UD Timer A3 up/down flag TA4UD Timer A4 up/down flag TA3P TA4P Fig.FB-5 Timer A-related registers (2) Jun 06, 2003 Bit name TA0UD TA2P Rev.1.00 Address 038416 page 82 of 290 When reset 0016 Function 0 : Down count 1 : Up count This specification becomes valid when the up/down flag content is selected for up/down switching factor Timer A2 two-phase pulse 0 : two-phase pulse signal processing disabled signal processing select bit 1 : two-phase pulse signal Timer A3 two-phase pulse processing enabled signal processing select bit When not using the two-phase Timer A4 two-phase pulse pulse signal processing function, signal processing select bit set the select bit to “0” AA AAAAAA AA AA AA AA AA AA R W Timer A M16C/6K9 Group One-shot start flag b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol ONSF b0 Address 038216 Bit symbol When reset 00X000002 Bit name Function TA0OS Timer A0 one-shot start flag TA1OS Timer A1 one-shot start flag TA2OS Timer A2 one-shot start flag TA3OS Timer A3 one-shot start flag TA4OS Timer A4 one-shot start flag 1 : Timer start When read, the value is “0” AAA AA A AAA AAA AA A AAA R W Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate. TA0TGL Timer A0 event/trigger selection bits TA0TGH b7 b6 0 0 : Input on TA0IN is selected (Note) 0 1 : TB2 overflow is selected 1 0 : TA4 overflow is selected 1 1 : TA1 overflow is selected Note: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”. Trigger selection register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol TRGSR Address 038316 Bit symbol TA1TGL Bit name Timer A1 event/trigger selection bits TA1TGH TA2TGL Timer A2 event/trigger selection bits TA2TGH TA3TGL Function b1 b0 b3 b2 0 0 : Input on TA2IN is selected (Note) 0 1 : TB2 overflow is selected 1 0 : TA1 overflow is selected 1 1 : TA3 overflow is selected b5 b4 Timer A4 event/trigger selection bits b7 b6 TA4TGH AAA AA A AA A AAA AAA AAA AA A AA A AAA AAA R W 0 0 : Input on TA1IN is selected (Note) 0 1 : TB2 overflow is selected 1 0 : TA0 overflow is selected 1 1 : TA2 overflow is selected Timer A3 event/trigger selection bits TA3TGH TA4TGL When reset 0016 0 0 : Input on TA3IN is selected (Note) 0 1 : TB2 overflow is selected 1 0 : TA2 overflow is selected 1 1 : TA4 overflow is selected 0 0 : Input on TA4IN is selected (Note) 0 1 : TB2 overflow is selected 1 0 : TA3 overflow is selected 1 1 : TA0 overflow is selected Note: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”. Clock prescaler reset flag b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol CPSRF Address 038116 Bit symbol Bit name When reset 0XXXXXXX2 Function R W AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AAA AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate. CPSR Clock prescaler reset flag Fig.FB-6 Timer A-related registers (3) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 83 of 290 0 : No effect 1 : Prescaler is reset (When read, the value is “0”) Timer A M16C/6K9 Group (1) Timer mode In this mode, the timer counts an internally generated count source. (See Table.FB-1) Fig.FB-7 shows the timer Ai mode register in timer mode. Table.FB-1 Specifications of timer mode Item Count source Count operation Specification f1, f8, f32, fC32 • Down count • When the timer underflows, it reloads the reload register contents and then continuing counting 1/(n+1) n : Set value Count start flag is set (= 1) Count start flag is reset (= 0) When the timer underflows Programmable I/O port or gate input Divide ratio Count start condition Count stop condition Interrupt request generation timing TAiIN pin function TAiOUT pin function Read from timer Write to timer Programmable I/O port or pulse output Count value can be read out by reading timer Ai register • When counting stopped When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to both reload register and counter • When counting in progress When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to only reload register (Transferred to counter at next reload time) • Gate function Counting can be started and stopped by the TAiIN pin’s input signal • Pulse output function Each time the timer underflows, the TAiOUT pin’s polarity is reversed Select function Timer Ai mode register b7 b6 b5 0 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol TAiMR(i=0 to 4) 0 0 Bit symbol TMOD0 TMOD1 Address When reset 039616 to 039A16 0016 Bit name Operation mode selection bits Function b1 b0 0 0 : Timer mode 0 : Pulse is not output (TAiOUT pin is a normal port pin) 1 : Pulse is output (Note 1) (TAiOUT pin is a pulse output pin) MR0 Pulse output function selection bit MR1 Gate function selection bits 0 X (Note 2): Gate function not available b4 b3 (TAiIN pin is a normal port pin) 1 0 : Timer counts only when TAiIN pin is held “L” (Note 3) 1 1 : Timer counts only when TAiIN pin is held “H” (Note 3) MR2 MR3 TCK0 0 (Must always be fixed to “0” in timer mode) Count source selection bits TCK1 b7 b6 0 0 : f1 0 1 : f8 1 0 : f32 1 1 : fC32 A A AA A AA A RW Note 1: The settings of the corresponding port register and port direction register are invalid. Note 2: The bit can be “0” or “1”. Note 3: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”. Fig.FB-7 Timer Ai mode register in timer mode Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 84 of 290 Timer A M16C/6K9 Group (2) Event counter mode In this mode, the timer counts an external signal or an internal timer’s overflow. Timers A0 and A1 can count a single-phase external signal. Timers A2, A3, and A4 can count a single-phase and a two-phase external signals. Table.FB-2 lists timer specifications and Fig. FB-8 shows the timer Ai mode register in event count mode when counting a single-phase external signal. Table.FB-3 lists timer specifications and Fig. FB-8 shows the timer Ai mode register in event count mode when counting a two-phase external signals. Table.FB-2 Timer specifications in event counter mode (when not processing two-phase pulse signal) Item Specification Count source • External signal input to TAiIN pin (effective edge can be selected by software) • TB2 overflow, TAj overflow Count operation • Up count or down count can be selected by external signal or software • When the timer overflows or underflows, it reloads the reload register con tents and then continuing counting (Note) Divide ratio 1/ (FFFF16 - n + 1) for up count 1/ (n + 1) for down count n : Set value Count start condition Count start flag is set (= 1) Count stop condition Count start flag is reset (= 0) Interrupt request generation timing The timer overflows or underflows TAiIN pin function Programmable I/O port or count source input TAiOUT pin function Programmable I/O port, pulse output, or up/down count select input Read from timer Count value can be read out by reading timer Ai register Write to timer • When counting stopped When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to both reload register and counter • When counting in progress When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to only reload register (Transferred to counter at next reload time) Select function • Free-run count function Even when the timer overflows or underflows, the reload register content is not reloaded to it • Pulse output function Each time the timer overflows or underflows, the TAiOUT pin’s polarity is reversed Note: This does not apply when the free-run function is selected. Timer Ai mode register b7 b6 b5 0 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol TAiMR(i = 0, 1) 0 1 Address 039616, 039716 Bit symbol Bit name TMOD0 Operation mode selection bits TMOD1 When reset 0016 Function b1 b0 0 1 : Event counter mode (Note 1) AAAA AAAA AAAA AA MR0 Pulse output function selection bit 0 : Pulse is not output (TAiOUT pin is a normal port pin) 1 : Pulse is output (Note 2) (TAiOUT pin is a pulse output pin) MR1 Count polarity selection bit (Note 3) 0 : Counts external signal's falling edge 1 : Counts external signal's rising edge MR2 Up/down switching factor selection bit 0 : Up/down flag's content 1 : TAiOUT pin's input signal (Note 4) MR3 0 (Must always be fixed to “0” in event counter mode) TCK0 Count operation type selection bit TCK1 Invalid in event counter mode Can be “0” or “1” 0 : Reload type 1 : Free-run type R W RW Note 1: In event counter mode, the count source is selected by the event / trigger select bit (addresses 038216 and 038316). Note 2: The settings of the corresponding port register and port direction register are invalid. Note 3: Valid only when counting an external signal. Note 4: When an “L” signal is input to the TAiOUT pin, the downcount is activated. When “H”, the upcount is activated. Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”. Fig.FB-8 Timer Ai mode register in event counter mode Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 85 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Timer A Table.FB-3 Timer specifications in event counter mode (when processing two-phase pulse signals with timers A2, A3, and A4) Item Count source Count operation Divide ratio Count start condition Count stop condition Interrupt request generation timing TAiIN pin function TAiOUT pin function Read from timer Write to timer Select function Specification • Two-phase pulse signals input to TAiIN and TAiOUT pin • Up count or down count can be selected by two-phase pulse signals • When the timer overflows or underflows, the reload register content is reloaded and the timer starts over again (Note) 1/ (FFFF16 - n + 1) for up count 1/ (n + 1) for down count n : Set value Count start flag is set (= 1) Count start flag is reset (= 0) Timer overflows or underflows Two-phase pulse input Two-phase pulse input Count value can be read out by reading timer A2, A3, or A4 register • When counting stopped When a value is written to timer A2, A3, or A4 register, it is written to both reload register and counter • When counting in progress When a value is written to timer A2, A3, or A4 register, it is written to only reload register. (Transferred to counter at next reload time.) • Normal processing operation The timer up-counts by the rising edge of TAiIN pin and down-counts by the falling edge fo TAiIN pin during the "H" level period of input signal in TAiOUT pin. TAiOUT TAiIN (i=2,3) Up count Up count Up count Down count Down count Down count • Multiply-by-4 processing operation If the phase relationship is such that the TAiIN pin goes “H” when the input signal on the TAiOUT pin is “H”, the timer counts up rising and falling edges on the TAiOUT and TAiIN pins. If the phase relationship is such that the TAiIN pin goes “L” when the input signal on the TAiOUT pin is “H”, the timer counts down rising and falling edges on the TAiOUT and TAiIN pins. TAiOUT Count up all edges Count down all edges Count up all edges Count down all edges TAiIN (i=3,4) Note: This does not apply when the free-run function is selected. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 86 of 290 Timer A M16C/6K9 Group Timer Ai mode register (When not using two-phase pulse signals' processing) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 0 b1 b0 0 1 Symbol Address When reset TAiMR(i = 2 to 4) 039816 to 039A16 0016 Bit symbol TMOD0 TMOD1 Bit name Operation mode selection bits Function b1 b0 0 1 : Event counter mode 0 : Pulse is not output (TAiOUT pin is a normal port pin) 1 : Pulse is output (Note 1) (TAiOUT pin is a pulse output pin) AA A A AA AA AA AA AA AA R W MR0 Pulse output function selection bit MR1 Count polarity selection bit 0 : Counts external signal's falling edges 1 : Counts external signal's rising edges (Note 2) MR2 Up/down switching factor selection bit MR3 0 : (Must always be “0” in event counter mode) TCK0 Count operation type selection bit 0 : Reload type 1 : Free-run type TCK1 Two-phase pulse signals' processing operation selection bit (Note 4)(Note 5) 0 : Normal processing operation 1 : Multiply-by-4 processing operation 0 : Up/down flag's content 1 : TAiOUT pin's input signal (Note 3) Note 1: The settings of the corresponding port register and port direction register are invalid. Note 2: This bit is valid when only counting an external signal. Note 3: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”. Note 4: This bit is valid for the timer A3 mode register. For timer A2 and A4 mode registers, this bit can be “0 ”or “1”. Note 5: When performing two-phase signal processing, make sure the two-phase pulse signals' processing operation selection bit (address 038416) is set to “1”. Also, always be sure to set the event/trigger selection bit (addresses 038216 and 038316) to “00”. Timer Ai mode register (When using two-phase pulse signals' processing) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 1 0 0 0 1 Symbol Address When reset TAiMR(i = 2 to 4) 039816 to 039A16 0016 Bit symbol TMOD0 TMOD1 Bit name Operation mode selection bits Function b1 b0 0 1 : Event counter mode MR0 0 (Must always be “0” when using two-phase pulse signal processing) MR1 0 (Must always be “0” when using two-phase pulse signal processing) MR2 1 (Must always be “1” when using two-phase pulse signal processing) MR3 0 (Must always be “0” when using two-phase pulse signal processing) TCK0 TCK1 Count operation type selection bit 0 : Reload type 1 : Free-run type AA AA A A A A AA A A AA A A AA RW Two-phase pulse processing 0 : Normal processing operation operation selection bit 1 : Multiply-by-4 processing operation (Note 1)(Note 2) Note 1: This bit is valid for timer A3 mode register. For timer A2 and A4 mode registers, this bit can be “0” or “1”. Note 2: When performing two-phase pulse signals' processing, make sure the two-phase pulse signals' processing operation selection bit (address 038416) is set to “1”. Also, always be sure to set the event/trigger selection bit (addresses 038216 and 038316) to “00”. Fig.FB-9 Timer Ai mode register in event counter mode Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 87 of 290 Timer A M16C/6K9 Group (3) One-shot timer mode In this mode, the timer operates only once. (See Table.FB-4) When a trigger occurs, the timer starts to operate for a given period. Fig.FB-10 shows the timer Ai mode register in one-shot timer mode. Table.FB-4 Timer specifications in one-shot timer mode Item Specification Count source Count operation f1, f8, f32, fC32 • The timer counts down • When the count reaches 000016, the timer stops counting after reloading a new count • If a trigger occurs when counting, the timer reloads a new count and restarts counting 1/n n : Set value • An external trigger is input • The timer overflows • The one-shot start flag is set (= 1) • A new count is reloaded after the count has reached 000016 • The count start flag is reset (= 0) The count reaches 000016 Programmable I/O port or trigger input Programmable I/O port or pulse output When timer Ai register is read, it indicates an indeterminate value • When counting stopped When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to both reload register and counter • When counting in progress When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to only reload register (Transferred to counter at next reload time) Divide ratio Count start condition Count stop condition Interrupt request generation timing TAiIN pin function TAiOUT pin function Read from timer Write to timer Timer Ai mode register b7 b6 b5 0 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address When reset TAiMR(i = 0 to 4) 039616 to 039A16 0016 1 0 Bit symbol TMOD0 TMOD1 Bit name Operation mode selection bits Function b1 b0 1 0 : One-shot timer mode AA AA AA A AA MR0 Pulse output function selection bit 0 : Pulse is not output (TAiOUT pin is a normal port pin) 1 : Pulse is output (Note 1) (TAiOUT pin is a pulse output pin) MR1 External trigger selection bit (Note 2) 0 : Falling edge of TAiIN pin's input signal (Note 3) 1 : Rising edge of TAiIN pin's input signal (Note 3) MR2 Trigger selection bit 0 : One-shot start flag is valid 1 : Selected by event/trigger selection register MR3 TCK0 TCK1 0 (Must always be “0” in one-shot timer mode) Count source selection bits b7 b6 0 0 : f1 0 1 : f8 1 0 : f32 1 1 : fC32 RW Note 1: The settings of the corresponding port register and port direction register are invalid. Note 2: Valid only when the TAiIN pin is selected by the event/trigger selection bit (addresses 038216 and 038316). If timer overflow is selected, this bit can be “1” or “0”. Note 3: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”. Fig.FB-10 Timer Ai mode register in one-shot timer mode Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 88 of 290 Timer A M16C/6K9 Group (4) Pulse width modulation (PWM) mode In this mode, the timer outputs pulses of a given width in succession. (See Table.FB-5) In this mode, the counter functions as either a 16-bit pulse width modulator or an 8-bit pulse width modulator. Fig.FB-11 shows the timer Ai mode register in pulse width modulation mode. Fig.FB-12 shows the example of how a 16-bit pulse width modulator operates. Fig.FB-13 shows the example of how an 8-bit pulse width modulator operates. Table.FB-5 Timer specifications in pulse width modulation mode Item Specification Count source Count operation f1, f8, f32, fC32 • The timer counts down (operating as an 8-bit or a 16-bit pulse width modulator) • The timer reloads a new count at a rising edge of PWM pulse and continues counting • The timer is not affected by a trigger that occurs when counting • High level width n / fi n : Set value • Cycle time (216-1) / fi fixed • High level width n (m+1) / fi n : values set to timer Ai register’s high-order address 8 • Cycle time (2 -1) (m+1) / fi m : values set to timer Ai register’s low-order address • External trigger is input • The timer overflows • The count start flag is set (= 1) • The count start flag is reset (= 0) The falling edge of PWM pulse Programmable I/O port or trigger input Pulse output When timer Ai register is read, it indicates an indeterminate value • When counting stopped When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to both reload register and counter • When counting in progress When a value is written to timer Ai register, it is written to only reload register (Transferred to counter at next reload time) 16-bit PWM 8-bit PWM Count start condition Count stop condition Interrupt request generation timing TAiIN pin function TAiOUT pin function Read from timer Write to timer Timer Ai mode register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 1 1 1 Symbol TAiMR(i=0 to 4) Bit symbol TMOD0 TMOD1 Address When reset 039616 to 039A16 0016 Bit name Function Operation mode selection b1 b0 1 1 : PWM mode bits AA A AA A AA A AA AA AA AA A AA A AA A AA A MR0 1 (Must always be “1” in PWM mode) MR1 External trigger selection 0: Falling edge of TAiIN pin's input signal (Note 2) 1: Rising edge of TAiIN pin's input signal (Note 2) bit (Note 1) MR2 Trigger selection bit 0: Count start flag is valid 1: Selected by event/trigger selection register MR3 16/8-bit PWM mode selection bit 0: Functions as a 16-bit pulse width modulator 1: Functions as an 8-bit pulse width modulator b7 b6 TCK0 TCK1 Count source selection bits 0 0 : f1 0 1 : f8 1 0 : f32 1 1 : fC32 RW Note 1: Valid only when the TAiIN pin is selected by the event/trigger selection bit (addresses 038216 and 038316). If timer overflow is selected, this bit can be “1” or “0”. Note 2: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”. Fig.FB-11 Timer Ai mode register in pulse width modulation mode Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 89 of 290 Timer A M16C/6K9 Group Condition : Reload register = 000316, when external trigger (rising edge of TAiIN pin input signal) is selected 1 / fi X (2 16 – 1) Count source “H” TAiIN pin input signal “L” Trigger is not generated by this signal 1 / fi X n “H” PWM pulse output from TAiOUT pin “L” “1” Timer Ai interrupt request bit “0” fi : Frequency of count source Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software (f1, f8, f32, fC32) Note: n = 000016 to FFFE16. Fig.FB-12 Example of how a 16-bit pulse width modulator operates Condition : Reload register high-order 8 bits = 0216 Reload register low-order 8 bits = 0216 External trigger (falling edge of TAiIN pin input signal) is selected 1 / fi X (m + 1) X (2 8 – 1) Count source (Note1) TAiIN pin input signal “H” “L” AAAAAAAAAAAAAAA 1 / fi X (m + 1) “H” Underflow signal of 8-bit prescaler (Note2) “L” 1 / fi X (m + 1) X n PWM pulse output from TAiOUT pin “H” Timer Ai interrupt request bit “1” “L” “0” fi : Frequency of count source (f1, f8, f32, fC32) Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software Note 1: The 8-bit prescaler counts the count source. Note 2: The 8-bit pulse width modulator counts the 8-bit prescaler's underflow signal. Note 3: m = 0016 to FE16; n = 0016 to FE16. Fig.FB-13 Example of how an 8-bit pulse width modulator operates Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 90 of 290 Timer B M16C/6K9 Group Timer B Fig.FB-14 shows the block diagram of timer B. Fig.FB-15 and FB-16 show the timer B-related registers. Use the timer Bi mode register (i = 0 to 5) bits 0 and 1 to choose the desired mode. Timer B has three operation modes listed as follows: • Timer mode: The timer counts an internal count source. • Event counter mode: The timer counts pulses from an external source or a timer overflow. • Pulse period/pulse width measuring mode: The timer measures an external signal's pulse period or pulse width. Data bus high-order bits Data bus low-order bits Clock source selection High-order 8 bits Low-order 8 bits f1 • Timer • Pulse period/pulse width measurement f8 f32 fC32 Reload register (16) Counter (16) • Event counter Count start flag Polarity switching and edge pulse TBiIN (i = 0 to 5) (address 038016) Counter reset circuit Can be selected in only event counter mode TBi Timer B0 Timer B1 Timer B2 Timer B3 Timer B4 Timer B5 TBj overflow (j = i – 1. Note, however, j = 2 when i = 0, j = 5 when i = 3) Address 039116 039016 039316 039216 039516 039416 035116 035016 035316 035216 035516 035416 TBj Timer B2 Timer B0 Timer B1 Timer B5 Timer B3 Timer B4 Fig.FB-14 Block diagram of timer B Timer Bi mode register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address TBiMR(i = 0 to 5) 039B16 to 039D16 035B16 to 035D16 Bit symbol Bit name TMOD0 Operation mode selection bits Function b1 b0 TMOD1 MR0 When reset 00XX00002 00XX00002 0 0 : Timer mode 0 1 : Event counter mode 1 0 : Pulse period/pulse width measurement mode 1 1 : Inhibited Function varies with each operation mode MR1 MR2 AA A A AA AA AA A AA R (Note 1) (Note 2) MR3 TCK0 TCK1 Count source selection bits (Function varies with each operation mode) Note 1: Timer B0, timer B3. Note 2: Timer B1, timer B2, timer B4, timer B5. Fig.FB-15 Timer B-related registers (1) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 91 of 290 W Timer B M16C/6K9 Group Timer Bi register (Note) (b15) b7 (b8) b0 b7 b0 Symbol TB0 TB1 TB2 TB3 TB4 TB5 Address 039116, 039016 039316, 039216 039516, 039416 035116, 035016 035316, 035216 035516, 035416 Function When reset Indeterminate Indeterminate Indeterminate Indeterminate Indeterminate Indeterminate AAA AA A AA Values that can be set • Timer mode Counts the timer's period 000016 to FFFF16 • Event counter mode Counts external pulses input or a timer overflow 000016 to FFFF16 • Pulse period / pulse width measurement mode Measures a pulse period or width RW Note: Read and write data in 16-bit units. Count start flag b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol TABSR b0 Address 038016 When reset 0016 AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AA A AAA AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AAA AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AA A AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AA A AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AA A AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AAA Bit symbol Bit name TA0S Timer A0 count start flag TA1S Timer A1 count start flag TA2S Timer A2 count start flag TA3S Timer A3 count start flag TA4S Timer A4 count start flag TB0S Timer B0 count start flag TB1S Timer B1 count start flag TB2S Timer B2 count start flag Function RW 0 : Stops counting 1 : Starts counting Timer B3, 4, 5 count start flag b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol TBSR b0 Address 034016 When reset 000XXXXX2 AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AAA AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AA A AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AAA Bit symbol Bit name Function RW Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate. TB3S Timer B3 count start flag TB4S Timer B4 count start flag TB5S Timer B5 count start flag 0 : Stops counting 1 : Starts counting Clock prescaler reset flag b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol CPSRF b0 Bit symbol Address 038116 Bit name When reset 0XXXXXXX2 Function Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate. R W AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA AA A AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA CPSR Fig.FB-16 Timer B-related registers (2) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 92 of 290 Clock prescaler reset flag 0 : No effect 1 : Prescaler is reset (When read, the value is “0”) Timer B M16C/6K9 Group (1) Timer mode In this mode, the timer counts an internally generated count source. (See Table.FB-6.) Fig.FB-17 shows the timer Bi mode register in timer mode. Table.FB-6 Timer specifications in timer mode Item Count source Count operation Specification Divide ratio Count start condition Count stop condition Interrupt request generation timing TBiIN pin function Read from timer Write to timer AA A AA A f1, f8, f32, fC32 •Counts down •When the timer underflows, it reloads the reload register contents and then continuing counting 1/(n+1) n : Set value Count start flag is set (= 1) Count start flag is reset (= 0) The timer underflows Programmable I/O port Count value is read out by reading timer Bi register •When counting stopped When a value is written to timer Bi register, it is written to both reload register and counter • When counting in progress When a value is written to timer Bi register, it is written to only reload register (Transferred to counter at next reload time) Timer Bi mode register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 Symbol TBiMR(i=0 to 5) Address 039B16 to 039D16 035B16 to 035D16 Bit symbol Bit name TMOD0 Operation mode selection bits TMOD1 MR0 When reset 00XX00002 00XX00002 Function b1 b0 0 0 : Timer mode MR1 Invalid in timer mode Can be “0” or “1” MR2 0 (Set to “0” in timer mode ; i = 0, 3) Nothing is assigned (i = 1, 2, 4, 5). In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate. MR3 Invalid in timer mode. In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read in timer mode, turns out to be indeterminate. TCK0 Count source selection bits TCK1 b7 b6 0 0 : f1 0 1 : f8 1 0 : f32 1 1 : fC32 Note 1: Timer B0, timer B3. Note 2: Timer B1, timer B2, timer B4, timer B5. Fig.FB-17 Timer Bi mode register in timer mode Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 93 of 290 AA A A AA A AA A AA A A AA AA R (Note 1) (Note 2) W Timer B M16C/6K9 Group (2) Event counter mode In this mode, the timer counts an external signal or an internal timer's overflow. (See Table.FB-7) Fig.FB-18 shows the timer Bi mode register in event counter mode. Table.FB-7 Timer specifications in event counter mode Item Count source Specification •External signals input to TBiIN pin •Effective edge of count source can be a rising edge, a falling edge, or both edges as selected by software •Counts down •When the timer underflows, it reloads the reload register contents and then continuing counting 1/(n+1) n : Set value Count start flag is set (= 1) Count start flag is reset (= 0) Count operation Divide ratio Count start condition Count stop condition Interrupt request generation timing TBiIN pin function Read from timer Write to timer AA AA The timer underflows Count source input Count value can be read out by reading timer Bi register •When counting stopped When a value is written to timer Bi register, it is written to both reload register and counter •When counting in progress When a value is written to timer Bi register, it is written to only reload register (Transferred to counter at next reload time) Timer Bi mode register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 1 Symbol TBiMR(i=0 to 5) Address 039B16 to 039D16 035B16 to 035D16 Bit symbol Bit name TMOD0 Operation mode selection bits TMOD1 MR0 Count polarity selection bits (Note 1) MR1 MR2 When reset 00XX00002 00XX00002 Function b1 b0 0 1 : Event counter mode b3 b2 0 0 : Counts external signal's falling edges 0 1 : Counts external signal's rising edges 1 0 : Counts external signal's falling and rising edges 1 1 : Inhibited 0 (Fixed to “0” in event counter mode; i = 0, 3) Nothing is assigned (i = 1, 2, 4, 5). In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate. MR3 Invalid in event counter mode. In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read in event counter mode, turns out to be indeterminate. TCK0 Invalid in event counter mode. Can be “0” or “1”. TCK1 Event clock selection 0 : Input from TBiIN pin (Note 4) 1 : TBj overflow AA AAAA AAAA AAAA AAAA AAAA AA AA AAAA AAAA (j = i – 1; however, j = 2 when i = 0, j = 5 when i = 3) Note 1: Valid only when input from the TBiIN pin is selected as the event clock. If timer's overflow is selected, this bit can be “0” or “1”. Note 2: Timer B0, timer B3. Note 3: Timer B1, timer B2, timer B4, timer B5. Note 4: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”. Fig.FB-18 Timer Bi mode register in event counter mode Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 94 of 290 R (Note 2) (Note 3) W Timer B M16C/6K9 Group (3) Pulse period/pulse width measurement mode In this mode, the timer measures the pulse period or pulse width of an external signal. (See Table.FB-8) Fig.FB-19 shows the timer Bi mode register in pulse period/pulse width measurement mode. Fig.FB-20 shows the operation timing when measuring a pulse period. Fig.FB-21 shows the operation timing when measuring a pulse width. Table.FB-8 Timer specifications in pulse period/pulse width measurement mode Item Count source Count operation Specification f1, f8, f32, fC32 •Up count •At measurement pulse's effective edge, after the count value is transferred to reload register, it is cleared to "000016" and then continues counting. Count start flag is set (= 1) Count start flag is reset (= 0) •When measurement pulse's effective edge is input (Note 1) •When an overflow occurs. (Simultaneously, the timer Bi overflow flag becomes “1”. The timer Bi overflow flag becomes “0” when the count start flag is “1” and a value is written to the timer Bi mode register.) Measurement pulse input When timer Bi register is read, it indicates the reload register’s content (measurement result) (Note 2) Cannot be written to Count start condition Count stop condition Interrupt request generation timing TBiIN pin function Read from timer Write to timer Note 1: An interrupt request is not generated when the first effective edge is input after the timer has started counting. Note 2: After count starts, the value read out from the timer Bi register is indeterminate until the second effective edge is input . Timer Bi mode register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 1 0 Symbol TBiMR(i=0 to 5) Bit symbol TMOD0 TMOD1 MR0 Address 039B16 to 039D16 035B16 to 035D16 Bit name Operation mode selection bits Measurement mode selection bits MR1 MR2 When reset 00XX00002 00XX00002 Function b1 b0 1 0 : Pulse period / pulse width measurement mode b3 b2 0 0 : Pulse period measurement (Interval between measurement pulse's falling edge to falling edge) 0 1 : Pulse period measurement (Interval between measurement pulse's rising edge to rising edge) 1 0 : Pulse width measurement (Interval between measurement pulse's falling edge to rising edge, and between rising edge to falling edge) 1 1 : Inhibited 0 (Fixed to “0” in pulse period/pulse width measurement mode; i = 0, 3) Nothing is assigned (i = 1, 2, 4, 5). In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate. MR3 Timer Bi overflow flag ( Note 1) TCK0 Count source selection bits TCK1 0 : Timer did not overflow 1 : Timer has overflowed b7 b6 0 0 : f1 0 1 : f8 1 0 : f32 1 1 : fC32 AAAA AAA AA AAA AAA AAA AAAA AAA R W (Note 2) (Note 3) Note 1: The timer Bi overflow flag becomes “0” when the count start flag is “1” and a value is written to the timer Bi mode register. This flag cannot be set to “1” by software. Note 2: Timer B0, timer B3. Note 3: Timer B1, timer B2, timer B4, timer B5. Fig.FB-19 Timer Bi mode register in pulse period/pulse width measurement mode Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 95 of 290 Timer B M16C/6K9 Group When measuring a pulse time interval from falling edge to falling edge Count source “H” Measurement pulse Reload register transfer timing “L” Transfer (indeterminate value) Transfer (measured value) counter (Note 1) (Note 1) (Note 2) Timing at which counter reaches “000016” “1” Count start flag “0” “1” Timer Bi interrupt request bit “0” Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software. Timer Bi overflow flag “1” “0” Note 1: Counter is initialized at completion of measurement. Note 2: Timer has overflowed. Fig.FB-20 Operation timing when measuring a pulse period Count source “H” Measurement pulse Reload register transfer timing “L” counter Transfer (indeterminate value) (Note 1) Transfer (measured value) (Note 1) Transfer (measured value) (Note 1) Transfer (measured value) (Note 1) (Note 2) Timing at which counter reaches “000016” “1” Count start flag “0” “1” Timer Bi interrupt request bit “0” Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software. Timer Bi overflow flag “1” “0” Note 1: Counter is initialized at completion of measurement. Note 2: Timer has overflowed. Fig.FB-21 Operation timing when measuring a pulse width Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 96 of 290 Serial I/O M16C/6K9 Group Serial I/O Serial I/O is configured as five channels: UART0, UART1, UART2, S I/O3 and S I/O4. UART0 to 2 Each of UART0 - UART2 has an exclusive timer to generate a transfer clock, operating independently from each other. Fig.GA-1 shows the block diagram of UART0, UART1 and UART2. Fig.GA-2 and GA-3 show the block diagram of the transmit/receive unit. UARTi (i = 0 to 2) has two operation modes: a clock synchronous serial I/O mode and a clock asynchronous serial I/O mode (UART mode). The contents of the serial I/O mode selection bits (bits 0 to 2 at addresses 03A016, 03A816 and 037816) determine whether UARTi is used as a clock synchronous serial I/O or as a UART. Although a few functions are different, UART0, UART1 and UART2 have almost the same functions. UART0 through UART2 are almost equal in their functions with minor exceptions. UART2, in particular, is compliant with the SIM interface with some extra settings added in clock-asynchronous serial I/O mode (Note). It also has the bus collision detection function that generates an interrupt request if the TxD pin and the RxD pin are different in level. Table.GA-1 shows the comparison of functions of UART0 through UART2, and Fig.GA-4 to GA-8 show the registers related to UARTi. Note: SIM : Subscriber Identity Module Table.GA-1 Comparison of functions of UART0 through UART2 Function UART0 UART1 UART2 CLK polarity selection Possible (Note 1) Possible (Note 1) Possible (Note 1) LSB first / MSB first selection Possible (Note 1) Possible (Note 1) Possible (Note 2) Continuous receive mode selection Possible (Note 1) Possible (Note 1) Possible (Note 1) Transfer clock output from multiple pins selection Impossible Possible (Note 1) Impossible Separate CTS/RTS pins Possible Impossible Impossible Serial data logic switch Impossible Impossible Possible Sleep mode selection Possible TxD, RxD I/O polarity switch Impossible Impossible Possible TxD, RxD port output format CMOS output CMOS output N-channel open-drain output Parity error signal output Impossible Impossible Possible Bus collision detection Impossible Impossible Possible (Note 3) Possible Note 1: Only in clock synchronous serial I/O mode. Note 2: Only in clock synchronous serial I/O mode and 8-bit UART mode. Note 3: Only in UART mode. Note 4: Can be used for SIM interface. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 97 of 290 (Note 3) (Note 4) Impossible (Note 4) Serial I/O M16C/6K9 Group (UART0) RxD0 TxD0 UART reception 1/16 Clock source selection Bit rate generator Internal (address 03A116) f1 f8 f32 Reception control circuit Clock synchronous type 1 / (n0+1) UART transmission 1/16 Transmission control circuit Clock synchronous type External Receive clock Transmit/ receive unit Transmit clock Clock synchronous type (when internal clock is selected) 1/2 CLK polarity switching circuit CLK0 Clock synchronous type (when internal clock is selected) Clock synchronous type (when external clock is selected) CTS/RTS disabled CTS/RTS selected CTS0 / RTS0 RTS0 Vcc CTS/RTS disabled CTS0 CTS/RTS separated CTS0 from UART1 (UART1) RxD1 TxD1 Clock source selection Bit rate generator Internal (address 03A916) f1 f8 f32 UART reception 1/16 1 / (n1+1) Reception control circuit Clock synchronous type UART transmission 1/16 Transmission control circuit Clock synchronous type Clock synchronous type External Receive clock Transmit/ receive unit Transmit clock (when internal clock is selected) 1/2 CLK1 CLK polarity switching circuit CTS1 / RTS1 / CTS0 / CLKS1 Clock synchronous type (when external clock is selected) Clock synchronous type (when internal clock is selected) CTS/RTS disabled CTS/RTS separated Clock output pin select switch RTS1 VCC CTS/RTS disabled CTS0 CTS1 CTS0 to UART0 (UART2) RxD2 TxD polarity switching circuit RxD polarity switching circuit UART reception Clock source selection Bit rate generator f1 Internal (address 037916) f8 f32 1 / (n2+1) 1/16 Clock synchronous type UART transmission 1/16 Clock synchronous type External Reception control circuit Transmission control circuit Receive clock Transmit/ receive unit Transmit clock Clock synchronous type 1/2 CLK2 CLK polarity switching circuit (when internal clock is selected) Clock synchronous type (when internal clock is selected) CTS/RTS selected Clock synchronous type (when external clock is selected) CTS/RTS disabled RTS2 CTS2 / RTS2 Vcc CTS/RTS disabled CTS2 n0 : Values set to UART0 bit rate generator (BRG0) n1 : Values set to UART1 bit rate generator (BRG1) n2 : Values set to UART2 bit rate generator (BRG2) Fig.GA-1 Block diagram of UARTi (i = 0 to 2) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 98 of 290 TxD2 Serial I/O M16C/6K9 Group Clock synchronous type 1SP RxDi SP UART (7 bits) UART (8 bits) Clock synchronous type PAR disabled UARTi receive register UART (7 bits) PAR SP PAR enabled 2SP UART UART (9 bits) Clock synchronous type UART (8 bits) UART (9 bits) 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 D8 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 UARTi receive buffer register Address 03A616 Address 03A716 Address 03AE16 Address 03AF16 MSB/LSB conversion circuit Data bus high-order bits Data bus low-order bits MSB/LSB conversion circuit D7 D8 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 UART (8 bits) UART (9 bits) UART (9 bits) PAR enabled 2SP SP 1SP Clock synchronous type TxDi PAR disabled “0” Clock synchronous type UART (7 bits) Jun 06, 2003 page 99 of 290 UARTi transmit register UART (7 bits) UART (8 bits) Clock synchronous type Fig.GA-2 Block diagram of UARTi (i = 0, 1) transmit/receive unit Rev.1.00 UARTi transmit buffer register Address 03A216 Address 03A316 Address 03AA16 Address 03AB16 UART PAR SP D0 SP: Stop bit PAR: Parity bit Serial I/O M16C/6K9 Group No reverse RxD data reverse circuit RxD2 Reverse Clock synchronous type PAR disabled 1SP SP UART2 receive register UART(7 bits) PAR SP 2SP UART PAR enabled 0 UART (7 bits) UART (8 bits) Clock synchronous type 0 0 0 0 Clock synchronous type UART (9 bits) 0 0 UART (8 bits) UART (9 bits) D8 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 Logic reverse circuit + MSB/LSB conversion circuit UART2 receive buffer register Address 037E16 Address 037F16 Data bus high-order bits Data bus low-order bits Logic reverse circuit + MSB/LSB conversion circuit D8 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 Address 037A16 Address 037B16 UART (8 bits) UART (9 bits) PAR enabled 2SP SP SP UART UART (9 bits) Clock synchronous type PAR 1SP PAR disabled Clock synchronous type “0” UART (7 bits) UART (8 bits) UART(7 bits) UART2 transmit register Clock synchronous type Error signal output disable Not reverse Error signal output circuit Error signal output enable TxD data reverse circuit Reverse SP: Stop bit PAR: Parity bit Fig.GA-3 Block diagram of UART2 transmit/receive unit Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 UART2 transmit buffer register page 100 of 290 TxD2 Serial I/O M16C/6K9 Group UARTi transmit buffer register (b15) b7 (b8) b0 b7 Symbol U0TB U1TB U2TB b0 Address 03A316, 03A216 03AB16, 03AA16 037B16, 037A16 When reset Indeterminate Indeterminate Indeterminate Function A A R W Transmit data Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turn out to be indeterminate. UARTi receive buffer register (b8) b0 b7 (b15) b7 Symbol U0RB U1RB U2RB b0 Bit symbol Address 03A716, 03A616 03AF16, 03AE16 037F16, 037E16 When reset Indeterminate Indeterminate Indeterminate Function (During clock synchronous serial I/O mode) Bit name Receive data Function (During UART mode) Receive data Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”. OER Overrun error flag (Note 1) 0 : No overrun error 1 : Overrun error found 0 : No overrun error 1 : Overrun error found FER Framing error flag (Note 1) Invalid 0 : No framing error 1 : Framing error found PER Parity error flag (Note 1) Invalid 0 : No parity error 1 : Parity error found SUM Error sum flag (Note 1) Invalid 0 : No error 1 : Error found A A A A AA R W Note 1: Bits 15 through 12 are set to “0” when the serial I/O mode selection bits (bits 2 to 0 at addresses 03A016, 03A816 and 037816) are set to “0002” or the receive enable bit is set to “0”. (Bit 15 is set to “0” when bits 14 to 12 all are set to “0”.) Bits 14 and 13 are also set to “0” when the lower byte of the UARTi receive buffer register (addresses 03A616, 03AE16 and 037E16) is read out. UARTi bit rate generator b7 Symbol U0BRG U1BRG U2BRG b0 Address 03A116 03A916 037916 When reset Indeterminate Indeterminate Indeterminate Function Assuming that set value = n, BRGi divides the count source by n+1 Fig.GA-4 Serial I/O-related registers (1) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 101 of 290 Values that can be set 0016 to FF16 A R W Serial I/O M16C/6K9 Group UARTi transmit/receive mode register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol UiMR(i=0,1) Bit symbol SMD0 Address 03A016, 03A816 When reset 0016 Function (During clock synchronous serial I/O mode) Bit name Must be fixed to 001 Serial I/O mode selection bits b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 : Serial I/O invalid 0 1 0 : Inhibited 0 1 1 : Inhibited 1 1 1 : Inhibited SMD1 SMD2 Function (During UART mode) b2 b1 b0 R W AA AA AA AA AA AA A A A A AA 1 0 0 : Transfer data 7 bits long 1 0 1 : Transfer data 8 bits long 1 1 0 : Transfer data 9 bits long 0 0 0 : Serial I/O invalid 0 1 0 : Inhibited 0 1 1 : Inhibited 1 1 1 : Inhibited CKDIR Internal/external clock selection bit 0 : Internal clock 1 : External clock (Note 1) 0 : Internal clock 1 : External clock (Note 1) STPS Stop bit length selection bit Invalid 0 : One stop bit 1 : Two stop bits PRY Odd/even parity selection Invalid bit Valid when bit 6 = “1” 0 : Odd parity 1 : Even parity PRYE Parity enable bit Invalid 0 : Parity disabled 1 : Parity enabled SLEP Sleep selection bit Must always be “0” 0 : Sleep mode deselected 1 : Sleep mode selected Note 1: Set the corresponding port direction register to "0". UART2 transmit/receive mode register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol U2MR b0 Bit symbol SMD0 Address 037816 Bit name When reset 0016 Function (During clock synchronous serial I/O mode) b2 b1 b0 Serial I/O mode selection bits SMD1 SMD2 Must be fixed to 001 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 : Serial I/O invalid 0 1 0 : Inhibited 0 1 1 : Inhibited 1 1 1 : Inhibited 0 : Internal clock 1 : External clock (Note 1) Must always be "0" STPS Stop bit length selection bit Invalid 0 : One stop bit 1 : Two stop bits PRY Odd/even parity selection Invalid bit Valid when bit 6 = “1” 0 : Odd parity 1 : Even parity PRYE Parity enable bit Invalid IOPOL TxD, RxD I/O polarity switching bit 0 : Not reverse 1 : Reverse Usually set to “0” 0 : Parity disabled 1 : Parity enabled 0 : Not reverse 1 : Reverse Usually set to “0” Fig.GA-5 Serial I/O-related registers (2) Jun 06, 2003 page 102 of 290 AA AA AA AA A A A A AA AA AA 1 0 0 : Transfer data 7 bits long 1 0 1 : Transfer data 8 bits long 1 1 0 : Transfer data 9 bits long 0 0 0 : Serial I/O invalid 0 1 0 : Inhibited 0 1 1 : Inhibited 1 1 1 : Inhibited CKDIR Internal/external clock selection bit Note 1: Set the corresponding port direction register to "0". Rev.1.00 Function (During UART mode) R W Serial I/O M16C/6K9 Group UARTi transmit/receive control register 0 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol UiC0(i=0,1) Bit symbol Address When reset 03A416, 03AC16 0816 Function (During clock synchronous serial I/O mode) Bit name b1 b0 CLK0 BRG count source selection bits CLK1 CRS TXEPT CTS/RTS function selection bit Function (During UART mode) b1 b0 0 0 : f1 is selected 0 1 : f8 is selected 1 0 : f32 is selected 1 1 : Inhibited 0 0 : f1 is selected 0 1 : f8 is selected 1 0 : f32 is selected 1 1 : Inhibited Valid when bit 4 = “0” Valid when bit 4 = “0” 0 : CTS function is selected (Note 1) 1 : RTS function is selected (Note 2) 0 : CTS function is selected (Note 1) 1 : RTS function is selected (Note 2) 0 : Data present in transmit 0 : Data present in transmit register Transmit register empty register (during transmission) (during transmission) 1 : No data present in transmit flag 1 : No data present in transmit register (transmission completed) 0 : CTS/RTS function enabled 1 : CTS/RTS function disabled (Pins function as programmable I/O port) register (transmission completed) 0 : CTS/RTS function enabled 1 : CTS/RTS function disabled (Pins function as programmable I/O port) CRD CTS/RTS disable bit NCH Data output selection bit 0 : TXDi pin is CMOS output 0: TXDi pin is CMOS output 1: TXDi pin is N-channel open-drain output CKPOL CLK polarity selection bit 0 : Transmit data is output at Must always be “0” 1 : TXDi pin is N-channel opendrain output falling edge of transfer clock and receive data is input at rising edge 1 : Transmit data is output at rising edge of transfer clock and receive data is input at falling edge UFORM Transfer format selection 0 : LSB first 1 : MSB first bit Must always be “0” AA A A A A A A A R W Note 1: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”. Note 2: The settings of the corresponding port register and port direction register are invalid. UART2 transmit/receive control register 0 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol U2C0 Bit symbol CLK0 Address 037C16 Bit name TXEPT Function (During clock synchronous serial I/O mode) b1 b0 b1 b0 0 0 : f1 is selected 0 1 : f8 is selected 1 0 : f32 is selected 1 1 : Inhibited 0 0 : f1 is selected 0 1 : f8 is selected 1 0 : f32 is selected 1 1 : Inhibited CTS/RTS function selection bit Valid when bit 4 = “0” Valid when bit 4 = “0” 0 : CTS function is selected (Note 1) 0 : CTS function is selected (Note 1) 1 : RTS function is selected (Note 2) 1 : RTS function is selected (Note 2) 0 : Data present in transmit register Transmit register empty 0 : Data present in transmit register (during transmission) (during transmission) flag 1 : No data present in transmit 1 : No data present in transmit register register (transmission completed) CRD Function (During UART mode) BRG count source selection bits CLK1 CRS When reset 0816 CTS/RTS disable bit (transmission completed) 0 : CTS/RTS function enabled 0 : CTS/RTS function enabled 1 : CTS/RTS function disabled 1 : CTS/RTS function disabled (Pins function programmable (Pins function programmable I/O port) I/O port) 0 : TXDi pin is CMOS output Nothing is assigned. : TXDi pin is N-channel In an attempt to write to this bit, write1“0”. The value, if read, turns open-drain output 0 : Transmit data is output at CKPOL CLK polarity selection bit falling edge of transfer clock and receive data is input at rising edge 1 : Transmit data is output at rising edge of transfer clock and receive data is input at falling edge UFORM Transfer format selection 0 : LSB first bit (Note 3) 1 : MSB first 0: TXDi pin is CMOS output 1: TXDi pin is N-channel out to be “0”. open-drain output Must always be “0” 0 : LSB first 1 : MSB first AA A AA R W A A A A Note 1: Set the corresponding port direction register to “0”. Note 2: The settings of the corresponding port register and port direction register are invalid. Note 3: Only clock synchronous serial I/O mode and 8-bit UART mode are valid. Fig.GA-6 Serial I/O-related registers (3) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 103 of 290 Serial I/O M16C/6K9 Group UARTi transmit/receive control register 1 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol UiC1(i=0,1) b0 Bit symbol Address 03A516,03AD16 When reset 0216 Function (During clock synchronous serial I/O mode) Bit name Function (During UART mode) 0 : Transmission disabled 1 : Transmission enabled 0 : Transmission disabled 1 : Transmission enabled TI Transmit buffer empty flag 0 : Data present in transmit buffer register 1 : No data present in transmit buffer register 0 : Data present in transmit buffer register 1 : No data present in transmit buffer register RE Receive enable bit 0 : Reception disabled 1 : Reception enabled 0 : Reception disabled 1 : Reception enabled RI Receive complete flag 0 : No data present in receive buffer register 1 : Data present in receive buffer register 0 : No data present in receive buffer register 1 : Data present in receive buffer register TE Transmit enable bit Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”. AA A AA A A R W UART2 transmit/receive control register 1 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol U2C1 b0 Bit symbol Address 037D16 Bit name Function (During UART mode) 0 : Transmission disabled 1 : Transmission enabled TI Transmit buffer empty flag 0 : Data present in transmit buffer register 1 : No data present in transmit buffer register 0 : Data present in transmit buffer register 1 : No data present in transmit buffer register RE Receive enable bit 0 : Reception disabled 1 : Reception enabled 0 : Reception disabled 1 : Reception enabled RI Receive complete flag 0 : No data present in receive buffer register 1 : Data present in receive buffer register 0 : No data present in receive buffer register 1 : Data present in receive buffer register UART2 transmit interrupt factor selection bit 0 : Transmit buffer empty (TI = 1) 1 : Transmit is completed (TXEPT = 1) 0 : Transmit buffer empty (TI = 1) 1 : Transmit is completed (TXEPT = 1) U2RRM UART2 continuous receive mode enable bit 0 : Continuous receive mode disabled 1 : Continuous receive mode enabled Invalid U2LCH Data logic selection bit 0 : Not reverse 1 : Reverse 0 : Not reverse 1 : Reverse U2ERE Error signal output enable bit Must be fixed to “0” 0 : Output disabled 1 : Output enabled U2IRS Transmit enable bit Fig.GA-7 Serial I/O-related registers (4) Jun 06, 2003 Function (During clock synchronous serial I/O mode) 0 : Transmission disabled 1 : Transmission enabled TE Rev.1.00 When reset 0216 page 104 of 290 AA A A A A A A AA A AA AA AA AA R W Serial I/O M16C/6K9 Group UART transmit/receive control register 2 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol UCON Bit symbol U0IRS U1IRS Address 03B016 When reset X00000002 Function (During clock synchronous serial I/O mode) Bit name UART0 transmit interrupt factor selection bit 0 : Transmit buffer empty (Tl = 1) 1 : Transmission completed UART1 transmit interrupt factor selection bit 0 : Transmit buffer empty (Tl = 1) 1 : Transmission completed (TXEPT = 1) (TXEPT = 1) U0RRM UART0 continuous receive mode enable bit 0 : Continuous receive mode disabled 1 : Continuous receive mode enabled U1RRM UART1 continuous receive mode enable bit Function (During UART mode) 0 : Transmit buffer empty (Tl = 1) 1 : Transmission completed (TXEPT = 1) 0 : Transmit buffer empty (Tl = 1) 1 : Transmission completed (TXEPT = 1) Invalid 0 : Continuous receive mode disabled 1 : Continuous receive mode enabled CLKMD0 CLK/CLKS selection bit 0 Valid when bit 5 = “1” 0 : Clock output to CLK1 1 : Clock output to CLKS1 Invalid CLKMD1 CLK/CLKS selection bit 1 0 : Normal mode (CLK output is CLK1 only) (Note) 1 : Transfer clock output from multiple pins function selected Must always be “0” RCSP 0 : CTS/RTS shared pin 1 : CTS/RTS separated Separate CTS/RTS bit AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A RW Invalid 0 : CTS/RTS shared pin 1 : CTS/RTS separated Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate. Note: When using multiple pins to output the transfer clock, the following requirements must be met: • UART1 internal/external clock selection bit (bit 3 at address 03A816) = “0”. UART2 special mode register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol U2SMR 0 0 0 0 Bit symbol Address 037716 Bit name When reset 0016 Function (During clock synchronous serial I/O mode) Function (During UART mode) Reserved bits Must always be “0” ABSCS Bus collision detect sampling clock selection bit Must always be “0” 0 : Rising edge of transfer clock 1 : Underflow signal of timer A0 ACSE Auto clear function selection bit of transmit enable bit Must always be “0” 0 : No auto clear function 1 : Auto clear at occurrence of bus collision SSS Transmit start condition selection bit Must always be “0” 0 : Ordinary 1 : Falling edge of RxD2 Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”. Fig.GA-8 Serial I/O-related registers (5) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 105 of 290 R W A A A M16C/6K9 Group Serial I/O Clock synchronous serial I/O mode (1) Clock synchronous serial I/O mode The clock synchronous serial I/O mode uses a transfer clock to transmit and receive data. Tables.GA-2 and GA-3 list the specifications of the clock synchronous serial I/O mode. Fig.GA-9 shows the UARTi transmit/ receive mode register. Table.GA-2 Specifications of clock synchronous serial I/O mode (1) Item Specification Transfer data format • Transfer data length: 8 bits Transfer clock • When internal clock is selected (bit 3 at addresses 03A016, 03A816, 037816 = “0”) : fi/ 2(n+1) (Note 1) fi = f1, f8, f32 • When external clock is selected (bit 3 at addresses 03A016, 03A816, 037816 = “1”) : Input from CLKi pin _______ _______ _______ _______ Transmission/reception control • Selecting from CTS function/RTS function/Disable CTS, RTS function Transmission start condition • To start transmission, the following requirements must be met: _ Transmit enable bit (bit 0 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “1” _ Transmit buffer empty flag (bit 1 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “0” _______ _______ _ When CTS function selected, CTS input level = “L” • Furthermore, if external clock is selected, the following requirements must also be met: _ CLKi polarity select bit (bit 6 at addresses 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “0”: CLKi input level = “H” _ CLKi polarity select bit (bit 6 at addresses 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “1”: CLKi input level = “L” Reception start condition • To start reception, the following requirements must be met: _ Receive enable bit (bit 2 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “1” _ Transmit enable bit (bit 0 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “1” _ Transmit buffer empty flag (bit 1 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “0” • Furthermore, if external clock is selected, the following requirements must also be met: _ CLKi polarity select bit (bit 6 at addresses 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “0”: CLKi input level = “H” _ CLKi polarity select bit (bit 6 at addresses 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “1”: CLKi input level = “L” • When transmitting _ Transmit interrupt factor selection bits (bits 0, 1 at address 03B016, bit 4 at Interrupt request address 037D16) = “0”: At the completion of data transmission from UARTi generation timing transfer buffer register to UARTi transmit register _ Transmit interrupt factor selection bits (bits 0, 1 at address 03B016, bit 4 at address 037D16) = “1”: At the completion of data transmission from UARTi transfer register is completed • When receiving _ At the completion of data transferring from UARTi receive register to UARTi receive buffer register Error detection • Overrun error (Note 2) This error occurs when the next data is ready before contents of UARTi receive buffer register are read out Note 1: “n” denotes the value 0016 to FF16 that is set to the UART bit rate generator. Note 2: If an overrun error occurs, the UARTi receive buffer will have the next data written in. Note also that the UARTi receive interrupt request bit is not set to “1”. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 106 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Serial I/O Clock synchronous serial I/O mode Table.GA-3 Specifications of clock synchronous serial I/O mode (2) Item Function selection Specification • CLK polarity selection Whether transmit data is output/input at the rising edge or falling edge of the transfer clock can be selected • LSB first/MSB first selection Whether transmission/reception begins with bit 0 or bit 7 can be selected • Continuous receive mode selection Reception is enabled simultaneously by a read from the receive buffer register • Transfer clock output from multiple pins selection (UART1) (Note) UART1 transfer clock can be chosen by software to be output from one of the two pins set _______ _______ • Separate CTS/RTS pins (UART0) (Note) _______ _______ Each of UART0 CTS and RTS pins can be assigned to separate pins • Switching serial data logic (UART2) Whether to reverse data in writing to the transmission buffer register or reading the reception buffer register can be selected. • TxD, RxD I/O polarity switching (UART2) This function is reversing TxD port output and RxD port input. All I/O data level is reversed. _______ _______ Note: The transfer clock output from multiple pins and the separate CTS/RTS pins functions cannot be selected simultaneously. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 107 of 290 Serial I/O M16C/6K9 Group Clock synchronous serial I/O mode UARTi transmit/receive mode registers b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 0 b2 b1 b0 0 0 1 Symbol UiMR(i=0,1) Bit symbol SMD0 Address 03A016, 03A816 When reset 0016 Bit name Function Serial I/O mode selection bits SMD1 SMD2 CKDIR Internal/external clock selection bit b2 b1 b0 0 0 1 : Clock synchronous serial I/O mode 0 : Internal clock 1 : External clock (Note 1) STPS PRY Invalid in clock synchronous serial I/O mode PRYE 0 (Must always be “0” in clock synchronous serial I/O mode) SLEP AA A A AA AA AA AA A A AA AA AA RW Note 1: The corresponding port direction register should be "0". UART2 transmit/receive mode register b7 b6 b5 b4 0 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol U2MR 0 0 1 Bit symbol SMD0 Address 037816 Bit name Serial I/O mode selection bit SMD1 SMD2 CKDIR When reset 0016 Internal/external clock selection bit Function b2 b1 b0 0 0 1 : Clock synchronous serial I/O mode 0 : Internal clock 1 : External clock (Note 2) STPS PRY Invalid in clock synchronous serial I/O mode PRYE IOPOL TxD, RxD I/O polarity reverse bit (Note 1) A A AA A AA A AA AA AA AA RW 0 : No reverse 1 : Reverse Note 1: Usually sent to "0". Note 2: The corresponding port direction register should be "0". Fig.GA-9 UARTi transmit/receive mode register in clock synchronous serial I/O mode Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 108 of 290 Serial I/O M16C/6K9 Group Clock synchronous serial I/O mode Table.GA-4 lists the functions of the input/output pins during clock synchronous serial I/O mode. This table _______ _______ shows the pin functions that the transfer clock output from multiple pins and the separation of CTS/RTS pins are not selected. Note that for a period from when the UARTi operation mode is selected to when transfer starts, the TxDi pin outputs a “H”. (If the N-channel open-drain is selected, this pin is in floating state.) Table.GA-4 Input/output pin functions in clock synchronous serial I/O mode (The function that the transfer clock output from multiple pin is not selected. The function that separates CTS/RTS pins is not selected.) Pin name Function Method of selection TxDi Serial data output (Outputs dummy data when performing reception only) RxDi Serial data input The corresponding bit of port direction register = “0” (Can be used as an input port when performing transmission only) CLKi Transfer clock output Internal/external clock select bit (bit 3 at address 03A016, 03A816, 037816) = “0” Transfer clock input Internal/external clock select bit (bit 3 at address 03A016, 03A816, 037816) = “1” The corresponding bit of port direction register = “0” CTS input CTS/RTS disable bit (bit 4 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) =“0” CTS/RTS function selection bit (bit 2 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “0” The corresponding port direction bit = “0” RTS output CTS/RTS disable bit (bit 4 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “0” CTS/RTS function selection bit (bit 2 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “1” Programmable I/O port CTS/RTS disable bit (bit 4 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “1” CTSi/RTSi Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 109 of 290 Serial I/O M16C/6K9 Group Clock synchronous serial I/O mode • Example of transmit timing (when internal clock is selected) Tc Transfer clock “1” Transmit enable bit (TE) “0” Data is set in UARTi transmit buffer register “1” Transmit buffer empty flag (Tl) “0” Transferred from UARTi transmit buffer register to UARTi transmit register “H” CTSi TCLK “L” Stopped because CTS = “H” Stopped because transfer enable bit = “0” CLKi TxDi D 0 D1 D2 D 3 D 4 D 5 D 6 D 7 Transmit register empty flag (TXEPT) D0 D1 D2 D 3 D 4 D5 D 6 D7 D0 D 1 D2 D 3 D 4 D 5 D 6 D 7 “1” “0” Transmit interrupt “1” “0” request bit (IR) Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software Shown in ( ) are bit symbols. Tc = TCLK = 2(n + 1) / fi fi: frequency of BRGi count source (f1, f8, f32) n: value set to BRGi The above timing applies to the following settings: • Internal clock is selected. • CTS function is selected. • CLK polarity selection bit = “0”. • Transmit interrupt factor selection bit = “0”. • Example of receive timing (when external clock is selected) “1” Receive enable bit (RE) “0” Transmit enable bit (TE) “0” Transmit buffer empty flag (Tl) “1” “0” “H” RTSi Dummy data is set in UARTi transmit buffer register “1” Transferred from UARTi transmit buffer register to UARTi transmit register “L” 1 / fEXT CLKi Receive data is taken in D0 D1 D 2 D 3 D4 D5 D 6 D7 RxDi “1” Receive complete “0” flag (Rl) Receive interrupt request bit (IR) Transferred from UARTi receive register to UARTi receive buffer register D 0 D1 D 2 D 3 D4 D5 Read out from UARTi receive buffer register “1” “0” Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software Shown in ( ) are bit symbols. The above timing applies to the following settings: • External clock is selected. • RTS function is selected. • CLK polarity selection bit = “0”. fEXT: frequency of external clock The following conditions should be matched when the input level of CLKi pin is "H" before the data reception. • Transmit enable bit “1” • Receive enable bit “1” • Dummy data write to UARTi transmit buffer register Fig.GA-10 Typical transmit/receive timings in clock synchronous serial I/O mode Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 110 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Serial I/O Clock synchronous serial I/O mode (a) Polarity selection function As shown in Fig.GA-11, the CLK polarity selection bit (bit 6 at addresses 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) allows to select the polarity of the transfer clock. • When CLK polarity selection bit = “0” CLKi TXDi D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 RXDi D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Note 1: The CLK pin level is "H" when there is no transferring. • When CLK polarity select bit = “1” CLKi TXDi D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 RXDi D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Note 2: The CLK pin level is "L" when there is no transferring. Fig.GA-11 Polarity of transfer clock (b) LSB first/MSB first selection function As shown in Fig.GA-12, when the transfer format selection bit (bit 7 at addresses 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “0”, the transfer format is “LSB first”; when the bit = “1”, the transfer format is “MSB first”. • When transfer format selection bit = “0” CLKi TXDi D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 RXDi D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 LSB first • When transfer format selection bit = “1” CLKi TXDi D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 RXDi D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 MSB first Note: This applies when the CLK polarity selection bit = “0”. Fig.GA-12 Transfer format Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 111 of 290 Serial I/O M16C/6K9 Group Clock synchronous serial I/O mode (c) Transfer clock output from multiple pins function (UART1) This function allows to set two transfer clock output pins and chooses one to output a clock by the setting of CLK and CLKS selection bits (bits 4 and 5 at address 03B016). (See Fig.GA-13) The function is valid only _______ _______ when the UART1 internal clock is selected. Note that when this function is selected, UART1 CTS/RTS function cannot be used. Microcomputer TXD1 CLKS1 CLK1 IN IN CLK CLK Fig.GA-13 The sample of transfer clock output from the multiple pins function (d) Continuous receive mode If the continuous receive mode enable bits (bits 2 and 3 at address 03B016, bit 5 at address 037D16) are set to “1”, the unit is placed in continuous receive mode. In this mode, when the receive buffer register is read out, the unit simultaneously goes to a receive enable state without having to set dummy data to the transmit buffer register back again. _______ _______ (e) Separate CTS/RTS pins function (UART0) This function works the same way as in the clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode. The method of setting and the input/output pin functions are both the same, so refer to the selection function in the next section, “(2) Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode.” Note that this function is invalid if the transfer clock output from the multiple pins function is selected. (f) Serial data logic switch function (UART2) When the data logic selection bit (bit6 at address 037D16) = “1”, the data writing to transmit buffer register or reading from receive buffer register, are reversed. Fig.GA-14 shows the example of serial data logic switch timing. •When LSB first Transfer clock “H” “L” TxD2 “H” (no reverse) “L” TxD2 “H” (reverse) “L” D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Fig.GA-14 Serial data logic switch timing Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 112 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode (2) Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode The UART mode allows transmitting and receiving data after setting the desired transfer rate and transfer data format. Tables.GA-5 and GA-6 list the specifications of the UART mode. Fig.GA-15 shows the UARTi transmit/receive mode register. Table.GA-5 Specifications of UART Mode (1) Item Transfer data format Specification • Character bit (transfer data): 7 bits, 8 bits, or 9 bits as selected • Start bit: 1 bit • Parity bit: Odd, even, or nothing as selected • Stop bit: 1 bit or 2 bits as selected Transfer clock • When internal clock is selected (bit 3 at addresses 03A016, 03A816, 037816 = “0”) : fi/16(n+1) (Note 1) fi = f1, f8, f32 • When external clock is selected (bit 3 at addresses 03A016, 03A816 =“1”) : fEXT/16(n+1)(Note 1) (Note 2) • Do not select the external clock in UART2. _______ _______ _______ _______ Transmission/reception control • Selecting from CTS function/ RTS function/ Disable CTS, RTS function Transmission start condition • To start transmission, the following requirements must be met: - Transmit enable bit (bit 0 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “1” - Transmit buffer empty flag (bit 1 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “0” _______ _______ - When CTS function is selected CTS input level = “L” Reception start condition • To start reception, the following requirements must be met: - Receive enable bit (bit 2 at addresses 03A516, 03AD16, 037D16) = “1” - Start bit detection Interrupt request • When transmitting generation timing - Transmit interrupt factor selection bits (bits 0,1 at address 03B016, bit4 at address 037D16) = “0”: At the completion of data transferring from UARTi transfer buffer register to UARTi transmit register - Transmit interrupt factor selection bits (bits 0, 1 at address 03B016, bit4 at address 037D16) = “1”: At the completion of data transmission from UARTi transfer register • When receiving - At the completion of data transferring from UARTi receive register to UARTi receive buffer register Error detection • Overrun error (Note 3) This error occurs when the bit prior to the stop bit of next data is received before the contents of UARTi receive buffer register are read out. • Framing error This error occurs when the number set for stop bits is not detected • Parity error This error occurs in the case that parity is enabled and the number of "1" in parity bit and character bits does not match the number of "1" in parity odd/ even setting. • Error sum flag This flag is set (= 1) when any of the overrun, framing, and parity errors is encountered Note 1: ‘n’ denotes the value 0016 to FF16 that is set to the UARTi bit rate register. Note 2: fEXT is input from the CLKi pin. Note 3: If an overrun error occurs, the UARTi receive buffer will have the next data written in. Also note that the UARTi receive interrupt request bit is not set to “1”. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 113 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode Table.GA-6 Specifications of UART Mode (2) Item Specification _______ _______ Function selection Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 • Separate CTS/RTS pins (UART0) _______ _______ Each of UART0 CTS and RTS pins can be assigned to separate pins • Sleep mode selection (UART0, UART1) This mode is used to transfer data to and from one of multiple slave microcomputers • Serial data logic switch (UART2) This function is reversing logic value of transferring data. Start bit,and stop bit are not reversed. • TXD, RXD I/O polarity switch (UART2) This function is reversing TXD port output and RXD port input. All I/O data level are reversed. page 114 of 290 Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode M16C/6K9 Group UARTi transmit / receive mode registers b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol UiMR(i=0,1) Bit symbol SMD0 Address 03A016, 03A816 When reset 0016 Bit name Function Serial I/O mode selection bits SMD1 SMD2 b2 b1 b0 1 0 0 : Transfer data 7 bits long 1 0 1 : Transfer data 8 bits long 1 1 0 : Transfer data 9 bits long CKDIR Internal / external clock selection bit 0 : Internal clock 1 : External clock (Note 1) STPS Stop bit length select bit 0 : One stop bit 1 : Two stop bits PRY Odd / even parity select bit Valid when bit 6 = “1” 0 : Odd parity 1 : Even parity PRYE Parity enable bit 0 : Parity disabled 1 : Parity enabled SLEP Sleep selection bit 0 : Sleep mode deselected 1 : Sleep mode selected AA A AA A A A A A A AA AA A A AA R W Note 1: The corresponding port direction register should be "0". UART2 transmit / receive mode register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol U2MR b0 Address 037816 Bit symbol SMD0 When reset 0016 Bit name Serial I/O mode selection bits SMD1 SMD2 Function b2 b1 b0 1 0 0 : Transfer data 7 bits long 1 0 1 : Transfer data 8 bits long 1 1 0 : Transfer data 9 bits long CKDIR Internal / external clock selection bit Must always be "0" STPS Stop bit length select bit 0 : One stop bit 1 : Two stop bits PRY Odd / even parity selection bit Valid when bit 6 = “1” 0 : Odd parity 1 : Even parity PRYE Parity enable bit 0 : Parity disabled 1 : Parity enabled IOPOL TxD, RxD I/O polarity switching bit (Note) 0 : No reverse 1 : Reverse Note: Usually set to “0”. Fig.GA-15 UARTi transmit/receive mode register in UART mode Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 115 of 290 A A A A AA A A A AA A AA AA AA R W Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode M16C/6K9 Group Table.GA-7 lists the functions of the input/output pins during UART mode. This table shows the pin functions _______ _______ when the separate CTS/RTS pins function is not selected. Note that for a period from when the UARTi operation mode is selected to when transfer starts, the TxDi pin outputs a “H”. (If the N-channel open-drain is selected, this pin is in floating state.) ________________ Table.GA-7 Input/output pin functions in UART mode (when CTS/RTS separate function is not selected) Pin name Function Method of selection TxDi Serial data output RxDi Serial data input Corresponding port direction register bit = "0".(Can be used as an input port when performing transmission only) CLKi Programmable I/O port Internal/external clock selection bit (bit 3 at address 03A016, 03A816, 037816) = “0” Transfer clock input Internal/external clock selection bit (bit 3 at address 03A016, 03A816) = “1” Corresponding port direction register bit = “0” (Don't select the external clock for UART2) CTS input CTS/RTS disable bit (bit 4 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) =“0” CTS/RTS function selection bit (bit 2 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “0” Corresponding port direction register bit = “0” RTS output CTS/RTS disable bit (bit 4 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “0” CTS/RTS function selection bit (bit 2 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “1” Programmable I/O port CTS/RTS disable bit (bit 4 at address 03A416, 03AC16, 037C16) = “1” CTSi/RTSi Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 116 of 290 Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode M16C/6K9 Group • Example of transmit timing when transfer data are 8 bits long (parity enabled, one stop bit) The transfer clock stops momentarily as CTS is “H” when the stop bit is checked. The transfer clock starts as the transfer starts immediately CTS changes to “L”. Tc Transfer clock Transmit enable bit(TE) “1” Transmit buffer empty flag(TI) “1” “0” Data is set in UARTi transmit buffer register. “0” Transferred from UARTi transmit buffer register to UARTi transmit register “H” CTSi “L” Start bit TxDi Parity bit ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P Stopped because transmit enable bit = “0” Stop bit SP ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 ST D0 D1 P SP “1” Transmit register empty flag (TXEPT) “0” Transmit interrupt request bit (IR) “1” “0” Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software Shown in ( ) are bit symbols. The above timing applies to the following settings : • Parity is enabled. • One stop bit. • CTS function is selected. • Transmit interrupt factor selection bit = “1”. Tc = 16 (n + 1) / fi or 16 (n + 1) / fEXT fi : frequency of BRGi count source (f1, f8, f32) fEXT : frequency of BRGi count source (external clock) n : value set to BRGi • Example of transmit timing when transfer data are 9 bits long (parity disabled, two stop bits) Tc Transfer clock Transmit enable bit(TE) “1” Transmit buffer empty flag(TI) “1” “0” Data is set in UARTi transmit buffer register “0” Transferred from UARTi transmit buffer register to UARTi transmit register Start bit TxDi Stop bit ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 SP SP Stop bit ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 SPSP ST D0 D1 “1” Transmit register empty flag (TXEPT) “0” Transmit interrupt request bit (IR) “1” “0” Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software Shown in ( ) are bit symbols. The above timing applies to the following settings : • Parity is disabled. • Two stop bits. • CTS function is disabled. • Transmit interrupt factor selection bit = “0”. Tc = 16 (n + 1) / fi or 16 (n + 1) / fEXT fi : frequency of BRGi count source (f1, f8, f32) fEXT : frequency of BRGi count source (external clock) n : value set to BRGi Fig.GA-16 Typical transmit timings in UART mode Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 117 of 290 Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode M16C/6K9 Group • Example of transmit timing when transfer data are 8 bits long (parity enabled, one stop bit) Tc Transfer clock Transmit enable bit(TE) “1” Transmit buffer empty flag(TI) “1” “0” Data is set in USAR2 transmit buffer register Note1 “0” Transferred from UART2 transmit buffer register to UART2 transmit register Start bit TxD2 Parity Stop bit bit ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP “1” Transmit register empty flag (TXEPT) “0” Transmit interrupt request bit (IR) “1” “0” Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software Shown in ( ) are bit symbols. The above timing applies to the following settings : • Parity is enabled. • One stop bit. • Transmit interrupt factor selection bit = “1”. Tc = 16 (n + 1) / fi fi : frequency of BRGi count source (f1, f8, f32) n : value set to BRGi Note1. According to the above timing, the transmission is started by the timing of BRG overflow after writing to the transmit buffer. Fig.GA-17 Typical transmit timings in UART mode (UART2) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 118 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode • Example of receive timing when transfer data are 8 bits long (parity disabled, one stop bit) BRGi count source Receive enable bit “1” “0” Stop bit Start bit RxDi D0 D1 D7 Sampled “L” Receive data taken in Transfer clock Receive complete flag RTSi Receive interrupt request bit Reception triggered when transfer clock “1” is generated by falling edge of start bit “0” “H” “L” “1” “0” Transferred from UARTi receive register to UARTi receive buffer register Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software The above timing applies to the following settings : •Parity is disabled. •One stop bit. •RTS function is selected. Fig.GA-18 Typical receive timing in UART mode _______ _______ (a) Separate CTS/RTS pins function (UART0) _______ _______ _______ _______ Setting the CTS/RTS separate bit (bit 6 of address 03B016) to "1" separates the RTS and CTS signals to _______ _______ _______ _______ different input/out pins.(Fig GA-19). Choosing one from CTS or RTS, by using of the CTS/RTS function selection bit (bit 2 of address 03A416). This function is effective in UART0 only. If the function is used, the _______ _______ _______ _______ user cannot use the CTS/RTS function of UART1. Set "0" both to the CTS/RTS function selection bit (bit 2 of _______ _______ address 03AC16) and to the CTS/RTS disable bit (bit 4 of address 03AC16). IC Microcomputer TXD0 IN RXD0 OUT RTS0 CTS CTS0 RTS Note : The user cannot use CTS and RTS at the same time. _______ _______ Fig.GA-19 The separate CTS/RTS pins function usage (b) Sleep mode (UART0, UART1) This mode is used to transfer data between specific microcomputers among multiple microcomputers connected with UARTi. The sleep mode is selected when the sleep selection bit (bit 7 at addresses 03A016, 03A816) is set to “1” during reception. In this mode, the unit performs receive operation when the MSB of the received data = “1” and does not perform receive operation when the MSB = “0”. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 119 of 290 Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode M16C/6K9 Group (c) Function for switching serial data logic (UART2) When the data logic selection bit (bit 6 of address 037D16) is assigned 1, data is inverted in writing to the transmission buffer register or reading the reception buffer register. Fig.GA-20 shows the example of timing for switching serial data logic. • When LSB first, parity enabled, one stop bit Transfer clock “H” “L” TxD2 “H” (no reverse) “L” TxD2 “H” (reverse) ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP “L” ST : Start bit P : Even parity SP : Stop bit Fig.GA-20 Timing for switching serial data logic (d) TxD, RxD I/O polarity switching function (UART2) This function is to reverse TXD pin output and RXD pin input. The level of any data to be input or output (including the start bit, stop bit(s), and parity bit) is reversed. Set this function to “0” (not to reverse) for usual use. (e) Bus collision detection function (UART2) This function is to sample the output level of the TXD pin and the input level of the RXD pin at the rising edge of the transfer clock; if their values are different, then an interrupt request occurs. Fig.GA-21 shows the example of detection timing of a bus collision (in UART mode). Transfer clock “H” “L” TxD2 “H” “L” RxD2 “H” ST SP ST SP “L” Bus collision detection interrupt request signal “1” Bus collision detection interrupt request bit “1” “0” “0” ST : Start bit SP : Stop bit Fig.GA-21 Detection timing of a bus collision (in UART mode) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 120 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode (3) Clock-asynchronous serial I/O mode (compliant with the SIM interface) The SIM interface is used for connecting the microcomputer with a memory card IC or the like; adding some extra settings in UART2 clock-asynchronous serial I/O mode allows the user to effect this function. Table.GA-8 shows the specifications of clock-asynchronous serial I/O mode (compliant with the SIM interface). Table.GA-8 Specifications of clock-asynchronous serial I/O mode (compliant with SIM I/F) Item Transfer data format Transfer clock Specification • Transfer data 8-bit UART mode (bit 2 through bit 0 of address 037816 = “1012”) • One stop bit (bit 4 of address 037816 = “0”) • With the direct format chosen Set parity to “even” (bit 5 and bit 6 of address 037816 = “1” and “1” respectively) Set data logic to “direct” (bit 6 of address 037D16 = “0”). Set transfer format to LSB (bit 7 of address 037C16 = “0”). • With the inverse format chosen Set parity to “odd” (bit 5 and bit 6 of address 037816 = “0” and “1” respectively) Set data logic to “inverse” (bit 6 of address 037D16 = “1”) Set transfer format to MSB (bit 7 of address 037C16 = “1”) • With the internal clock chosen (bit 3 of address 037816 = “0”) : fi / 16 (n + 1) (Note 1) : fi=f1, f8, f32 • Don't chose external clock. _______ _______ Transmission / reception control • Disable the CTS and RTS function (bit 4 of address 037C16 = “1”) Other settings • The sleep mode selection function is not available for UART2 • Set transmission interrupt factor to “transmission completed” (bit 4 of address 037D16 = “1”) Transmission start condition • To start transmission, the following requirements must be met: - Transmit enable bit (bit 0 of address 037D16) = “1” - Transmit buffer empty flag (bit 1 of address 037D16) = “0” Reception start condition • To start reception, the following requirements must be met: - Reception enable bit (bit 2 of address 037D16) = “1” - Detection of a start bit Interrupt request • When transmitting generation timing When data transmission from the UART2 transfer register is completed (bit 4 of address 037D16 = “1”) • When receiving When data transfer from the UART2 receive register to the UART2 receive buffer register is completed Error detection • Overrun error (see the specifications of clock-asynchronous serial I/O) (Note 2) • Framing error (see the specifications of clock-asynchronous serial I/O) • Parity error (see the specifications of clock-asynchronous serial I/O) - On the reception side, an “L” level is output from the TXD2 pin by use of the parity error signal output function (bit 7 of address 037D16 = “1”) when a parity error is detected - On the transmission side, a parity error is detected by the level of input to the RXD2 pin when a transmission interrupt occurs • The error sum flag (see the specifications of clock-asynchronous serial I/O) Note 1: ‘n’ denotes the value 0016 to FF16 that is set to the UARTi bit rate generator. Note 2: If an overrun error occurs, the UART2 receive buffer will have the next data written in. Also Note that the UARTi receive interrupt request bit is not set to “1”. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 121 of 290 Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode M16C/6K9 Group Tc Transfer clock Transmit enable bit(TE) “1” Transmit buffer empty flag(TI) “1” “0” Data is set in UART2 transmit buffer register Note1 “0” Transferred from UART2 transmit buffer register to UART2 transmit register Start bit TxD2 Parity bit ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P Stop bit ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 SP RxD2 P SP P SP A "L" level returns from TxD2 due to the occurrence of a parity error Signal conductor level (Note1) ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Transmit register empty flag (TXEPT) “1” Transmit interrupt request bit (IR) “1” P ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 SP The level is detected by the interrupt routine The level is detected by the interrupt routine “0” “0” Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software Shown in ( ) are bit symbols. The above timing applies to the following settings : • Parity is enabled. • One stop bit. • Transmit interrupt cause select bit = “1”. Tc = 16 (n + 1) / fi fi : frequency of BRG2 count source (f1, f8, f32) n : value set to BRG2 Note 1. According to the above timing, the transmission is started by the timing of BRG overflow after writing to the transmit buffer. Tc Transfer clock Receive enable bit(RE) “1” “0” Start bit RxD2 Parity bit ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P Stop bit SP TxD2 ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP P SP A "L" level returns from TxD2 due to the occurrence of a parity error Signal conductor level (Note 2) ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Receive complete flag (RI) “1” Receive interrupt request bit (IR) “1” P SP ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 “0” Read to receive buffer Read to receive buffer “0” Cleared to “0” when interrupt request is accepted, or cleared by software Shown in ( ) are bit symbols. The above timing applies to the following settings : • Parity is enabled. • One stop bit. • Transmit interrupt cause select bit = “1”. Tc = 16 (n + 1) / fi fi : frequency of BRG2 count source (f1, f8, f32) n : value set to BRG2 Note 2. The waveforms are the same because TxD2 and RxD2 are connected. Fig.GA-22 Typical transmit/receive timing in UART mode (compliant with the SIM interface) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 122 of 290 Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode M16C/6K9 Group (a) Function for outputting a parity error signal With the error signal output enable bit (bit 7 of address 037D16) assigned “1”, an “L” level from the TxD2 pin will be output when a parity error is detected. Link with this function, the timing to generate a transmission completion interrupt varies according to the timing of a parity error signal detection. Fig.GA-23 shows the timing of the parity error signal output. • LSB first Transfer clock “H” “L” RxD2 “H” TxD2 “H” ST D0 D1 D2 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP Hi-Z “L” Receive complete flag D3 “L” “1” “0” ST : Start bit P : Even parity SP : Stop bit Fig.GA-23 Timing of the parity error signal output (b) Direct format/inverse format Connecting the SIM card allows you to switch between direct format and inverse format. If you choose the direct format, data are output from TxD2 beginning with D0. If you choose the inverse format, data are inverted and output from TxD2 beginning with D7. Fig.GA-24 shows the SIM interface format. Transfer clcck TxD2 (direct) D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P TxD2 (inverse) D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 P P : Even parity Fig.GA-24 SIM interface format Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 123 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode Fig.GA-25 shows the example of connecting the SIM interface. Connect TXD2 and RXD2 and apply pull-up. Microcomputer SIM card TxD2 RxD2 Fig.GA-25 Connecting the SIM interface Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 124 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode UART2 Special Mode Register The UART2 special mode register (address 037716) is used to control UART2 in various ways. Fig.GA-26 shows the UART2 special mode register. UART2 special mode register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol U2SMR 0 0 0 0 Bit symbol Address 037716 Bit name When reset 0016 Function (During clock synchronous serial I/O mode) Function (During UART mode) Reserved bits Must always be “0” ABSCS Bus collision detect sampling clock selection bit Must always be “0” 0 : Rising edge of transfer clock 1 : Underflow signal of timer A0 ACSE Auto clear function selection bit of transmit enable bit Must always be “0” 0 : No auto clear function 1 : Auto clear at occurrence of bus collision Transmit start condition selection bit Must always be “0” 0 : Ordinary 1 : Falling edge of RxD2 Reserved bit Must always be “0” SSS R W A A A Fig.GA-26 UART2 special mode register Some other functions added are explained here. Fig.GA-27 shows their workings. Bit 4 of the UART2 special mode register is used as the bus collision detect sampling clock selection bit. The bus collision detect interrupt occurs when the RxD2 level and TxD2 level do not match, but the nonconformity is detected in synchronization with the rising edge of the transfer clock signal if the bit is set to “0”. If this bit is set to “1”, the nonconformity is detected at the timing of the overflow of timer A0 rather than at the rising edge of the transfer clock. Bit 5 of the UART2 special mode register is used as the auto clear function selection bit of transmit enable bit. Setting this bit to “1” automatically resets the transmit enable bit to “0” when “1” is set in the bus collision detect interrupt request bit (nonconformity). Bit 6 of the UART2 special mode register is used as the transmit start condition selection bit. Setting this bit to “1” starts the TxD transmission in synchronization with the falling edge of the RxD pin. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 125 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode 1. Bus collision detect sampling clock select bit (Bit 4 of the UART2 special mode register) 0: Rising edges of the transfer clock CLK TxD/RxD 1: Timer A0 overflow Timer A0 2. Auto clear function selection bit of transmit enable bit (Bit 5 of the UART2 special mode register) CLK TxD/RxD Bus collision detect interrupt request bit Transmit enable bit 3. Transmit start condition selection bit (Bit 6 of the UART2 special mode register) 0: In normal state CLK TxD Enabling transmission With "1: falling edge of RxD2" selected CLK TxD RxD Fig.GA-27 Some other functions added Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 126 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode S I/O3, 4 S I/O3, 4 S I/O 3 and S I/O 4 are exclusive clock-synchronous serial I/Os. Fig.GA-28 shows the S I/O 3, 4 block diagram, and Fig.GA-29 shows the S I/O 3, 4 control register. Table.GA-9 shows the specifications of S I/O 3, 4. f1 Data bus SMi1 SMi0 f8 f32 Synchronous circuit 1/2 1/(ni+1) Transfer rate register (8) SMi3 SMi6 SMi6 S I/O counter i (3) CLKi SMi2 SMi3 SMi5 LSB MSB SOUTi S I/Oi transmission/reception register (8) SINi 8 Note: i = 3, 4. ni = A value set in the S I/O transfer rate register i (036316, 036716). Fig.GA-28 S I/O3, 4 block diagram Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 127 of 290 S I/Oi interrupt request M16C/6K9 Group Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode S I/O3, 4 S I/Oi control register (i = 3, 4) (Note 1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol SiC 0 Bit symbol SMi0 Address 036216, 036616 When reset 4016 Description Bit name R W b1 b0 Internal synchronous clock selection bits 0 0 : Selecting f1 0 1 : Selecting f8 1 0 : Selecting f32 1 1 : Not to be used SMi1 SMi2 SOUTi output disable bit 0 : SOUTi output 1 : SOUTi output disable (high impedance) SMi3 S I/Oi port selection bit (Note 2) 0 : Input-output port 1 : SOUTi output, CLK function Reserved bit Must be "0" SMi5 Transfer direction selection bit lect bitç 0 : LSB first 1 : MSB first SMi6 Synchronous clock selection bit (Note 2) 0 : External clock 1 : Internal clock SMi7 SOUTi initial value set bit Effective when SMi3 = 0 0 : L output 1 : H output Note 1: Set "1" in bit 2 of the protection register (000A16) in advance to write to the S I/Oi control register (i = 3, 4). Note 2: When SI/Oi port selection bit (i= 3, 4) is set to "0" as for I/O port, set the synchronous clock selection bit to "1". SI/Oi bit rate generator b7 Symbol S3BRG S4BRG b0 Address 036316 036716 When reset Indeterminate Indeterminate Indeterminate Values that can be set Assuming that set value = n, BRGi divides the count source by n + 1 R W 0016 to FF16 SI/Oi transmission/reception register b7 Symbol S3TRR S4TRR b0 Address 036016 036416 When reset Indeterminate Indeterminate Indeterminate Transmission/reception starts by writing data to this register. After transmission/reception finishes, reception data is input. Fig.GA-29 S I/O3, 4 control registers Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 128 of 290 R W M16C/6K9 Group Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode S I/O3, 4 Table.GA-9 Specifications of S I/O3, 4 Item Transfer data format Transfer clock Conditions for transmission/ reception start Interrupt request generation timing Select function Precaution Specifications • Transfer data length: 8 bits • With the internal clock selected (bit 6 of 036216, 036616 = “1”): f1/2(ni+1), f8/2(ni+1), f32/2(ni+1) (Note 1) • With the external clock selected (bit 6 of 036216, 036616 = 0):Input from the CLKi terminal (Note 2) • To start transmit/reception, the following requirements must be met: - Select the synchronous clock (use bit 6 of 036216, 036616). Select a frequency dividing ratio if the internal clock has been selected (use bits 0 and 1 of 036216, 036616). - SOUTi initial value set bit (use bit 7 of 036216, 036616)= 1. - S I/Oi port select bit (bit 3 of 036216, 036616) = 1. - Select the transfer direction (use bit 5 of 036216, 036616) - Write transfer data to SI/Oi transmission/reception register(036016, 036416) • To use S I/Oi interrupts, the following requirements must be met: - S I/Oi interrupt request bit (bit 3 of 004916, 004816) = 0. • At the rising edge of the last transfer clock (Note3) • LSB first or MSB first selection Whether transmission/reception begins with bit 0 (LSB) or bit 7 (MSB) can be selected. • The SOUTi default value setting function If the transfer clock is selected to external clock, the output level of SOUTi pin can be selected when it is not in transferring please refer to Fig.GA-30. • The SI/Oi (i=3,4) is different from UART0 to 2 that the register and buffer can not be separated, so don't write the next transfer data to the transmission/reception register(036016, 036416) during transferring. • If the transfer clock is selected to internal clock, at the end of transferring, the SOUTi holds the last data during the last 1/2 transfer clock, and then to high impedance. If the transmission/reception register(036016, 036416) is written during the period, the SOUTi becomes the high impedance right the writing ,the data hold time will be shortened. Note 1: n is a value from 0016 through FF16 set in the S I/Oi transfer rate register (i = 3, 4). Note 2: With the external clock selected: • Please write to the SI/Oi transmission/reception register(036016, 036416) under the status that the CLKi pin is input to "H" level. Also please write to the bit 7(SOUTi default value setting bit) under the status that the CLKi pin is input to "H" level. • The S I/Oi circuit keeps on with the shift operation as long as the synchronous clock is entered in it, so stop the synchronous clock at the instant when it counts to eight. The internal clock, if selected, automatically stops. Note 3: If the internal clock is used for the synchronous clock, the transfer clock signal stops at the “H” state. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 129 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Clock asynchronous serial I/O (UART) mode S I/O3, 4 Functions for setting an SOUTi initial value In carrying out transmission, the output level of the SOUTi pin as it is before transmitting 1-bit data can be set either to “H” or to “L”. Fig.GA-30 shows the timing chart for setting an SOUTi initial value and how to set it. (Example) With "H" selected for SOUTi Signal written to the SI/Oi transmission /reception register SI/Oi port selection bit SMi3 = 0 SOUTi initial value selection bit SMi7 = 1 "H" level) (SOUTi: Internal SOUTi's initial value set bit (SMi7) SI/Oi port selection bit (SMi3) SI/Oi port selection bit SMi3 = 0 1 (Port selection: Normal port SOUTi) D0 SOUTi (internal) SOUTi pin = "H" output D0 Port output SOUTi pin output Initial value = "H"(Note) (i = 3, 4) Setting the SOUTi initial value to H Signal written to the SI/Oi register ="L" "H" "L" (Falling edge ) Port selection (normal port SOUTi) Note: The set value is output only when the external clock has been selected. Please set the SOUTi default under the status that the CLKi is input to "H" level. If the internal clock has been selected or if SOUTi output inhibition has been set, this output goes to the high-impedance state. SOUTi pin = Outputting stored data in the SI/Oi transmission/ reception register Fig.GA-30 Timing chart for setting SOUTi’s initial value and how to set it S I/Oi operation timing Fig.GA-31 shows the S I/Oi operation timing MAX:1.5 cycle SI/Oi internal clock Transfer clock (Note 1) Signal written to the SI/Oi register (Note 2) S I/Oi output SOUTi (i= 3, 4) Hiz D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Hiz SI/Oi input SINi (i= 3, 4) SI/Oi interrupt "1" request bit (i=3,4) "0" Note 1: With the internal clock selected for the transfer clock, the frequency dividing ratio can be selected using bits 0 and 1 of the SI/Oi control register (i = 3,4). (No frequency division, 8-division frequency, 32-division frequency.) Note 2: With the internal clock selected for the transfer clock, the SOUTi (i = 3,4) pin becomes to the high-impedance state after the transfer finishes. Note 3: The figure shows when the port selection bit of SOUTi (i = 3,4) is set to "1". Fig.GA-31 S I/Oi operation timing chart Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 130 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group A-D Converter A-D Converter The A-D converter consists of one 10-bit successive approximation A-D converter circuit with a capacitive coupling amplifier. Pins P100 to P107, P95, and P96 also function as the analog signal input pins. The direction registers of these pins for A-D conversion must therefore be set to input. The Vref connect bit (bit 5 at address 03D716) can be used to isolate the resistance ladder of the A-D converter from the reference voltage input pin (VREF) when the A-D converter is not used. Doing so stops any current flowing into the resistance ladder from VREF, reducing the power dissipation. When using the A-D converter, start A-D conversion only after setting bit 5 of 03D716 to connect VREF. The result of A-D conversion is stored in the A-D registers of the selected pins. When set to 10-bit precision, the low 8 bits are stored in the even addresses and the high 2 bits in the odd addresses. When set to 8-bit precision, the low 8 bits are stored in the even addresses. Table.JA-1 shows the performance of the A-D converter. Fig.JA-1 shows the block diagram of the A-D converter, and Fig.JA-2 and JA-3 show the A-D converter-related registers. Table.JA-1 Performance of A-D converter Item Performance Method of A-D conversion Successive approximation (capacitive coupling amplifier) Analog input voltage 0V to AVCC (VCC) Operating clockφAD (Note1) fAD/divide-by-2 of fAD/divide-by-4 of fAD, fAD=f(XIN) Resolution 8-bit or 10-bit (selectable) Absolute precision • 8-bit resolution ±2LSB • 10-bit resolution ±6LSB Operating modes One-shot mode, repeat mode, single sweep mode, repeat sweep mode 0, and repeat sweep mode 1 Analog input pins 8pins (AN0 to AN7) + 2pins (ANEX0 and ANEX1) A-D conversion start condition • Software trigger A-D conversion starts when the A-D conversion start flag changes to “1” • External trigger (can be retriggered) A-D conversion starts when the A-D conversion start flag is “1” and the ___________ ADTRG/P97 input changes from “H” to “L” Conversion speed per pin • Without sample and hold function 8-bit resolution : 49 φAD cycles 10-bit resolution : 59 φAD cycles • With sample and hold function 8-bit resolution : 28 φAD cycles 10-bit resolution : 33 φAD cycles Note 1: The frequency φAD should be set to 250kHz min and 8MHz max. Without sample and hold function,set the φAD frequency to 250kHz min. With the sample and hold fucntion, set the φAD frequency to 1MHz min. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 131 of 290 A-D Converter M16C/6K9 Group A-D conversion rate selection CKS1=1 φAD CKS0=1 fAD 1/2 1/2 CKS1=0 CKS0=0 VREF VCUT=0 Resistor ladder AVSS VCUT=1 Successive conversion register A-D control register 1 (address 03D716) A-D control register 0 (address 03D616) Addresses (03C116, 03C016) A-D register 0(16) (03C316, 03C216) A-D register 1(16) A-D register 2(16) A-D register 3(16) (03C516, 03C416) (03C716, 03C616) (03C916, 03C816) (03CB16, 03CA16) (03CD16, 03CC16) (03CF16, 03CE16) Vref Decoder A-D register 4(16) A-D register 5(16) A-D register 6(16) A-D register 7(16) VIN Comparator Data bus high-order Data bus low-order AN0 CH2,CH1,CH0=000 AN1 CH2,CH1,CH0=001 AN2 CH2,CH1,CH0=010 AN3 CH2,CH1,CH0=011 AN4 CH2,CH1,CH0=100 AN5 CH2,CH1,CH0=101 AN6 CH2,CH1,CH0=110 AN7 CH2,CH1,CH0=111 OPA1,OPA0=0,0 OPA1, OPA0 OPA1,OPA0=0,1 ANEX0 ANEX1 OPA1,OPA0=1,0 Fig.JA-1 Block diagram of A-D converter Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 132 of 290 0 0 1 1 0 : AN0-AN7 1 : ANEX0 0 : ANEX1 1 : Inhibited A-D Converter M16C/6K9 Group A-D control register 0 (Note 1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol ADCON0 Bit symbol Address 03D616 When reset 00000XXX2 Bit name CH0 Analog input pin selection bits CH1 CH2 0 0 0 : AN0 is selected 0 0 1 : AN1 is selected 0 1 0 : AN2 is selected 0 1 1 : AN3 is selected 1 0 0 : AN4 is selected 1 0 1 : AN5 is selected 1 1 0 : AN6 is selected 1 1 1 : AN7 is selected 0 0 : One-shot mode 0 1 : Repeat mode 1 0 : Single sweep mode 1 1 : Repeat sweep mode 0 Repeat sweep mode 1 TRG Trigger selection bit 0 : Software trigger 1 : ADTRG trigger ADST A-D conversion start flag 0 : A-D conversion disabled 1 : A-D conversion started MD0 MD1 (Note 2) b4 b3 A-D operation mode selection bits 0 AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A RW Function b2 b1 b0 (Note 2) 0 : FAD/4 selected 1 : FAD/2 selected Note 1: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result is indeterminate. Note 2: When changing A-D operation mode, set analog input pin again. CKS0 Frequency selection bit 0 A-D control register 1 (Note) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol ADCON1 Bit symbol SCAN0 Address 03D716 When reset 0016 Bit name Function AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A AA A RW A-D sweep pin selection bits When single sweep and repeat sweep mode 0 are selected b1 b0 0 0 : AN0, AN1 (2 pins) 0 1 : AN0 to AN3 (4 pins) 1 0 : AN0 to AN5 (6 pins) 1 1 : AN0 to AN7 (8 pins) When repeat sweep mode 1 is selected SCAN1 b1 b0 0 0 : AN0 (1 pin) 0 1 : AN0, AN1 (2 pins) 1 0 : AN0 to AN2 (3 pins) 1 1 : AN0 to AN3 (4 pins) MD2 A-D operation mode selection bit 1 0 : Any mode other than repeat sweep mode 1 1 : Repeat sweep mode 1 BITS 8/10-bit mode selection bit 0 : 8-bit mode 1 : 10-bit mode CKS1 Frequency selection bit 1 0 : FAD/2 or FAD/4 selected 1 : FAD selected VCUT Vref connect bit 0 : Vref not connected 1 : Vref connected b7 b6 OPA0 ANEX0,1 selection bits OPA1 0 0 : ANEX0 and ANEX1 are not used 0 1 : ANEX0 input is A-D converted 1 0 : ANEX1 input is A-D converted 1 1 : Inhibited Note: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result is indeterminate. Fig.JA-2 A-D converter-related registers (1) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 133 of 290 A-D Converter M16C/6K9 Group A-D control register 2 (Note) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol ADCON2 b0 0 0 0 0 Address 03D416 Bit symbol SMP When reset 000100002 Bit name A-D conversion method select bit Function 0 : Without sample and hold 1 : With sample and hold Must be “0”. Reserved bits Nothing is assigned. AAA AA A AAA R W In an attempt to write to this bit, write “0”. The value, if read, turn out to be “0”. Symbol A-D register i (b15) b7 (b8) b0 b7 ADi(i=0 to 7) Address When reset 03C016 to 03CF16 Indeterminate b0 Function Eight low-order bits of A-D conversion result • During 10-bit mode Two high-order bits of A-D conversion result • During 8-bit mode When read, the content is indeterminate Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”. Fig.JA-3 A-D converter-related registers (2) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 134 of 290 AA AA AA R W A-D Converter M16C/6K9 Group (1) One-shot mode In one-shot mode, the pin selected using the analog input pin selection bits is used for one-shot A-D conversion. Table.JA-2 shows the specifications of one-shot mode. Fig.JA-4 shows the A-D control register in oneshot mode. Table.JA-2 One-shot mode specifications Item Specification Function The pin selected by the analog input pin selection bits is used for one A-D conversion Start condition Writing “1” to A-D conversion start flag Stop condition • End of A-D conversion (A-D conversion start flag changes to “0”, except when external trigger is selected) • Writing “0” to A-D conversion start flag Interrupt request generation timing End of A-D conversion Input pin One of AN0 to AN7, as selected Reading of result of A-D converter Read A-D register corresponding to selected pin A-D control register 0 (Note 1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 Symbol ADCON0 Address 03D616 Bit symbol Bit name CH0 Analog input pin selection bits CH1 CH2 MD0 MD1 TRG A-D operation mode selection bits 0 Trigger selection bit ADST A-D conversion start flag CKS0 Frequency selection bit 0 When reset 00000XXX2 Function 0 0 0 : AN0 is selected 0 0 1 : AN1 is selected 0 1 0 : AN2 is selected 0 1 1 : AN3 is selected 1 0 0 : AN4 is selected 1 0 1 : AN5 is selected 1 1 0 : AN6 is selected 1 1 1 : AN7 is selected (Note 2) b4 b3 0 0 : One-shot mode A AA A AA AA A RW b2 b1 b0 (Note 2) 0 : Software trigger 1 : ADTRG trigger 0 : A-D conversion disabled 1 : A-D conversion started 0 : FAD/4 selected 1 : FAD/2 selected Note 1: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result is indeterminate. Note 2: When changing A-D operation mode, set analog input pin again. A-D control register 1 (Note) b7 b6 b5 1 b4 b3 b2 0 b1 b0 Symbol ADCON1 Bit symbol SCAN0 Address 03D716 When reset 0016 Bit name Function A-D sweep pin selection Invalid in one-shot mode bits SCAN1 0 : Any mode other than repeat sweep mode 1 MD2 A-D operation mode selection bit 1 BITS 0 : 8-bit mode 1 : 10-bit mode 0 : FAD/2 or FAD/4 selected Frequency selection bit 1 1 : FAD selected CKS1 VCUT 8/10-bit mode select bit Vref connect bit 1 : Vref connected b7 b6 OPA0 ANEX0,1 selection bis OPA1 0 0 : ANEX0 and ANEX1 are not used 0 1 : ANEX0 input is A-D converted 1 0 : ANEX1 input is A-D converted 1 1 : Inhibited AA A AA AA A A RW Note: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result is indeterminate. Fig.JA-4 A-D conversion register in one-shot mode Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 135 of 290 A-D Converter M16C/6K9 Group (2) Repeat mode In repeat mode, the pin selected using the analog input pin selection bits is used for repeated A-D conversion. Table.JA-3 shows the specifications of repeat mode. Fig.JA-5 shows the A-D control register in repeat mode. Table.JA-3 Repeat mode specifications Item Specification The pin selected by the analog input pin selection bits is used for repeated A-D conversion Writing “1” to A-D conversion start flag Writing “0” to A-D conversion start flag Not generated One of AN0 to AN7, as selected Read A-D register corresponding to selected pin Function Star condition Stop condition Interrupt request generation timing Input pin Reading of result of A-D converter A-D control register 0 (Note 1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 1 Symbol ADCON0 Bit symbol Address 03D616 When reset 00000XXX2 Bit name Function CH0 CH1 CH2 MD0 (Note 2) b4 b3 MD1 A-D operation mode selection bits 0 TRG Trigger selection bit 0 : Software trigger 1 : ADTRG trigger ADST A-D conversion start flag CKS0 Frequency selection bit 0 0 : A-D conversion disabled 1 : A-D conversion started 0 : FAD/4 selected 1 : FAD/2 selected 0 1 : Repeat mode AA A AAA AA A AAA AA A AAA AAA RW b2 b1 b0 Analog input pin selection 0 0 0 : AN0 is selected bits 0 0 1 : AN1 is selected 0 1 0 : AN2 is selected 0 1 1 : AN3 is selected 1 0 0 : AN4 is selected 1 0 1 : AN5 is selected 1 1 0 : AN6 is selected 1 1 1 : AN7 is selected (Note 2) Note 1: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result is indeterminate. Note 2: When changing A-D operation mode, set analog input pin again. A-D control register 1 (Note) b7 b6 b5 1 b4 b3 b2 0 b1 b0 Symbol ADCON1 Address 03D716 When reset 0016 Bit symbol Bit name SCAN0 A-D sweep pin selection bits Invalid in repeat mode Function MD2 A-D operation mode selection bit 1 Should be “0” in this mode BITS 8/10-bit mode selection bit SCAN1 CKS1 VCUT 0 : 8-bit mode 1 : 10-bit mode 0 : FAD/2 or FAD/4 selected Frequency selection bit 1 1 : FAD selected Vref connect bit 1 : Vref connected b7 b6 OPA0 ANEX0,1 selection bis OPA1 0 0 : ANEX0 and ANEX1 are not used 0 1 : ANEX0 input is A-D converted 1 0 : ANEX1 input is A-D converted 1 1 : Inhibited AA A AA A AAA AA A AA A AAA AA A AA A AAA Note: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result is indeterminate. Fig.JA-5 A-D conversion register in repeat mode Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 136 of 290 RW A-D Converter M16C/6K9 Group (3) Single sweep mode In single sweep mode, the pins selected using the A-D sweep pin selection bits are used for one-by-one AD conversion. Table.JA-4 shows the specifications of single sweep mode. Fig.JA-6 shows the A-D control register in single sweep mode. Table.JA-4 Single sweep mode specifications Item Specification Function The pins selected by the A-D sweep pin selection bits are used for one-by-one A-D conversion Start condition Writing “1” to A-D converter start flag Stop condition • End of A-D conversion (A-D conversion start flag changes to “0”, except when external trigger is selected) • Writing “0” to A-D conversion start flag Interrupt request generation timing End of A-D conversion Input pin AN0 and AN1 (2 pins), AN0 to AN3 (4 pins), AN0 to AN5 (6 pins), or AN0 to AN7 (8 pins) Reading of result of A-D converter Read A-D registers corresponding to selected pins A-D control register 0 (Note) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 1 0 Symbol ADCON0 Bit symbol CH0 Address 03D616 When reset 00000XXX2 Bit name Function Analog input pin selection bits Invalid in single sweep mode CH1 CH2 MD0 A-D operation mode selection bits 0 b4 b3 1 0 : Single sweep mode MD1 TRG Trigger selection bit 0 : Software trigger 1 : ADTRG trigger ADST A-D conversion start flag CKS0 Frequency selection bit 0 0 : A-D conversion disabled 1 : A-D conversion started 0 : FAD/4 selected 1 : FAD/2 selected A A AA A AA RW Note: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result is indeterminate. A-D control register 1 (Note 1) b7 b6 b5 b4 1 b3 b2 0 b1 b0 Symbol ADCON1 Bit symbol SCAN0 Address 03D716 Bit name A-D sweep pin select bit BITS CKS1 VCUT Function When single sweep and repeat sweep mode 0 are selected b1 b0 0 0 : AN0, AN1 (2 pins) 0 1 : AN0 to AN3 (4 pins) 1 0 : AN0 to AN5 (6 pins) 1 1 : AN0 to AN7 (8 pins) SCAN1 MD2 When reset 0016 A-D operation mode select bit 1 8/10-bit mode select bit Should be "0" in this mode Vref connect bit 1 : Vref connected ANEX0,1 selection bis 0 0 : ANEX0 and ANEX1 are not used 0 1 : ANEX0 input is A-D converted 1 0 : ANEX1 input is A-D converted 1 1 : Inhibited 0 : 8-bit mode 1 : 10-bit mode 0 : FAD/2 or FAD/4 selected Frequency selection bit 1 1 : FAD selected b7 b6 OPA0 OPA1 AA A AA A AA R W Note 1: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result is indeterminate. Fig.JA-6 A-D conversion register in single sweep mode Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 137 of 290 A-D Converter M16C/6K9 Group (4) Repeat sweep mode 0 In repeat sweep mode 0, the pins selected using the A-D sweep pin selection bits are used for repeat sweep A-D conversion. Table.JA-5 shows the specifications of repeat sweep mode 0. Fig.JA-7 shows the A-D control register in repeat sweep mode 0. Table.JA-5 Repeat sweep mode 0 specifications Item Function Start condition Stop condition Interrupt request generation timing Input pin Reading of result of A-D converter Specification The pins selected by the A-D sweep pin selection bits are used for repeat sweep A-D conversion Writing “1” to A-D conversion start flag Writing “0” to A-D conversion start flag Not generated AN0 and AN1 (2 pins), AN0 to AN3 (4 pins), AN0 to AN5 (6 pins), or AN0 to AN7 (8 pins) Read A-D registers corresponding to selected pins (at any time) A-D control register 0 (Note) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 1 1 Symbol ADCON0 Bit symbol CH0 Address 03D616 When reset 00000XXX2 Bit name Function Analog input pin selection bits Invalid in repeat sweep mode 0 CH1 CH2 MD0 b4 b3 A-D operation mode selection 1 1 : Repeat sweep mode 0 bits 0 MD1 TRG Trigger selection bit 0 : Software trigger 1 : ADTRG trigger ADST A-D conversion start flag 0 : A-D conversion disabled 1 : A-D conversion started CKS0 Frequency selection bit 0 0 : FAD/4 selected 1 : FAD/2 selected AA A AAA AA A AAA AA A AA A AAA AAA RW Note: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result is indeterminate. A-D control register 1 (Note 1) b7 b6 b5 b4 1 b3 b2 0 b1 b0 Symbol ADCON1 Bit symbol SCAN0 Address 03D716 When reset 0016 Bit name Function b1 b0 0 0 : AN0, AN1 (2 pins) 0 1 : AN0 to AN3 (4 pins) 1 0 : AN0 to AN5 (6 pins) 1 1 : AN0 to AN7 (8 pins) SCAN1 MD2 A-D operation mode selection bits 1 Should be "0" in this mode BITS 8/10-bit mode selection bit CKS1 Frequency selection bit 1 0 : 8-bit mode 1 : 10-bit mode 0 : FAD/2 or FAD/4 selected 1 : FAD selected VCUT Vref connect bit 1 : Vref connected b7 b6 OPA0 ANEX0,1 selection bis OPA1 AA A AA A AA A AA A AAA AA A AA A AAA R W A-D sweep pin selection bits When single sweep and repeat sweep mode 0 are selected 0 0 : ANEX0 and ANEX1 are not used 0 1 : ANEX0 input is A-D converted 1 0 : ANEX1 input is A-D converted 1 1 : Inhibited Note 1: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result is indeterminate. Fig.JA-7 A-D conversion register in repeat sweep mode 0 Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 138 of 290 A-D Converter M16C/6K9 Group (5) Repeat sweep mode 1 In repeat sweep mode 1, all pins are used for A-D conversion with emphasis on the pin or pins selected using the A-D sweep pin selection bits. Table.JA-6 shows the specifications of repeat sweep mode 1. Fig.JA-8 shows the A-D control register in repeat sweep mode 1. Table.JA-6 Repeat sweep mode 1 specifications Item Function Start condition Stop condition Interrupt request generation timing Input pin Reading of result of A-D converter Specification All pins perform repeat sweep A-D conversion, with emphasis on the pin or pins selected by the A-D sweep pin selection bits Example : AN0 selected AN0 AN1 AN0 AN2 AN0 AN3, etc Writing “1” to A-D conversion start flag Writing “0” to A-D conversion start flag Not generated AN0 (1 pin), AN0 and AN1 (2 pins), AN0 to AN2 (3 pins), AN0 to AN3 (4 pins) Read A-D registers corresponding to selected pins (at any time) A-D control register 0 (Note) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 1 1 Symbol ADCON0 Bit symbol CH0 Address 03D616 When reset 00000XXX2 Bit name Function Analog input pin selection bits Invalid in repeat sweep mode 1 CH1 CH2 MD0 b4 b3 A-D operation mode selection 1 1 : Repeat sweep mode 1 bits 0 MD1 TRG Trigger select bit 0 : Software trigger 1 : ADTRG trigger ADST A-D conversion start flag 0 : A-D conversion disabled 1 : A-D conversion started CKS0 Frequency selection bit 0 0 : FAD/4 selected 1 : FAD/2 selected AAAA AA AA AA AA AA AAA AAA RW Note: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result is indeterminate. A-D control register 1 (Note 1) b7 b6 b5 b4 1 b3 b2 1 b1 b0 Symbol ADCON1 Bit symbol SCAN0 Address 03D716 Bit name A-D sweep pin selection bits BITS Function When repeat sweep mode 1 is selected b1 b0 0 0 : AN0 (1 pin) 0 1 : AN0, AN1 (2 pins) 1 0 : AN0 to AN2 (3 pins) 1 1 : AN0 to AN3 (4 pins) SCAN1 MD2 When reset 0016 A-D operation mode selection 1 : Repeat sweep mode 1 bit 1 0 : 8-bit mode 8/10-bit mode selection bit 1 : 10-bit mode CKS1 Frequency selection bit 1 0 : FAD/2 or FAD/4 selected 1 : FAD selected VCUT Vref connect bit 1 : Vref connected b7 b6 OPA0 ANEX0,1 selection bis OPA1 0 0 : ANEX0 and ANEX1 are not used 0 1 : ANEX0 input is A-D converted 1 0 : ANEX1 input is A-D converted 1 1 : Inhibited AAAA AA AA AA AAAA AA AA R W Note 1: If the A-D control register is rewritten during A-D conversion, the conversion result is indeterminate. Fig.JA-8 A-D conversion register in repeat sweep mode 1 Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 139 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group A-D Converter (a) Extended analog input pins In one-shot mode and repeat mode, the input via the extended analog input pins ANEX0 and ANEX1 can also be converted from analog to digital. When bit 6 of the A-D control register 1 (address 03D716) is “1” and bit 7 is “0”, input via ANEX0 is converted from analog to digital. The result of conversion is stored in A-D register 0. When bit 6 of the A-D control register 1 (address 03D716) is “0” and bit 7 is “1”, input via ANEX1 is converted from analog to digital. The result of conversion is stored in A-D register 1. (b) Sample and hold Sample and hold is selected by setting bit 0 of the A-D control register 2 (address 03D416) to “1”. When sample and hold is selected, the rage of conversion of each pin increases. As a result, a 28 φAD cycle is achieved with 8-bit resolution and 33φAD cycle with 10-bit resolution. Sample and hold can be selected in all modes. However, in all modes, be sure to specify before starting A-D conversion whether sample and hold is to be used. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 140 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group D-A Converter D-A Converter This is an 8-bit, R-2R type D-A converter. The microcomputer contains two independent D-A converters of this type. DA conversion is performed when a value is written to the corresponding D-A register. Bits 0 and 1 (D-A output enable bits) of the D-A control register decide if the result of conversion is to be output. Do not set the corresponding port to output mode if D-A conversion is to be performed. If D-A output is enabled, the pull-up of corresponding port is inhibited. Output analog voltage (V) is determined by a set value n (n : decimal) in the D-A register. V = VREF X n/ 256 (n = 0 to 255) VREF : reference voltage Table.JB-1lists the performance of the D-A converter. Fig.JB-1 shows the block diagram of the D-A converter. Fig.JB-2 shows the D-A control register. Fig.JB-3 shows the D-A converter equivalent circuit. Table.JB-1 Performance of D-A converter Item Conversion type Resolution Analog output pins Performance R-2R type 8 bits 2 channels Data bus low-order bits D-A register0 (8) (Address 03D816) AAA D-A0 output enable bit R-2R resistor ladder D-A register1 (8) P93/DA0 (Address 03DA16) AAA D-A1 output enable bit R-2R resistor ladder Fig.JB-1 Block diagram of D-A converter Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 141 of 290 P94/DA1 D-A Converter M16C/6K9 Group D-A control register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol DACON Address 03DC16 Bit symbol DA0E DA1E When reset 0016 Bit name Function D-A0 output enable bit 0 : Output disabled 1 : Output enabled D-A1 output enable bit 0 : Output disabled 1 : Output enabled AA A AA A RW Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to these bits, write “0”. The value, if read, turns out to be “0” D-A register b7 b0 Symbol DAi (i = 0,1) Address 03D816, 03DA16 When reset Indeterminate AA A Function RW R W Output value of D-A conversion Fig.JB-2 D-A control register D-A0 output enable bit "0" R R R R 2R 2R 2R 2R R R R 2R DA0 "1" 2R MSB 2R 2R 2R LSB D-A0 register0 AVSS VREF Note 1: The above diagram shows an instance in which the D-A register is assigned 2A16. Note 2: The same circuit as this is also used for D-A1. Note 3: To reduce the current consumption when the D-A converter is not used, set the D-A output enable bit to 0 and set the D-A register to 0016 Do not let current flows through R-2R resistors. Fig.JB-3 D-A converter equivalent circuit Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 142 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Comparator Comparator Circuit Comparator Configuration A comparator circuit consists of a switch tree, ladder resistance, comparators, comparator control circuit, the comparator control register (address 03DE16), comparator data register (address 03DF16), and analog signal input pins(P50 - P57). The analog input pins (P50 - P57) are shared with the usual digital port I/O pins. The comparator control register is a 4-bit register and can generate internal analog voltages in steps of 1/16 Vcc with the contens of bits 0 to 3. In Table.JC-2 contents of bits 0 to 3 of the comparator control register and corresponding internal analog voltage generated are indicated. The compared result of the analog input voltage and internal analog voltage is stored in the comparator data register. The value of comparator control register can not be read out. Comparator Operation In order to perform comparator operation, first, set the port P5 direction register (address 03EB16) to "0", as P5 can be used as the analog input pins. Then write a digital value, which corresponds to the internal analog voltage to be compared, to bits 0 to 3 of the comparator control register (address 03DE16) . The voltage comparison starts immediately by the writing operation. After 28 cycles of main clock without division (the cycles needed for comparison, no relation to the frequency), the compared result of the comparator is stored in the comparator data register (address 03DF16). Each bit of this register becomes as follows depending on the status of corresponding P50 to P57 pins: When analog input voltage > internal analog voltage, it is "1". When analog input voltage < internal analog voltage, it is "0". For comparing once more, it is necessary to write data into comparator control register again even if the internal analog voltage is the same. To read the result, wait 28 cycles of main clock without division (the cycles needed for comparison, no relation to the frequency) or more after the comparator operation starts. During the 28 cycles of the comparison, the ladder resistance is turned on and the reference voltage is generated. When the comparator is not in operation, the ladder resistance is off. Therefore, unnecessary consumption is prevented. The comparison is accomplished by capacitive coupling. If the clock frequency is too low, electric charge will be lost. While the comparator is in operation, the clock frequency must be 1MHz or higher. During this time, do not execute a STP instruction, a WIT instruction, or an I/O instruction for port P5. Data bus P5 (8) 4 8 8 Comparator data register(03DF16) Comparator control register(03DE16) b0 b3 b0 P57 Compa rator R-ladder P56 Compa rator P50 Compa rator Comparator Comparator connection Control Cricuit signal Fig.JC-1 Comparator circuit Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 143 of 290 Switch Tree R-ladder connection signal VSS Comparator M16C/6K9 Group Table.JC-1 Correspondence of internal analog voltage and contents of bits 0 to 3 of the comparator control register. Comparator Control Register Contents of bit 0 to 3 0000 LSB 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 0111 1000 Internal Analog Voltage 1 / 32•Vcc 1 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc 2 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc 3 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc 4 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc 5 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc 6 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc 7 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc 8 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc 1001 1010 1011 1100 1101 1110 1111 9 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc 10 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc 11 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc 12 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc 13 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc 14 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc 15 / 16•Vcc + 1 / 32•Vcc AAA A AA AAA AA A Comparator Control register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol CMPCON Bit Symbol CREFS Address 03DE16 Bit name Internal analog voltage setting bits Reserved bit Can't be written. "0" will be read out. Fig.JC-2 Comparator control register Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 144 of 290 When Reset 0016 Function n/16•VCC+1/32•VCC n=setting vaule R W PWM M16C/6K9 Group PWM Output Circuit (PWM : Pulse Width Modulation) There are 6 PWM output circuits, PWM0 to PWM5, with 8-bit resolution and operating independently. The input clock f(PC) for PWM is based on XIN, 2 division of XIN or 4 division of XIN. Data bus PWM0 prescaler pre-latch PWM0 register pre-latch Transmission control circuit PWM0 prescaler latch "00" f(XIN) PWM0 register latch Count source selection bits P44 latch P44/PWM01 1/2 1/4 "01" f(PC) PWM0 prescaler PWM0 register PWM0 "10" PWM0 output pin selection bit PWM0 output enable bit P44 direction register P93 latch P93/DA1/PWM00 PWM0 output pin selection bit PWM0 output enable bit Note: Refer to page 24 for the addresses of PWM prescaler and PWM register. Fig.LA-1 PWM circuit (PWM0) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 145 of 290 P93 direction register M16C/6K9 Group PWM Data Setup (PWM0) PWM0 output pin shares with P93 or P44. PWM0 output pin is selected from either P93/PWM00 or P44/ PWM01 by bit 0 of PWM control register 0 (address 030C16). PWM0 output is enabled and starts to operate by setting bit 0 of PWM control register 1 (address 030D16) to “1” . The period of PWM is set by PWM0 prescaler (address 030016), The “H” width of output pulse is set by PWM0 register (address 030116). The following are the calculations if the prescaler value is n and PWM0 register value is m. (n = 0 to 255, m = 0 to 255) PWM period = 255 ✕ (n+1) = 31.875 ✕ (n+1) µs f(XIN) (In the case of f(XIN)=8MHz, PWM counter source selection bits=“002”) "H" width of output pulse = PWM period ✕ m = 0.125 ✕ (n+1) ✕ mµs 255 (In the case of f(XIN)=8MHz, PWM counter source selection bits=“002”) The setting of PWM1 to PWM5 are the same. PWM Operation By setting bit 0 ( PWM0 output enable bit) of PWM control register 1 to “1”, the PWM output circuit starts to operate from default state with “H” pulse output. If the values of PWM0 register and PWM0 prescaler are modified during the PWM output operation, the corresponding pulse will be output from the next period after the modification. 31.875 ✕ m ✕ (n+1) µs 255 < > PWM0 output < T = [31.875 ✕ (n+1)] µs > m : The content of PWM0 register n : The content of PWM0 prescaler T : PWM Period ( in the case of f(XIN) = 8MHz) Fig.LA-2 The timing of PWM period (PWM0) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 146 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group PWM A B C B C = T T2 PWM0 output T The write signal to PWM0 register The write signal to PWM0 prescaler T T2 ( The modification of “H” width from “A” to “B”) ( The modification of PWM period from “T” to “T2”) In the case that values of PWM0 register and PWM0 prescaler are modified, the PWM0 output will be changed from the next period after the modification. Fig.LA-3 The PWM output timing in the case of modification of PWM register and PWM prescaler (PWM0) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 147 of 290 PWM M16C/6K9 Group AAA AA A AAA AA A PWM control register 0 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol PWMCON0 Bit symbol Address 030C16 When reset 0016 Bit name Function PWMSEL0 PWM0 output pin selection bit 0 : P93/PWM00 1 : P44/PWM01 PWMSEL1 PWM1 output pin selection bit 0 : P94/PWM10 1 : P45/PWM11 PWMSEL2 PWM2 output pin selection bit 0 : P95/PWM20 1 : P46/PWM21 PWMSEL3 PWM3 output pin selection bit 0 : P96/PWM30 1 : P47/PWM31 PWMSEL4 PWM4 output pin selection bit 0 : P160/PWM40 1 : P40/PWM41 PWMSEL5 PWM5 output pin selection bit 0 : P161/PWM50 1 : P41/PWM51 R W b7 b6 PWMCLK0 PWM count source selection bits 0 0 : f(XIN) 0 1 : f(XIN)/2 1 0 : f(XIN)/4 PWMCLK1 1 1 : Inhibit AAA AA A AAA AA A PWM control register 1 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol PWMCON1 Bit symbol Address 030D16 Bit name PWMEN0 PWM0 output enable bit PWMEN1 PWM1 output enable bit 0 : Inhibit 1 : Enable PWMEN2 PWM2 output enable bit 0 : Inhibit 1 : Enable PWMEN3 PWM3 output enable bit 0 : Inhibit 1 : Enable PWMEN4 PWM4 output enable bit 0 : Inhibit 1 : Enable PWMEN5 PWM5 output enable bit 0 : Inhibit 1 : Enable Fig.LA-4 PWM control registers (1) Jun 06, 2003 Function 0 : Inhibit 1 : Enable Nothing is assigned. Can not be written. The value is “0” in reading. Rev.1.00 When reset 0016 page 148 of 290 R W M16C/6K9 Group LPC Bus Interface LPC Bus Interface LPC bus interface is based on Intel Low Pin Count (LPC) Interface Specification, Revision 1.0. It is I/O cycle data transfer format of serial communication. 4 channels are built in. The function of data bus buffer and data bus buffer status are almost the same as that of MELPS8-41 series. It can be written in or read out (as slave mode) by the control signals from host CPU side. The LPC bus interface functionality block diagram is shown in Figure GF-2. LPC data bus buffer functional Input / Output ports (P30-P36 ) are shared with GPIO port. The setting of bit3 (LPC bus buffer enable bit) of LPC control register ( address 02D616 ) is as below: 0: General purpose Input / Output port 1: LPC bus buffer functional Input / Output port The enabling of channel of LPC bus buffer is controlled by bits 4-7 (LPC bus buffer 0-3 enable bits) of LPC control register (address 02D616 ). The slave address (16 bits) of LPC bus buffer channel 0 is fixed on 0060h, 0064h. The slave addresses (16 bits) of LPC bus buffer channel 1-3 are definable by setting LPC 1-3 address register H, L (address 02D016 to 02D516 ). The setting value of bit2 of LPC1-3 address register (A2) L will not be decoded. The bit is “0” when read from slave CPU. The A2 status of slave address is latched to XA2 flag when written by host CPU. The input buffer full interrupt is generated when written in the data by host CPU. The Output buffer empty interrupt is generated when read out the data by host CPU. As shown in GF-1, the input buffer full interrupt request and output buffer empty interrupt request are switched by bit6, 7 of data bus buffer control register0. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 149 of 290 LPC Bus Interface M16C/6K9 Group Input buffer full flag0 IBF0 Input buffer full flag1 IBF1 Input buffer full flag2 IBF2 Input buffer full flag3 IBF3 Rising edge detection circuit Rising edge detection circuit Rising edge detection circuit Rising edge detection circuit One shot pulse generator One shot pulse generator One shot pulse generator One shot pulse generator Input Buffer Full0 interrupt request signal (IBF0 interrupt request) b7,b6 0 0 1 0 1 1 IBF1INT b7,b6 0 1 b7,b6 0 0 0 1 1 1 IBF2INT b7,b6 1 0 b7,b6 0 0 0 1 1 0 IBF3INT b7,b6 1 1 DBBCON0 bit 7,6 Output buffer full flag0 OBF0 OBE0 Rising edge detection circuit One shot pulse generator OBE1 Rising edge detection circuit One shot pulse generator OBE2 Rising edge detection circuit One shot pulse generator OBE3 Rising edge detection circuit One shot pulse generator OBE Output buffer full flag1 OBF1 Output buffer full flag2 OBF2 Output buffer full flag3 OBF3 IBF0 IBF0 interrupt request IBF1 IBF1INT IBF2 IBF2INT IBF3 IBF3INT OBF0(OBE0) OBF1(OBE1) OBF2(OBE2) OBF3(OBE3) OBE (Example) Data bus buffer control register 0 bit 7=1, bit 6=1 IBF1/OBE interrupt request IBF2/OBE interrupt request IBF3/OBE interrupt request Fig.GF-1 Interrupt, request, circuit of Data Bus Buffer Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 150 of 290 Input Buffer Full1/output buffer empty interrupt request signal (IBF1/OBE interrupt request) Input Buffer Full2/output buffer empty interrupt request signal (IBF2/OBE interrupt request) Input Buffer Full3/output buffer empty interrupt request signal (IBF3/OBE interrupt request) M16C/6K9 Group LPC Bus Interface P33/LAD3 Address register LL (Note1) Address register LH (Note1) Address register HL (Note1) Address register HH (Note1) RD/WR register Start register AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA Internal Data Bus Input Data Buffer [7:4] Input Data Buffer [3:0] Output Data Buffer [7:4]Output Data Buffer [3:0] Data bus buffer status register U7 U6 U5 U4 XA2 U2 IBF OBF Output Control Circuit TAR register P32/LAD2 Input Control Circuit SYNC register P31/LAD1 System Bus P30/LAD0 AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA AA Input Data Comparator P34/LFRAME P35/LRESET P36/LCLK Interrupt signal IBF, OBE Interrupt generate Circuit b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 LPC control register (address 02D616) 0 0 Note1 : LPC bus interface channel 0 is fixed on slave address “0060h”, “0064h”. Fig.GF-2 LPC bus interface function block diagram (LPC1) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 151 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group LPC Bus Interface Figure GF-3 Shows Data bus buffer control registers Figure GF-4 Shows Data bus buffer status register Figure GF-5, 6 Shows LPC related registers Data bus buffer status register (DBBSTS0-DBBSTS3) This is 8-bit register. The bit 0, 1, 3 are read only bits and indicate the status of data bus buffer. Bit 2, 4, 5, 6, 7 are user definable and flags which can be read and written by software. The data bus buffer status register can be read out by host CPU when the slave address (16 bit) bit2 (A2) is high. • Output buffer full flag (OBF) The bit will be set to “1” when a data is written into output data bus buffer and will be cleared to “0” when host CPU read out the data from output data bus buffer. • Input buffer full flag (IBF) The bit will be set to “1” while a data is written into input data bus buffer by host CPU and will be cleared to “0”when the data is read out from input data bus buffer by slave CPU. • XA2 flag (XA2) The bit 2 of slave address (16 bits) is latched while a data is written into data bus buffer. Input data bus buffer register (DBBIN0-DBBIN3) When there is a write request from host CPU, the data on the data bus will be latched to DBBIN0-3. The data of DBBIN0-3 can be read out from data bus buffer registers (Address:02C016, 02C216 , 02C416 , 02C616 ) in SFR field. Output data bus buffer register (DBBOUT0-DBBOUT3) When writing data to data bus buffer registers (Address: 02C016 , 02C216 , 02C416 , 02C616 ), the data will be transferred to DBBOUT0-3 automatically. The data of DBBOUT0-3 will be output to the data bus when there is a read request from host CPU and the status of bit2 (A2) of slave address (16 bits) is low. LPCi address register H/L (LPC1ADH-LPC3ADH / LPC1ADL-LPC3ADL) The slave address (16 bits) of LPC bus buffer channel 0 is fixed on 0060h, 0064h. The slave addresses (16 bits) of LPC bus buffer channel 1-3 are definable by setting LPC1-3 address registers H/L (02D016 to 02D516 ). The settings are for slave address upper 8 bits and lower 8 bits. And these registers can be set and cleared in any time. The bit 2 of LPC 1-3 address L is not decoded regardless of the setting value. When slave CPU reads LPC13 address registers, the bit2 (A2) of address low byte will be fixed to “0”. The bit2 (A2) status of slave address is latched to XA2 flag when written by host CPU. The slave addresses that are already set in these registers will be used for comparing with the addresses to be received. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 152 of 290 LPC Bus Interface M16C/6K9 Group Data bus buffer control register 0 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol DBBCON0 Address 02C816 Bit symbol When reset 000000002 Bit name Nothing is assigned. Cannot be written. The value is "0" in reading. IBFSEL R W Function IBF/OBE interrupt request select bit b7 b6 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 A A AA (Note 1) : OBE disable : OBE enable, IBF1 disable : OBE enable, IBF2 disable : OBE enable, IBF3 disable Note 1: By setting these two bits, one of IBF1 to IBF3 interrupt requests will be switched to OBE interrupt request. There is no relative between IBF0 interrupt request and these two bits. Interrupt b7, b6 0,0 0,1 1,0 1,1 IBF0 interrupt IBF0 IBF0 IBF0 IBF0 IBF1 interrupt IBF1 OBE IBF1 IBF1 IBF2 interrupt IBF2 IBF2 OBE IBF2 IBF3 interrupt IBF3 IBF3 IBF3 OBE Data bus buffer control register 1 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol DBBCON1 Bit symbol Address 02C916 Bit name OBF0SEL OBF0 output selection bit OBF00EN OBF00 output enable bit 0 : P40 as GPIO 1 : P40 as OBF00 output OBF01EN OBF01 output enable bit 0 : P43 as GPIO 1 : P43 as OBF01 output OBF1EN OBF1 output enable bit 0 : P44 as GPIO 1 : P44 as OBF1 output OBF2EN OBF2 output enable bit 0 : P45 as GPIO 1 : P45 as OBF2 output OBF3EN OBF3 output enable bit 0 : P46 as GPIO 1 : P46 as OBF3 output Fig.GF-3 Data bus buffer control registers Jun 06, 2003 Function 0 : OBF00 enable 1 : OBF01 enable Nothing is assigned. Cannot be written. The value is "0" in reading. Rev.1.00 When reset 000000002 page 153 of 290 R W LPC Bus Interface M16C/6K9 Group Data bus buffer status register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol DBBSTS0 DBBSTS1 DBBSTS2 DBBSTS3 Bit name Bit symbol Function Output buffer full flag 0 : Buffer empty 1 : Buffer full IBF Input buffer full flag 0 : Buffer empty 1 : Buffer full U2 User definable flag This flag can be freely defined by user XA2 XA2 flag This flag is indication the A2 status of the 16 bit slave address when IBF flag is set U4 User definable flag This flag can be freely defined by user U6 U7 Fig.GF-4 Data bus buffer status register Jun 06, 2003 When reset 000000002 000000002 000000002 000000002 OBF U5 Rev.1.00 Address 02C116 02C316 02C516 02C716 page 154 of 290 R W LPC Bus Interface M16C/6K9 Group LPCi address register L (i=1,2,3) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 (Note2) Symbol LPC1ADL LPC2ADL LPC3ADL b0 Bit symbol Address 02D016 02D216 02D416 When reset 000000002 000000002 000000002 Bit name LPCSAD0 Slave address0 LPCSAD1 Slave address1 LPCSAD2 Slave address2 (Note1) LPCSAD3 Slave address3 LPCSAD4 Slave address4 LPCSAD5 Slave address5 LPCSAD6 Slave address6 LPCSAD7 Slave address7 R W Note1: Always returns “0” when read, even if writing “1” to this bit. Note2: Do not set the same 16 bits slave address in each channel. LPCi address register H (i=1,2,3) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol LPC1ADH LPC2ADH LPC3ADH b0 Bit symbol Fig.GF-5 LPC related registers Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 155 of 290 Address 02D116 02D316 02D516 Bit name LPCSAD8 Slave address8 LPCSAD9 Slave address9 LPCSAD10 Slave address10 LPCSAD11 Slave address11 LPCSAD12 Slave address12 LPCSAD13 Slave address13 LPCSAD14 Slave address14 LPCSAD15 Slave address15 When reset 000000002 000000002 000000002 R W LPC Bus Interface M16C/6K9 Group LPC control register (LPCCON) • LPC bus interface enable bit (LPCBEN) “0”: P30 -P36 use as GPIO “1”: P30 -P36 use as LPC bus interface • LPC bus buffer 0 enable bit (LPCEN0) “0”: LPC bus buffer0 disable “1”: LPC bus buffer0 enable • LPC bus buffer 1 enable bit (LPCEN1) “0”: LPC bus buffer1 disable “1”: LPC bus buffer1 enable • LPC bus buffer 2 enable bit (LPCEN2) “0”: LPC bus buffer2 disable “1”: LPC bus buffer2 enable • LPC bus buffer 3 enable bit (LPCEN3) “0”: LPC bus buffer3 disable “1”: LPC bus buffer3 enable • LPC software reset bit (LPCSR) ______________ By setting the bit to “1”, LPC interface is reset by the same status as LRESET=“L”. After 1.5 cycles of BCLK at writing “1”, reset is released and the bit becomes “0”. Nothing happens if “0” is set. • SYNC output selection bits (SYNCSEL0,SYNCSEL1) The content of SYNC output can be selected by bit 0,1 (SYNC output selection bits) of LPC control register. Fig.GF-6 shows the configuration of LPC control register, Table.GF-1 shows the content of SYNC output selected by SYNC output selection bits. Table GF-1 SYNC output SYNCSEL1 SYNCSEL0 SYNC cycle 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 1 4 1 4 Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 156 of 290 1st cycle 00002 01102 10102 01102 SYNC output 2nd cycle 3rd cycle 4th cycle 01102 01102 00002 01102 01102 10102 M16C/6K9 Group AA AA A AA AAAAAA A LPC Bus Interface LPC control register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol LPCCON Bit symbol Address 02D616 When reset 000000002 Bit name Function b1 b0 SYNCSEL0 SYNC output selection bits 0 0: OK 0 1: Long & OK 1 0: Err 1 1: Long & Err LPCSR LPC software reset bit 0 : The release of reset (Note) 1 : Reset LPCBEN LPC interface enable bit 0 : P30 - P36 as GPIO 1 : LPC bus buffer enable LPCEN0 LPC bus buffer 0 enable bit 0 : LPC bus buffer 0 disable 1 : LPC bus buffer 0 enable LPCEN1 LPC bus buffer 1 enable bit 0 : LPC bus buffer 1 disable 1 : LPC bus buffer 1 enable LPCEN2 LPC bus buffer 2 enable bit 0 : LPC bus buffer 2 disable 1 : LPC bus buffer 2 enable LPCEN3 LPC bus buffer 3 enable bit 0 : LPC bus buffer 3 disable 1 : LPC bus buffer 3 enable SYNCSEL1 Note: For LPC software reset, the bit will automatically return to “0” after writing “1”. Fig.GF-6 LPC control register Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 157 of 290 R W M16C/6K9 Group LPC Bus Interface Basic operation of LPC bus interface The status transition of LPC bus interface is shown in Figure GF-7. Setting steps for using LPC bus interface is explained below. • Setting bit3 (LPC interface enable bit) of LPC control register ( address 02D616 ) to "1" • Choosing which LPC bus buffer channel will be used • Setting "1" to bits 4-7 (LPC bus buffer 0-3 enable bit) of LPC control register ( address 02D616 ). • The 16-bit slave address of LPC bus buffer channel is defined by writing 16-bit slave address to LPC 1-3 address registers ( address 02D016 to 02D516 ). If channel 1-3 LPC bus buffer is chosen, set the address to the corresponding address register. • Selecting IBF/ OBE interrupt in data bus buffer control register0 ( address 02C816 ) • Selecting OBF output port in data bus buffer control register1 ( address 02C916 ) <1> Example of I/O writing cycle from HOST Writing timing is shown in Figure GF-8. The basic communication cycles of LPC I/O protocol are 13 cycles. The data of LAD[3:0] will be read by the _______________ rising edge of LCLK. Communication will start from LFRAME falling edge. ______________ • 1st cycle : When LFRAME is "Low", sending "00002 " to LAD[3:0] for communication start frame detecting. _______________ • 2nd cycle : When LFRAME is "High", sending "001X2 " to LAD[3:0] for write frame detecting. • From 3rd cycle to 6th cycle: These four cycles are detecting for 16 bits slave address. 3rd cycle: The slave address which is from host is written to slave address register [15:12] through LAD[3:0] 4th cycle: The slave address which is from host is written to slave address register [11:8] through LAD[3:0] 5th cycle: The slave address which is from host is written to slave address register [7:4] through LAD[3:0] 6th cycle: The slave address which is from host is written to slave address register [3:0] through LAD[3:0] • 7th and 8th cycles are used for one data byte transfer. 7th cycle: The data which is from host is written to input data buffer[3:0] through LAD[3:0] 8th cycle: The data which is from host is written to input data buffer[7:4] through LAD[3:0] • 9th and 10thcycles are for changing the communication direction from host→slave to slave→host 9th cycle: Host outputs "11112 " to LAD[3:0] 10thcycle: The LAD[3:0] will be set to Hi-Z by HOST to switch the communication direction. • 11th cycle: The "00002 " (SYNC OK) is output to LAD[3:0] for acknowledge. • 12th cycle: The "11112 " is output to LAD[3:0]. The XA2 and IBF flag are set. IBF interrupt signal is generated. • 13th cycle: The LAD[3:0] will be set to Hi-Z by slave to switch the communication direction. During the host write period, the bit2 (A2) status of 16 bits slave address will be latched to XA2 flag. When 8 bits data from input data buffer are read out by slave CPU, the IBF flag will be cleared simultaneously. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 158 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group LPC Bus Interface <2> Example for I/O reading cycle from HOST Reading timing is shown in Figure GF-9. The basic communication cycles of LPC I/O protocol are 13 cycles. The data of LAD[3:0] will be read by the _______________ rising edge of LCLK. Communication will start from LFRAME falling edge. _______________ • 1st cycle: When LFRAME is "Low", sending "00002 " to LAD[3:0] for communication start detecting. _______________ • 2ndcycle: When LFRAME is "High", the host send "000X2 " on LAD[3:0] to inform the cycle type as I/O read. • From 3rd cycle to 6thcycle: These four cycles are detecting for 16 bits slave address. 3rdcycle: The slave address which is from host is written to slave address register [15:12] throughLAD[3:0] 4thcycle: The slave address which is from host is written to slave address register [11:8] throughLAD[3:0] 5thcycle: The slave address which is from host is written to slave address register [7:4] throughLAD[3:0] 6thcycle: The slave address which is from host is written to slave address register [3:0] throughLAD[3:0] • 7th and 8thcycles are used for changing the communication direction from host→slave to slave→host 7thcycle: Host is output "11112 " to LAD[3:0] 8thcycle: The LAD[3:0] will be set to Hi-Z by HOST to switch the communication direction. • 9thcycle : The "00002 " (SYNC OK) is output to LAD[3:0] for acknowledge. • 10th and 11thcycles are for output 8 bits data from output data buffer or output 8 bits data from status register. 10thcycle: Sending output data buffer [3:0] to LAD[3:0] or sending data of status register [3:0] to LAD[3:0] 11thcycle: Sending output data buffer [7:4] to LAD[3:0] or sending data of status register [7:4] to LAD[3:0]. • 12thcycle: The "11112 " is output to LAD[3:0]. The OBF flag is cleared and OBE interrupt signal is generated. • 13thcycle: The LAD[3:0] will be set to Hi-Z by slave to switch the communication direction. OBF flag will be set when 8 bits data are written to output data buffer by slave CPU. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 159 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group LPC Bus Interface Data WR (I/O write cycle) START WR 16 BIT ADDRESS DATA TAR SYNC TAR LCLK LFRAME (Note1) LAD [3:0] Input buffer XA2 flag IBF flag Driven by the HOST Driven by the SLAVE Command WR (I/O write cycle) START WR 16 BIT ADDRESS DATA TAR SYNC TAR LCLK LFRAME (Note1) LAD [3:0] Input buffer XA2 flag IBF flag Driven by the HOST Driven by the SLAVE Note1 : LAD0 to LAD3 pins remain Hi-Z after transfer completion Fig.GF-7 Data and Command write timing figure Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 160 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group LPC Bus Interface Data RD (I/O read cycle) START RD 16 BIT ADDRESS TAR SYNC DATA TAR LCLK LFRAME (Note1) LAD [3:0] OBF flag Driven by the HOST Driven by the SLAVE Status RD (I/O read cycle) START RD 16 BIT ADDRESS TAR SYNC DATA TAR LCLK LFRAME (Note1) LAD [3:0] (Note2) OBF flag Driven by the HOST Driven by the SLAVE Note1 : LAD0 to LAD3 pins become Hi-Z after transfer completion. Note2 : OBF flag does not change. Fig.GF-8 Data and Status read timing figure Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 161 of 290 Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 162 of 290 1 1 OBF1 OBF2 OBF3 P45/OBF2 P46/OBF3 1 P44/OBF1 0 1 OBF01 P43/OBF01 O O O O O OBF00 P40/OBF00 1 I 1 LCLK P36/LCLK 0 I 1 LRESET I I/O I/O 1 02C916 Bit 6 I/O 1 02C916 Bit 5 1 0 02C916 Bit 4 Input/ Output P35/LRESET LAD3 P33/LAD3 02C916 Bit 3 HOSTEN control bit 1 LAD2 P32/LAD2 02C916 Bit 2 OBF3 output enable bit I/O 02C916 Bit 1 OBF1 OBF2 output output enable bit enable bit 1 1 02C916 Bit 0 02D616 Bit 3 OBF00 OBF01 output output enable bit enable bit P34/LFRAME LFRAME LAD1 LAD0 Name P31/LAD1 P30/LAD0 Pin name OBF0 output enable bit LPC interface enable bit Table GF-2 Function explanation of the control input and output pins in LPC bus interface function Status output signal. OBF3 output. Status output signal. OBF2 output. Status output signal. OBF1 output. Status output signal. OBF01 output. Status output signal. OBF00 output. LPC synchronous clock signal. LPC reset signal. LPC bus interface function is reset. It is used for indicating the start of LPC cycle and termination of abnormal communication cycle. LPC bus used for transmitting and receiving address, command and data between Host CPU and peripheral devices. Function M16C/6K9 Group LPC Bus Interface M16C/6K9 Group LPC Bus Interface ______________ Table GF-3 Conditions of LPC bus interface function induced by LRESET input Pin name / Internal register ______________ ______________ LRESET=“H” LRESET=“L” P30/LAD0 P31/LAD1 LPC bus interface function(function is P32/LAD2 P33/LAD3 select) Note I/O port Pin _________________ P34/LFRAME _______________ P35/LRESET I/O port LPC bus interface function P36/LCLK P40/OBF00 I/O port P43/OBF01 P44/OBF1 Internal register P45/OBF2 P46/OBF3 OBF output is enable until LRESET=“L”. A spike pulse may be output to the port when the port is already set to L output port and OBF signal______________ is output to the port just before LRESET is set to L. ______________ P42/GateA20 Input data bus buffer unstable Output data bus buffer U flag 7,6,5,4,2 It can't be written by slave side. It can be written and read by Initialization to “0” only for DBBSTS0. XA2 flag slave side. Initialization to “0” IBF flag Initialization to “0” There is possibility to generate IBF interrupt request. OBF flag Initialization to “0” There is possibility to generate OBE interrupt request. LPCADH/L It can be written and read by slave side. LPCCON It can be written and read by slave side. GA20 circuit Initialization Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 163 of 290 LPC Bus Interface M16C/6K9 Group GateA20 output function The GateA20 pin (port P42) can be controlled by LPC interface function channel 0 in hardware. Hardware GateA20 is sharing with P42 pin. Setting “1” to bit 0 of GateA20 control register enables the hardware GateA20 function. The default value of hardware GateA20 is “1”. The GateA20 control register is shown in Fig.GF-9. When the host CPU writes “D1” command to address 006416, and then writes data to address 006016 in succession, the value of bit 1 of the data will be output to GateA20 pin. The timing is shown in Fig.GF-10. The GateA20 operation sequences are shown in Fig.GF-11, Fig.GF-12. As shown in the figures, there is no change in input buffer full flag(IBF0) and no input buffer full(IBF) interrupt request, but the input data bus buffer and XA2 flag are changed in these sequences. The value of the GateA20 output pin will be held till the data next to D1 command is written in. P42 becomes _____________ I/O port and the the value of GateA20 becomes "0" when LRESET input is “L”. GateA20 will be initialized even if the sequence is executed. However, the GateA20 enable bit will not be changed and GateA20 output pin _____________ will be resumed after the LRESET input becomes “H”. GateA20 control register AA A A AA AAA AA A b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol GA20CON Address 002CA16 Reset 0016 Bit name Bit Symbol Function GateA20 enable bit GA20EN R W 0 : P42 as GPIO 1 : Hardware GateA20 function enable Reserved bit Must be set to “0” Nothing is assigned. Meaningless in writing. "0" in reading. Fig.GF-9 GateA20 control register START WRITE 16-bit address DATA TAR SYNC TAR LCLK LFRAME LAD (3:0) Previous value GateA20 pin Fig.GF-10 GateA20 output timing Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 164 of 290 The value of bit 1 of the data LPC Bus Interface M16C/6K9 Group Sequence 1 (basic operation 1) LPC communication GateA20 pin Write data to 006016 Write D1 to 006416 Write FF to 006416 Previous value Bit 1 value of the data IBF0 flag refresh No No No IBF interrupt request No No No Sequence 2 (basic operation 2) LPC communication GateA20 pin Write data other than FF and D1 to 006416 Write data to 006016 Write D1 to 006416 Previous value Bit 1 value of the data IBF0 flag refresh No No Yes IBF interrupt request No No Yes Sequence 3 (basic operation 3) LPC communication GateA20 pin Write data to 006016 Previous value Bit 1 value of the data IBF0 flag refresh No No Yes IBF interrupt request No No Yes Fig.GF-11 GateA20 operation sequence (1) Rev.1.00 Write data to 006016 Write D1 to 006416 Jun 06, 2003 page 165 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group LPC Bus Interface Sequence 4 (re-trigger) Write D1 to 006416 LPC communication Write D1 to 006416 GateA20 pin Write data to 006016 Previous value Bit 1 value of the data IBF0 flag refresh No No No IBF interrupt request No No No Sequence 5 (cancel operation) LPC communication Write D1 to 006416 GateA20 pin Previous value Write data other than D1 to 006416 IBF0 flag refresh No Yes IBF interrupt request No Yes Sequence 6 (continuance operation) LPC communication GateA20 pin Write data1 to 006016 Write D1 to 006416 Previous value Write data2 to 006016 Bit 1 value of the data The value of bit 1 of data 2 IBF0 flag refresh No No No No IBF interrupt request No No No No Fig.GF-12 GateA20 operation sequence (2) Rev.1.00 Write D1 to 006416 Jun 06, 2003 page 166 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Serial Interrupt Output Serial Interrupt Output The serial interrupt output is the circuit that outputs the interrupt request to the host with serial interrupt data format. Tab.SI-1 shows the specification of serial interrupt output. Table.SI-1 Specifications of serial interrupt output Item The factors of serial interrupt The number of frame Operation clock Clock restart Clock stop inhibition OBF sync enable Specification The numbers of serial interrupt requests (numbers of channels) that can output simultaneously are 5 factors. Each interrupt factor of each channel is explained as follows. • Channel 0 ➀ By setting “1” to IRQi request bit (bit 5, 6 i=1,12) of IRQ request register 0, the interrupt request can be generated. ➁ Synchronized with OBF00 and OBF01 that are the host bus interface internal signals, the serial interrupt request can be generated. • Channel 1-3 ➀ By setting “1” to IRQ request bit (bit 5) of IRQ request register 1-3, the interrupt request can be generated. ➁ Synchronized with OBF1-3 that are the host bus interface internal signals, the serial interrupt request can be generated. • Channel 4 By setting “1” to IRQ request bit (bit 5) of IRQ request register 4, the interrupt request can be generated. • Channel 0 ➀ Setting the IRQ1 request bit (bit 5) of IRQ request register0 to “1” or detecting OBF00, which is the host bus interface internal signal, selects Frame 1. ➁ Setting the IRQ12 request bit (bit 6) of IRQ request register0 to “1” or detecting OBF01, which is the host bus interface internal signal, selects Frame 12. • Channel 1-4 Selecting the frame select bit (bit 0-4) of IRQ request register1-4 selects Frame 1-15 or extend Frame 0-10. The operation synchronized with LCLK (Max. 33MHz). (Note) Setting the clock restart enable bit (bit 6) of serial interrupt control register0 to “1” requests the clock restart if the clock has stopped or slowed down in serial interrupt output. Setting the clock stop inhibition bit (bit 5) of serial interrupt control register0 to “1” requests the inhibition of clock stop if the clock tends to stop or slow down in serial interrupt output. Setting the OBF00, OBF01, OBF1-3 sync enable bit (bit 0-4) of serial interrupt control register0 to “1” enables the OBF synchronization. Note: To enable LCLK, it is necessary to enable the LPC bus interface function. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 167 of 290 Serial Interrupt Output M16C/6K9 Group internal data bus Serial interrupt control register0 (address:02B016 ) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Clock stop inhibiting enable IRQ request register1 - 4 (address:02B316 , 02B416, 02B516 ,02B616) IRQ request register0 (address:02B216 ) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 IRQ request 00,01 IRQ request 1 - 4 Clock restart enable OBF sync enable IRQ request 0 - 4 Serial interrupt enable Internal signals OBF00,OBF01, OBF1 - OBF3 IRQ frame number 1 - 4 Serial interrupt request Control circuit IRQ request 0-4 Port control section IRQ request clear Frame number (CH0 - CH4) SERIRQ Serial interrupt output Control circuit Clock operation Status & finish acknowledge Clock restart request & start frame start request Clock monitor/ Control circuit CLKRUN LCLK Reset selection LRESET b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 PRST Serial interrupt control register1(address: 02B116 ) f1 Internal data bus Fig.SI-1 Serial interrupt block chart Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 168 of 290 Serial Interrupt Output M16C/6K9 Group (1) Register explanation Fig.SI-2 shows the configuration of IRQ request register0, Fig.SI-3 shows the configuration of IRQ request register1-4, Fig.SI-4, SI-5 show the configurations of serial interrupt control register0,1 respectively. ● IRQ request register0 IRQR0 The serial interrupt request of Channel 0 is set by software. •IRQ1 request bit IR0 Setting the bit to “1” generates the serial interrupt request (Frame 1). By setting the OBF00 sync enable bit (bit 0) of the serial interrupt control register0 to “1”, the value of IR0 is the same as that of OBF00, which is the host bus interface internal signal. When the internal signal OBF00 is “1”, the serial interrupt is generated. IR0 is cleared to “0” by writing “0” in software. IR0 can not be cleared to “0” by software when the internal signal OBF00 is “1” if OBF00 sync enable bit is set to “1”. •IRQ12 request bit IR1 Setting the bit to “1” generates the serial interrupt request (Frame 12). By setting the OBF01 sync enable bit (bit 1) of the serial interrupt control register0 to “1”, the value of IR1 is the same with that of OBF01, which is the host bus interface internal signal. When the internal signal OBF01 is “1”, the serial interrupt is generated. IR1 is cleared to “0” by writing “0” in software. IR1 can not be cleared to “0” by software when the internal signal OBF01 is “1” if OBF01 sync enable bit is set to “1”. AAAAAA A AAAAAA A IRQ request register0 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol: IRQR0 Address: 02B216 Bit symbol Bit name Nothing is assigned. Meaningless in writing, “0” in reading. IRQ1 request bit 0: No IRQ1 request 1: IRQ1 request IR1 IRQ12 request bit 0: No IRQ12 request 1: IRQ12 request Fig.SI-2 Configuration of IRQ request register0 Jun 06, 2003 Function IR0 Nothing is assigned. Meaningless in writing, “0” in reading. Rev.1.00 When reset: 0016 page 169 of 290 R W Serial Interrupt Output M16C/6K9 Group ● IRQ request register i IRQRi (i=1-4) The serial interrupt request of Channel 1-4 is set by software, or asserting frame is selected. •IRQ request bit IR Setting the bit to “1” generates the serial interrupt request. By setting the OBFj sync enable bit (bit2-4, j=1-3) of the serial interrupt control register0 to “1”, the value of IR is the same as that of OBFj, which is the host bus interface internal signal. When the internal signal OBFj is “1”, the serial interrupt is generated. IR is cleared to “0” by writing “0” in software. IR can not be cleared to “0” by software when the internal signal OBFj is “1” if OBFj sync enable bit is set to “1”. ● IRQ select bit IS0-4 The asserting frame is selected. AA A A AA AAA AA A IRQ request register1-4 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol IRQR1 IRQR2 IRQR3 IRQR4 Bit symbol IS0 Address 02B316 02B416 02B516 02B616 When reset 0016 0016 0016 0016 Bit name IRQ Frame 0 0 0 0 0 : No SERIRQ output 0 0 0 0 1 : Frame 1 0 0 0 1 0 : Frame 2 0 0 0 1 1 : Frame 3 0 0 1 0 0 : Frame 4 0 0 1 0 1 : Frame 5 0 0 1 1 0 : Frame 6 0 0 1 1 1 : Frame 7 0 1 0 0 0 : Frame 8 0 1 0 0 1 : Frame 9 0 1 0 1 0 : Frame 10 0 1 0 1 1 : Frame 11 0 1 1 0 0 : Frame 12 0 1 1 0 1 : Frame 13 0 1 1 1 0 : Frame 14 0 1 1 1 1 : Frame 15 1 0 0 0 0 : Can’t select 1 0 0 0 1 : Can’t select 1 0 0 1 0 : Can’t select 1 0 0 1 1 : Can’t select 1 0 1 0 0 : Can’t select 1 0 1 0 1 : Extend Frame 0 1 0 1 1 0 : Extend Frame 1 1 0 1 1 1 : Extend Frame 2 1 1 0 0 0 : Extend Frame 3 1 1 0 0 1 : Extend Frame 4 1 1 0 1 0 : Extend Frame 5 1 1 0 1 1 : Extend Frame 6 1 1 1 0 0 : Extend Frame 7 1 1 1 0 1 : Extend Frame 8 1 1 1 1 0 : Extend Frame 9 1 1 1 1 1 : Extend Frame 10 IRQ request bit 0: No IRQ request 1: IRQ request IS1 IS2 IS3 IS4 IR Nothing is assigned. Meaningless in writing, “0” in reading. Fig.SI-3 Configuration of IRQ request register1-4 Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 170 of 290 Function Frame select bit b4b3b2b1b0 R W Serial Interrupt Output M16C/6K9 Group ● Serial interrupt control register0 SERCON0 The operation condition of serial interrupt is set. •OBFi sync enable bit SENi (i=00,01,1-3) By setting the bit to “1”, sync with the OBFi of host interface, the serialized interrupt can be generated. •Clock stop inhibition bit SUPEN Setting the bit to “1” will request the inhibition of clock if the clock tends to stop or slow down in serial interrupt request. •Clock restart enable bit RUNEN Setting the bit to “1” requests the clock restart during the clock stop or clock slow down in serial interrupt request. •Serial interrupt enable bit IRQEN __________ _______________ 0: SERIRQ, PRST, CLKRUN are I/O ports. __________ _______________ 1: SERIRQ, PRST, CLKRUN are serial interrupt function ports. AA AA A AA AAAA A AA Serial interrupt control register0 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol SERCON0 Bit symbol Address 02B016 When reset 0016 Bit name R W Function 0: Sync inhibition 1: Sync enable SEN00 OBF00 sync enable bit SEN01 OBF01 sync enable bit 0: Sync inhibition 1: Sync enable SEN1 OBF1 sync enable bit 0: Sync inhibition 1: Sync enable SEN2 OBF2 sync enable bit SEN3 OBF3 sync enable bit 0: Sync inhibition 1: Sync enable 0: Sync inhibition 1: Sync enable 0: Stop control operation 1: No stop control operation SUPEN Clock stop inhibition bit RUNEN Clock restart enable bit 0: No clock restart 1: Clock restart IRQEN Serial interrupt enable bit 0: Serial interrupt inhibition 1: Serial interrupt enable (Note 1) _______________ Note 1 : When IRQEN is set to “1”, if either SUPEN or RUNEN is set to “1”, P46 will function as CLKRUN I/O and the output type is N channel open drain. __________ __________ Note 2 : When the bit is set to “1”, P43, P45 function as SERIRQ, PRST respectively. Even the bit is set to “1”, P45/PRST can function as GPIO if bit 1 of serial interrupt control register 1 (address 02B116) is set to “1”. Fig.SI-4 Configuration of serial interrupt control register0 Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 171 of 290 Serial Interrupt Output M16C/6K9 Group ● Serial interrupt control register1 SERCON1 The register is for setting the pins of serial interrupt. •Reset selection bit RSEL __________ 0: The input of PRST is the reset signal. ______________ 1: The input of LRESET is the reset signal. (Note1) __________ Note 1: The PRST pin becomes I/O port if setting the bit to “1”. AA A AA A AAAA AA Serial interrupt control register 1 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 Symbol SERCON1 Bit symbol Address 02B116 Bit name Reset selection bit OBF0MRG OBF0 mergence bit OBF0CLR OBF0 cut sync bit Reserved bit Nothing is assigned. Meaningless in writing. “0” in reading. Fig.SI-5 Configuration of serial interrupt control register1 Jun 06, 2003 page 172 of 290 0 : Select PRST pin. 1 : Select LRESET pin. Must be “0”. Reserved bit Rev.1.00 Function Must be “0”. Reserved bit RSEL When reset 0016 0 : OBF00 and OBF01 are independent. 1 : OBF00 and OBF01 are merged (logical OR). 0: Normal operation 1: SEN00, SEN01 is cleared when OBF0 is cleared. Must be “0”. R W Serial Interrupt Output M16C/6K9 Group •OBF0 mergence function By setting the bit to “1”, the signal, which is logically OR by OBF00 and OBF01 signals from LPC bus interface, will output to IRQ1 and IRQ12 of serial interrupt circuit. With the function, the IRQ1 and IRQ12 request bits can be cleared simultaneously by H/W at the read of output data buffer from system if both IRQ1 and IRQ12 request bits are set in the case that IRQ1 request bit (or IRQ12 request bit) is set after that of IRQ12 (or IRQ1) because of the overwrite to the output data buffer. •OBF0 sync inhabitant function By setting bit 4 of serial interrupt control register 1 (OBF cut sync bit), simultaneously after the read of OBF0, the OBF0 sync function can be inhabited. If the bit is set to “1”, simultaneously after the clear of OBF00 or OBF01, SEN00 (OBF00 sync enable bit) and SEN01 (OBF01 sync enable bit) bits are cleared (sync inhabitation) by H/W. The configuration of serial interrupt control register 1 and the switching circuit controlled by OBF0MRG, OBF0CLR are shown in Fig. SI-5, Fig. SI-6 respectively. OBF0CLR OBF0MRG OBF0 RD OBF0 “0” RD/WR OBF0001 SEN00 To IRQ1 request bit of serial interrupt circuit WR IR0 “1” OBF0 clear signal (Triggered by host read) “0” OBF0SEL OBF0001 “1” SEN01 RD/WR To IRQ12 request bit of serial interrupt circuit WR IR0 RD Fig.SI-6 The switching circuit controlled by OBF0MRG, OBF0CLR Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 173 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Serial Interrupt Output ● Serial interrupt control register2 SERCON2 The polarity of serial interrupt output can be selected by bit 0 to bit 5 of serial interrupt control register 2. When the bit is set to “0”: If there is a request, Hiz-Hiz-Hiz If there is no request, L-H-Hiz When the bit is set to “1”: If there is a request, L-H-Hiz If there is no request, Hiz-Hiz-Hiz Only the default value of bit 4 (serial interrupt polarity bit 3) of serial interrupt control register 2 after reset is “1”. Fig.SI-7 shows the configuration of serial interrupt control register 2. AA A AA A AAAA AA Serial interrupt control register 2 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol SERCON2 Bit symbol Address 02B716 When reset 1016 Bit name Function SERSEL00 Serial interrupt polarity selection bit 00 SERSEL01 Serial interrupt polarity selection bit 01 SERSEL1 Serial interrupt polarity selection bit 1 SERSEL2 Serial interrupt polarity selection bit 2 SERSEL3 Serial interrupt polarity selection bit 3 SERSEL4 Serial interrupt polarity selection bit 4 Nothing is assigned. Meaningless in writing. “0” in reading. Note: “0” “1” : If there is a request If there is no request : If there is a request If there is no request Hiz-Hiz-Hiz L-H-Hiz L-H-Hiz Hiz-Hiz-Hiz Fig.SI-7 The configuration of serial interrupt control register 2 Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 174 of 290 Select serial interrupt output polarity of IRQ1 in channel 0. (Note) Select serial interrupt output polarity of IRQ12 in channel 0. (Note) Select serial interrupt output polarity of IRQ in channel 1. (Note) Select serial interrupt output polarity of IRQ in channel 2. (Note) Select serial interrupt output polarity of IRQ in channel 3. (Note) Select serial interrupt output polarity of IRQ in channel 4. (Note) R W Serial Interrupt Output M16C/6K9 Group (2) The operation of serial interrupt A cycle operation of serial interrupt starts with start frame and finishes with stop frame. There are 2 kinds of operation mode: continuous mode and quiet mode. The next operation mode is judged by monitoring the length of stop frame sent from host side. ● The timing of serial interrupt cycle Fig.SI-8 shows an example of basic timing of serial interrupt cycle. ➀ Start frame The start frame will be detected if the SERIRQ remains “L” in 4-8 clock cycles. ➁IRQ data frame Each IRQ data frame is 3 clock cycles. •Channel 0-2,4:If the IRQ request bit is “0”, then the SERIRQ is driven to “L” during the 1st clock cycle of the corresponding data frame, to “H” during the 2nd clock cycle, to high impedance during the 3rd clock cycle. If the IRQ request bit is “1”, then the SERIRQ is high impedance during all of the 3 clock cycles. •Channel 3:If the IRQ request bit is “0”, then the SERIRQ is high impedance during all of the 3 clock cycles. If the IRQ request bit is “1”, then the SERIRQ is driven to “L” during the 1st clock cycle of the corresponding data frame, to “H” during the 2nd clock cycle, to high impedance during the 3rd clock cycle. ③Stop frame The stop frame will be detected if the SERIRQ remains “L” in 2 or 3 clock cycles. The next operation mode is quiet mode if the length of “L” is 2 clock cycles, the continuous mode if the length is 3 clock cycles. Start frame frame 0 frame 1 frame 15 IOCHK Stop frame Clock SERIRQ Driver source System side Device side Fig.SI-8 Basic timing of serial interrupt cycle Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 175 of 290 Device side System side to the next cycle Serial Interrupt Output M16C/6K9 Group ● Operation mode Fig.SI-9 shows an example of timing of continuous mode, Fig.SI-10 shows that of quiet mode. ➀Continuous mode __________ _______________ After reset, at the rising edge of PRST (or LRESET) or the length of the last stop frame of serial interrupt cycle being 3 clock cycles, it will be the continuous mode. After receiving the start frame (Note 1), the Frame 1, Frame 12 or frames selected in each channel will be asserted. Note 1: If the length of “L” is less than 4 clock cycles or more than 9 clock cycles, the start frame will not be detected and the next start (the falling edge of SERIRQ) is waited. Start frame (Note1) IRQ0 frame IRQ1 frame IRQ2 frame IRQ3 frame Clock SERIRQ line System•SERIRQ output Device•SERIRQ output Driver source System side Device side Note1 . The start frame is set to 4 clock as setting exemple Fig.SI-9 Timing diagram of continuous mode ➁Quiet mode At clock stop or clock slow down, or the length of the last stop frame of serial interrupt cycle being 2 clock cycles, it will be the quiet mode. In this mode the SERIRQ is driven to “L” in the 1st clock cycle by device and after the receiving of the rest start frame (Note 1) from host, the IRQ1 Frame , IRQ12 Frame or frames selected in each channel will be asserted. Note 1: If the sum of length of “L” that is driven by the device in the 1st clock cycle and by the host in the rest clock cycles is within 4-8 clock cycles, the start frame will be detected. If the sum of length of “L” is less than 4 clock cycles or more than 9 clock cycles, the start frame will not be detected and the next start (the falling edge of SERIRQ) is waited. Start frame (Note1) IRQ0 frame IRQ1 frame LCLK SERIRQ line System•SERIRQ output Device•SERIRQ output Driver source Device side Device side System side Note1 . The start frame is set to 4 clock as setting example Fig.SI-10 Timing diagram of quiet mode Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 176 of 290 IRQ2 frame IRQ3 frame Serial Interrupt Output M16C/6K9 Group (3) Clock restart/ stop inhibition request _______________ Asserting the CLKRUN signal can request to restart or maintain the clock which stops or slows down or request the host to tend to stop or slow down. Fig.SI-11 shows an example of timing of clock restart request, Fig.SI-12 shows an example of timing of clock stop inhibition request. ➀Clock restart operation Setting the clock restart bit of serial interrupt control register0 to “1” will request the clock restart if the clock has slowed down or stopped at serial interrupt request. LCLK CLKRUN line System•CLKRUN Restart frame Device•CLKRUN Start frame SERIRQ line System•SERIRQ Device•SERIRQ f1 Serial interrupt request Internal Interrupt restart request signal Fig.SI-11 Timing diagram of clock restart request ➁Clock stop inhibition request Setting the clock stop inhibition bit of serial interrupt control register0 to “1” will request the inhibition of clock stop if the clock tends to stop or slow down during all the period of serial interrupt output. Clock CLKRUN line System•CLKRUN Inhibition request Device•CLKRUN A cycle of serial interrupt SERIRQ line Serial interrupt request Internal Interrupt Inhibition request signal Fig.SI-12 Example of timing of clock stop inhibition request Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 177 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface The multi-master I2C-BUS interface is a serial communication circuit based on Philips I2C-BUS data transfer format. 3 independent channels, with both arbitration lost detection and a synchronous functions, are built in for the multi-master serial communication. Fig.GC-1 shows a block diagram of the multi-master I2C-BUS interface and Table.GC-1 lists the multi-master I2C-BUS interface functions. The multi-master I2C-BUS interface consists of the I2C address register, the I2C data shift register, the I2C clock control register, the I2C control register 1, I2C control register 2, the I2C status register, the I2C start/stop condition control register and other control circuits. Note 1: 2 independent channels exist in M306K9F8LRP. Table.GC-1 Multi-master I2C-BUS interface functions Item Format Communication mode SCL clock frequency *VIIC=I2C Rev.1.00 system clock Jun 06, 2003 page 178 of 290 Function Based on Philips I2C-BUS standard: 10-bit addressing format 7-bit addressing format High-speed clock mode Standard clock mode Based on Philips I2C-BUS standard: Master transmission Master reception Slave transmission Slave reception 16.1kHz to 400kHz (at VIIC = 4MHz) Rev.1.00 S3D ICK1 b7 Jun 06, 2003 page 179 of 290 b0 Fig.GC-1 Block diagram of multi-master I2C-BUS interface clock (SCL) Serial Noise elimination circuit I C start/stop condition control register 2 Clock control circuit circuit BB circuit b7 I2C address register b0 TOE I2 C system clock (VIIC) Clock division ICK1,ICK0=1,1 ICK1,ICK0=0,0 ICK1,ICK0=0,1 ICK1,ICK0=1,0 1/2 1/2 1/2 1/2 f1 10BIT SAD ALS Bit count ES0 BC2 BC1 BC0 b0 I 2 C status register I C control register 0 S1D 2 b0 Interrupt request signal (I2CIRQ) AL AAS AD0 LRB ICCK(External clock) b7 S1 TISS 2 S2 I C clock control register Interrupt generating circuit MST TRX BB PIN b7 b0 System clock select circuit Timeout detection circuit TOSEL TOF Internal data bud b0 FAST ACK MODE CCR4 CCR3 CCR2 CCR1 CCR0 BIT S4D 2 I C control register 2 I2C data shift register Address comparator SAD5 SAD4 SAD3 SAD2 SAD1 SAD0 RBW b7 S0 b7 S0D SAD6 ACK Data control circuit Noise elimination circuit AL Interrupt request signal (SCLSDAIRQ) SIM Interrupt generating circuit WIT STSP SIS SIP SSC4 SSC3 SSC2 SSC1 SSC0 SEL S2D (SDA) Serial data ICK0 SCLM SDAM I2C Control register 1 M16C/6K9 Group MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface M16C/6K9 Group I2C Data Shift Register The I2C data shift register (address 032016, 033016, 031016) is an 8-bit shift register to store receiving data and write transmission data. When transmit data is written into this register, it is transferred to the outside from bit 7 in synchronization with the SCL clock, and each time one-bit data is output, the data of this register are shifted by one bit to the left. When data is received, it is input to this register from bit 0 in synchronization with the SCL clock, and each time one-bit data is input, the data of this register are shifted by one bit to the left. The timing of storing received data to this register is shown in figure GC-3.The I2C data shift register is in a write enable status only when the I2C-BUS interface enable bit (ES0 bit : bit 3 of address 032316, 033316, 031316) of the I2C control register 0 is “1”. The bit counter is reset by a write instruction to the I2C data shift register. When both the ES0 bit and the MST bit of the I2C status register (address 032816, 033816, 031816) are “1”, the SCL is output by a write instruction to the I2C data shift register. Reading data from the I2C data shift register is always enabled regardless of the value of ES0 bit. 2 AAAAAA I C data shift register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol S0i(i=0,1,2) Address 032016,033016,031016 When reset -- R W Function Transmission data /receiving data are stored. In the master transmission mode, the start condition/ stop condition are triggered by writing data to the register (refer to the section on the method to generate the start/stop condition). The transmission/receiving are started synchronized with SCL. Note Note The write is only enabled when bus interface enable bit (ES0 bit) is "1". Because the register is used both for storing transmission data/receiving data, the transmission data should be written after the receiving data are read out before writing transmission data to this register. Fig.GC-2 I2C data shift register SCL SDA tdfil tdfil : Noise elimination circuit delay time Internal SCL 1 to 2 VIIC cycle Internal SDA tdfil tdsf : Shift clock delay time 1 VIIC cycle tdsft Shift clock Storing data at shift clock rising edge. Fig.GC-3 The timing of receiving data stored to I2C data shift register Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 180 of 290 MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface M16C/6K9 Group I2C Address Register The I2C address register (address 032216, 033216, 031216) consists of a 7-bit slave address and a read/ write bit. In the addressing mode, the slave address written in this register is compared with the address data to be received immediately after the START condition is detected. •Bit 0: Read/write bit (RBW) This is not used in the 7-bit addressing mode. In the 10-bit addressing mode, the first byte address data to be received are compared with the contents (SAD6 to SAD0 + RBW) of the I2C address register. The RBW bit is cleared to “0” automatically when the stop condition is detected. •Bits 1 to 7: Slave address (SAD0–SAD6) These bits store slave addresses. Regardless of the 7-bit addressing mode or the 10-bit addressing mode, the address data transmitted from the master is compared with the contents of these bits. 2 I C address register AAA b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol S0Di(i=0,1,2) b0 Bit Symbol Address 032216,033216,031216 Bit name When reset 000000002 Function RBW Read/Write bit This bit is using for comparing with receiving address data in the 10-bit address mode. (Note) SAD0 Slave address For comparing with received address data SAD1 SAD2 SAD3 SAD4 SAD5 SAD6 Note.The RBW bit is cleared to "0" automatically when stop condition is detected Fig.GC-4 I2C address register Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 181 of 290 R W M16C/6K9 Group MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface I2C Clock Control Register The I2C clock control register 0,1 (address 032416, 033416, 031416) is used to set ACK control, SCL mode and SCL frequency. •Bits 0 to 4: SCL frequency control bits (CCR0–CCR4) These bits control the SCL frequency. Refer to Table GC-2. •Bit 5: SCL mode specification bit (FAST MODE) This bit specifies the SCL mode. When this bit is set to “0”, the standard clock mode is selected. When the bit is set to “1” , the high-speed clock mode is selected. When connecting to the bus with the high-speed mode I2C-BUS standard (maximum 400 kbits/s), set 4 MHz or more to I2C system clock(VIIC). •Bit 6: ACK bit (ACK BIT) This bit sets the SDA status when an ACK clock is generated. When this bit is set to “0”, the ACK return mode is selected and SDA goes to “L” at the occurrence of an ACK clock. When the bit is set to “1”, the ACK nonreturn mode is selected. The SDA is held in the “H” status at the occurrence of an ACK clock. However, when the slave address agrees with the address data in the reception of address data at ACK BIT = “0”, the SDA is automatically made “L” (ACK is returned). If there is a disagreement between the slave address and the address data, the SDA is automatically made “H” (ACK is not returned). *ACK clock: Clock for acknowledgment •Bit 7: ACK clock bit (ACK) This bit specifies the mode of acknowledgment which responses to the data transferring. When this bit is set to “0”, the no ACK clock mode is selected. In this case, no ACK clock occurs after data transmission. When the bit is set to “1”, the ACK clock mode is selected and the master generates an ACK clock at the completion of each 1-byte data transfer. The device for transmitting address data and control data releases the SDA at the occurrence of an ACK clock (makes SDA “H”) and receives the ACK bit generated by the data receiving device. Note: Except for ACK bit (ACKBIT), do not write data into the I2C clock control register during transfer. If data is written during transfer, the I2C clock generator is reset, so that data cannot be transferred normally. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 182 of 290 MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface M16C/6K9 Group 2 I C clock control register AAA b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol S2i(i=0,1,2) Bit Symbol CCR0 Address 032416,033416,031416 Bit name When reset 000000002 Function SCL frequency control bits Refer to table.GC-2 SCL mode specification bit 0 : Standard clock mode 1 : High-speed clock mode ACK bit 0 : ACK is returned 1 : ACK is not returned ACK clock bit 0 : No ACK clock 1 : ACK clock CCR1 CCR2 CCR3 CCR4 FAST MODE ACK BIT ACK Fig.GC-5 I2C clock register Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 183 of 290 R W MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface M16C/6K9 Group → → → → → Table.GC-2 Set values of I2C clock control register and SCL frequency Setting value of CCR4 to CCR0 SCL frequency (at VIIC=4MHz, unit : kHz) (Note1) CCR4 CCR3 CCR2 CCR1 CCR0 Standard clock mode High-speed clock mode 0 0 0 0 0 Setting disabled Setting disabled 0 0 0 0 1 Setting disabled Setting disabled 0 0 0 1 0 Setting disabled Setting disabled 0 0 0 1 1 - (Note2) 333 0 0 1 0 0 - (Note2) 250 0 0 1 0 1 100 400 (Note3) 0 0 1 1 0 83.3 166 500 / CCR value 1000 / CCR value (Note3) (Note3) 1 1 1 0 1 17.2 34.5 1 1 1 1 0 16.6 33.3 1 1 1 1 1 16.1 32.3 Notes1: Duty of SCL clock output is 50 %. The duty becomes 35 to 45 % only when the high-speed clock mode is selected and CCR value = 5 (400 kHz, at V IIC = 4 MHz). “H” duration of the clock fluctuates from –4 to +2 machine cycles in the standard clock mode, and fluctuates from –2 to +2 machine cycles in the high-speed clock mode. In the case of negative fluctuation, the frequency does not increase because “L” duration is extended instead of “H” duration reduction. These are value when SCL clock synchronization by the synchronous function is not performed. CCR value is the decimal notation value of the SCL frequency control bits CCR4 to CCR0. 2: Each value of SCL frequency exceeds the limit at VIIC = 4 MHz or more. When using these setting value, use VIIC = 4 MHz or less. Refer to I2C system clock selection bits (bit 6,7 of I 2C control register 1) on VIIC. 3: The data formula of SCL frequency is described below: VIIC/(8 X CCR value) Standard clock mode VIIC/(4 X CCR value) High-speed clock mode (CCR value ≠ 5) VIIC/(2 X CCR value) High-speed clock mode (CCR value = 5) Do not set 0 to 2 as CCR value regardless of VIIC frequency. Set 100 kHz (max.) in the standard clock mode and 400 kHz (max.) in the high-speed clock mode to the SCL frequency by setting the SCL frequency control bits CCR4 to CCR0. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 184 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface I2C Control Register 0 The I2C control register 0 (address 032316, 033316, 031316) of channel 0, 1 controls data communication format. •Bits 0 to 2: Bit counter (BC0–BC2) These bits decide the number of bits for the next 1-byte data to be transmitted. The I2C interrupt request signal occurs immediately after the number of count specified with these bits (ACK clock is added to the number of count when ACK clock is selected by ACK bit (bit 7 of address 032416, 033416, 031416)) have been transferred, and BC0 to BC2 are returned to “0002”. Also when a START condition is detected, these bits become “0002” and the address data is always transmitted and received in 8 bits. •Bit 3: I2C interface enable bit (ES0) This bit enables to use the multi-master I2C-BUS interface. When this bit is set to “0”, the interface is disabled and the SDA and the SCL become high-impedance. When the bit is set to “1”, the interface is enabled. When ES0 = “0”, the following is performed. 1)Set MST = “0”, TRX = “0”, PIN = “1”, BB =“0”, AL = “0”, AAS = “0”, and AD0 = “0”, of I 2C status register (Address : 032816, 033816, 031816) 2)Writing data to I2C data shift register (Address : 032016, 033016, 031016) is inhibited. 3)The TOF bit of I2C control register (Address : 032716, 033716, 031716) is cleared to “0” 4)I2C system clock (VIIC) is stopped and the interval counter, flags are initialized. •Bit 4: Data format selection bit (ALS) This bit decides if the recognition of slave address should be processed. When this bit is set to “0”, the addressing format is selected, so that address data will be recognized. The transfer will be processed only when a comparison is matched between the salve address and the address data or a general call is received (refer to the item of bit 1 of I2C status register: general call detection flag). When this bit is set to “1”, the free data format is selected, so that slave address will not be not recognized. •Bit 5: Addressing format selection bit (DBIT SAD) This bit selects a slave address specification format. When this bit is set to “0”, the 7-bit addressing format is selected. In this case, only the high-order 7 bits (slave address) of the I2C address register (address 032216, 033216, 031216) are compared with address data. When this bit is set to “1”, the 10-bit addressing format is selected, and all the bits of the I2C address register are compared with address data. •Bit 6: I2C-BUS interface reset bit (IHR) The bit is used to reset I2C-BUS interface circuit in the case that the abnormal communication occurs. When the ES0 bit is“1” (I2C-BUS interface is enabled), writing“1” to the IHR bit makes a H/W reset. Flags are processed as follows: 1)Set MST = “0”, TRX = “0”, PIN = “1”, BB =“0”, AL = “0”, AAS = “0”, and AD0 = “0”, of I 2 C status register (Address : 032816, 033816, 031816) 2)The TOF bit of I2C control register (Address : 032716, 033716, 031716) is cleared to “0” 3)The interval counter, flags are initialized. After writing“1” to IHR bit, the circuit reset processing will be finished in Max. 2.5 VIIC cycles and IHR bit will be automatically cleared to “0”. Fig.GC-6 shows the reset timing. •Bit 7: I2C-BUS interface pin input level selection bit This bit selects the input level of the SCL and SDA pins of the multi-master I2C-BUS interface. When this bit is set to“1” the P60,P61/P62,P63/P76,P77 will become SMBus input level. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 185 of 290 MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface M16C/6K9 Group The signal of writing "1" to IHR bit IHR bit The reset signal to I2 C-BUS interface circuit 2.5 VIIC cycles Fig.GC-6 The timing of reset to the I2C-BUS interface circuit I 2 C control register 0 AAA b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol S1Di(i=0,1,2) Address 032316,033316,031316 Bit Symbol Bit name b2 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 ES0 I 2C-BUS interface enable bit 0 : Disable 1 : Enable ALS Data format selection bit 0 : Addressing format 1 : Free data format DBIT SAD Addressing format selection bit 0 : 7-bit addressing format 1 : 10-bit addressing format IHR I2 C-BUS interface reset bit 0 : Release of reset (auto) 1 : Reset BC1 BC2 TISS Note Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 186 of 290 Function Bit counter (Number of transmitting/ receiving bits) BC0 Fig.GC-7 I2C control register When reset 000000002 2 I C-BUS interface pin input level selection bit b1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 b0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 (Note) : : : : : : : : 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 : I 2 C-BUS input 1 : SMBUS input In the following status, the bit counter will be cleared automatically •Start condition/stop condition is detected •Right after the completion of 1 byte data transmission •Right after the completion of 1 byte data receiving R W M16C/6K9 Group MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface I2C Status Register The I2C status register (address 032816, 033816, 031816) controls the I2C-BUS interface status. The loworder 6 bits are read-only if it is used for status check. The high-order 2 bits can be both read and written. Regarding to the function of writing to the low-order 6 bits, refer to the method of start condition/stop condition generation described later. •Bit 0: Last receive bit (LRB) This bit stores the last bit value of received data and can also be used for ACK receive confirmation. If ACK is returned when an ACK clock occurs, the LRB bit is set to “0”. If ACK is not returned, this bit is set to “1”. Except in the ACK mode, the last bit value of received data is input. The bit will be “0” by executing a write instruction to the I2C data shift register (address 032016, 033016, 031016). •Bit 1: General call detecting flag (AD0) When the ALS bit is “0”, this bit is set to “1” when a general call* whose address data is all “0” is received in the slave mode. By a general call of the master device, every slave device receives control data after the general call. The AD0 bit is set to “0” by detecting the STOP condition, START condition, or ES0 is“0”, or reset. *General call: The master transmits the general call address “0016” to all slaves. •Bit 2: Slave address comparison flag (AAS) This flag indicates a comparison result of address data when the ALS bit is “0”. 1)In the slave receive mode, when the 7-bit addressing format is selected, this bit is set to “1” in one of the following conditions: • The address data, which following the start conduction, is same with upper bits data of I 2C address register(Address 032216, 033216, 031216) • A general call is received. 2)In the slave reception mode, when the 10-bit addressing format is selected, this bit is set to “1” with the following condition: • When the address data is compared with the I2C address register (8 bits consisting of slave address and RBW bit), the first bytes agree. 3)This bit is set to “0” by executing a write instruction to the I2C data shift register (address 032016, 033016, 031016) when ES0 is set to “1”. The bit is also set to “0” when ES0 is set to “0” or when reset. •Bit 3: Arbitration lost* detecting flag (AL) In the master transmission mode, when the SDA is made “L” by any other device, arbitration is judged to have been lost, so that this bit is set to “1”. At the same time, the TRX bit is set to “0”. Immediately after transmission of the byte whose arbitration was lost is completed, the MST bit is set to “0”. The arbitration lost can be detected only in the master transmission mode. When arbitration is lost during slave address transmission, the TRX bit is set to “0” and the reception mode is set. Consequently, it becomes possible to detect the agreement between its own slave address and address data transmitted by another master device. The bit is cleared to “0” if writing to I2C data shift register (address 032016, 033016, 031016) when ES0 is “1”. The bit is also cleared to “0” when ES0 is set to “0” or when reset. *Arbitration lost: The status in which communication as a master is disabled. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 187 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface •Bit 4: I2C-BUS interface interrupt request bit (PIN) This bit generates an interrupt request signal. After each byte data is transmitted, the PIN bit changes from “1” to “0”. At the same time, an I2C interrupt request signal occurs to the CPU. The PIN bit is set to “0” synchronized with the falling edge of the last internal transmitting clock (including the ACK clock) and an interrupt request signal occurs synchronized with the falling edge of the PIN bit. When the PIN bit is “0”, the SCL is kept in the “0” state and clock generation is disabled. In the ACK clock enable mode, if WIT bit (bit 1 of I2C control register 1) is set to “1”, synchronized with the falling edge of last bit clock and ACK clock, PIN bit becomes to “0” and I2C interrupt request is generated (Refer to the description on bit 1 of I2C control register 1: the data reception completion interrupt enable bit). Fig.GC-9 shows the timing of I2C interrupt request generation. The bit is read-only, the value should be “0” in writing. The PIN bit is set to “0” in one of the following condition: •Executing a write instruction to the I2C data shift register (address 032016, 033016, 031016). •Executing a write instruction to the I2C clock control register (Address : 032416, 033416, 031416) (only when WIT is “1” and internal WAIT flag is “1”) •When the ES0 bit is “0” •At reset The PIN bit is set to “0” in one of the following condition: •Immediately after the completion of 1-byte data transmission (including arbitration lost is detected) •Immediately after the completion of 1-byte data reception •In the slave reception mode, with ALS = “0” and immediately after the completion of slave address agreement or general call address reception •In the slave reception mode, with ALS = “1” and immediately after the completion of address data reception •Bit 5: Bus busy flag (BB) This bit indicates the in-use status the bus system. When this bit is set to “0”, bus system is not busy and a START condition can be generated. The BB flag is set/reset by the SCL, SDA pins input signal regardless of master/slave. This flag is set to “1” by detecting the start condition, and is set to “0” by detecting the stop condition. The condition of the detecting is set by the start/stop condition setting bits (SSC4–SSC0) of the I2C start/stop condition control register (address 032516, 033516, 031516). When the ES0 bit (bit 3) of the I2C control register (address 032316, 033316, 031316) is “0” or reset, the BB flag is set to “0”. For the writing function to the BB flag, refer to the sections “START Condition Generating Method” and “STOP Condition Generating Method” described later. •Bit 6: Communication mode specification bit (transfer direction specification bit: TRX) This bit decides a direction of transfer for data communication. When this bit is “0”, the reception mode is selected and the data from a transmitting device is received. When the bit is “1”, the transmission mode is selected and address data and control data are output onto the SDA synchronized with the clock generated on the SCL. This bit can be set/reset by software or hardware. This bit is set to “1” by hardware in the following condition: In___slave mode with ALS = “0”, if the AAS flag is set to “1” after the address data reception and the received R/W bit is “1”. This bit is set to “0” by hardware in one of the following conditions: •When arbitration lost is detected. •When a STOP condition is detected. •When a start condition is prevented by the start condition duplication preventing function (Note). •When a start condition is detected with MST = “0”. •When ACK non-return is detected with MST = “0”. •When ES0 = “0”. •At reset Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 188 of 290 MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface M16C/6K9 Group •Bit 7: Communication mode specification bit (master/slave specification bit: MST) This bit is used for master/slave specification for data communication. When this bit is “0”, the slave is specified, so that a START condition and a STOP condition generated by the master are received. The data communication is performed synchronized with the clock generated by the master. When this bit is “1”, the master is specified and a START condition and a STOP condition are generated. Additionally, the clocks required for data communication are generated on the SCL. This bit is set to “0” by hardware in one of the following conditions. •Immediately after the completion of 1-byte data transfer when arbitration lost is detected. •When a STOP condition is detected. •Writing a start condition is prevented by the start condition duplication preventing function (Note). •At reset Note: START condition duplication preventing function The MST, TRX, and BB bits is set to “1” at the same time after confirming that the BB flag is “0” in the procedure of a START condition occurrence. However, when a START condition by an other master device occurs and the BB flag is set to “1” immediately after the contents of the BB flag is confirmed, the START condition duplication preventing function makes the writing to the MST and TRX bits invalid. The duplication preventing function becomes valid from the rising of the BB flag to reception completion of slave address. Refer to the method on the start condition generation in detail. AA A AA A AAAA AA 2 I C status register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol S1i(i=0,1,2) Bit symbol LRB Address 032816,033816,031816 When reset 0001000X2 Bit name Last receive bit Function R W 0 : Last bit = "0" 1 : Last bit = "1" (Note1) AD0 General call detecting flag 0 : No general call detected 1 : General call detected (Note1) AAS Slave address comparison flag 0 : Address disagreement 1 : Address agreement (Note1) 0 : Not detected 1 : Detected (Note1) AL Arbitration lost detection flag PIN I 2 C-BUS BB TRX MST interface interrupt request bit Bus busy flag Communication mode specification bits 0 : Interrupt request issued 1 : No interrupt request issued 0 : Bus free 1 : Bus busy b7 0 0 1 1 b6 0 : Slave receive mode 1 : Slave transmit mode 0 : Master receive mode 1 : Master transmit mode Note1.This bit is read only if it is used for the status check. How to write this bit, please refer to start condition/stop condition generating method. Note2.The bit can be read and only can be written with "0" by software. Note3.Refer to the method of start condition generation on how to write these bits. How to write this bit, please refer to start condition/stop condition generating method. Fig.GC-8 I2C status register Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 189 of 290 (Note2) (Note1) (Note3) (Note3) M16C/6K9 Group MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface SCL PIN flag I2CIRQ Fig.GC-9 Interrupt request signal generating timing Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 190 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface I2C0, I2C1 control register 1 I2C control register 10, 11, 12 (address 032616, 033616, 031616) controls I2C-BUS interface circuit. •Bit 0 : Interrupt enable bit by STOP condition (SIM ) It is possible for I2C-BUS interface to request an interrupt by detecting a STOP condition. If the bit set to “1”, an interrupt from I2C-BUS interface occurs by detecting a STOP condition ( There is no change for PIN flag) •Bit 1: Interrupt enable bit at the completion of data receiving (WIT) When with-ACK mode (ACK bit = “1”) is specified, by enabling the interrupt at the completion of data receiving (WIT bit = “1”), the I2C interrupt request occurs and PIN bit becomes “0” synchronized with the falling edge of last data bit clock. SCL is fixed “L” and the generation of ACK clock is suppressed. Table GC-3 and Fig.GC-10 show the I2C interrupt request timing and the method of communication restart. After the communication restart, synchronized with the falling edge of ACK clock, PIN bit becomes to “0” and I2C interrupt request occurs. Table.GC-3 Timing of interrupt generation in data receiving The timing of I2C interrupt generation The method of communication restart 1)Synchronized with the falling edge of the The execution of writing to ACKBIT of I2C clock control last data bit clock register. (Do not write to I2C data shift register. The processing of ACK clock would be incorrect.) 2)Synchronized with the falling edge of the The execution of writing to I2C data shift register ACK clock The state of internal WAIT flag can be read out by reading the WIT bit. The internal WAIT flag is set after writing to I2C data shift register, and it is reset after writing to I2C clock control register. Consequently, which of the timing 1) and 2) of interrupt request occurring can be understood. (See Fig.GC-10)In the cases of transmission and address data reception immediately after the START condition, the interrupt request only occurs at the falling edge of ACK clock regardless of the value of WIT bit and the WAIT flag remains the reset state. Write “0” to WIT bit when in NACK is specified. (ACK bit = “0”) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 191 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface •Bits 2,3 : Port function selection bits PED, PEC When ES0 bit of I2C control register 0 is set to “1”, P61/P63 and P60/P62 function as SCL and SDA respectively. However, if PED is set to “1”, SDA functions as output port so as to SCL if PEC is set to “1”. In this case, if “0” or “1” is written to the port register, the data can be output on to the I2C-BUS regardless of the internal SCL/SDA output signals. The functions of SCL/SDA are returned back by setting PED/PEC to “1” again. If the ports are set in input mode, the values on the I2C-BUS can be known by reading the port register regardless of the values of PED and PEC.Table GC-4 shows the port specification. Table.GC-4 Ports specifications P6 port direction register Pin name ES0 bit PED bit P60/P62 0 1 0 1 1 0/1 - ES0 bit PEC bit P6 port direction register 0 1 0 0/1 - 1 1 - P61/P63 Function Port I/O function SDA I/O function SDA input function, port output function Function Port I/O function SCL I/O function SCL input function, port output function •Bits 4,5 : SDA/SCL logic output value monitor bits SDAM /SCLM It is possible to monitor the logic value of the SDA and SCL output signals from I2C-BUS interface circuit. SDAM can monitor the output logic value of SDA. SCLM can monitor the output logic value of SCL. The bits are read-only. Write “0” if in writing (Writing “1” is reserved) •Bits 6,7 : I2C system clock selection bits ICK0, ICK1 These bits select the basic operation clock of I2C-BUS interface circuit. It is possible to select I2C system clock VIIC among 1/2,1/4 and 1/8 of main clock f(XIN) and 1/2 of external I2C clock (ICCK) Table.GC-5 I2C system clock selecting bits ICK1 ICK0 I2C system clock 0 0 VIIC = 1 / 2f1 0 1 VIIC = 1 / 4f1 1 0 VIIC = 1 / 8f1 1 1 VIIC = 1 / 2ICCK Note: f1 = f(XIN) ICCK = External I2C clock Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 192 of 290 MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface M16C/6K9 Group •The address reception in STOP mode /WAIT mode It is possible for I2C-BUS interface to receive address data even in STOP mode or in WAIT mode. However the I2C system clock VIIC should be supplied. Table.GC-6 shows the setting list. Table.GC-6 Clock setting to the I2C system in different operation mode. Mode STOP mode The setting content The external clock is selected as the I2C system clock ( ICK1 = 1, ICK0 = 1) and the external I2C clock is supplied by ICCK. The external clock is selected as the I2C system clock ( ICK1 = 1, ICK0 = 1) and the external I2C clock is supplied by ICCK. Select the peripheral function clock stop bit CMO2 (bit 2 of the system clock control register 0, address : 000616) to the state of not stopping f1,f8,f32 (CMO2 = 0) when in WAIT mode, and then execute the WAIT command. The external clock is selected as the I2C system clock ( ICK1 = 1, ICK0 = 1) and WAIT mode Low power the external I2C clock is supplied by ICCK. consumption mode When in reception mode, ACK bit = "1" WIT bit = "0" SCL SDA 7 clock 7 bit ACK clock 8 clock 8 bit 1 clock ACK bit 1 bit ACKBIT PIN flag Internal WAIT flag I2C interrupt request signal The writing signal of I2C data shift register When in reception mode, ACK bit = "1" WIT bit = "1" SCL SDA 7 clock 7 bit ACK clock 8 clock 1 bit 8 bit ACKBIT PIN flag Internal WAIT flag I2C interrupt request signal ➀ ➁ The writing signal of I2C data shift register The writing signal of I2C clock control register Note. Do not write to I2C clock control register except bit ACKBIT. Fig.GC-10 The timing of the interrupt generation at the completion of data reception Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 193 of 290 MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface M16C/6K9 Group 2 I C control register 1 AAAAA b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol S3Di(i=0,1,2) Bit Symbol Address 032616,033616,031616 Bit name When reset 001100002 Function SIM The interrupt enable bit of STOP condition detection 0 : Disable the interrupt of STOP condition detection 1 : Enable the interrupt of STOP condition detection WIT The interrupt enable bit of at the completion of data reception 0 : Disable 1 : Enable When in NACK setting (ACK bit = "0") please write "0" PED SDAi/Port function switching bit 0 : SDA I/O pin(enable ES0 = 1) 1 : GPIO(enable ES0 = 1) PEC SCLi/Port function switching bit 0 : SCL I/O pin(enable ES0 = 1) 1 : GPIO(enable ES0 = 1) SDAM The logic value monitor bit of SDA output 0 : SDA output logic value = "0" 1 : SDA output logic value = "1" SCLM The logic value monitor bit of SCL output 0 : SCL output logic value = "0" 1 : SCL output logic value = "1" ICK0 I 2 C system clock selection bits b7 b6 0 0 : VIIC=1/2f1 0 1 : VIIC=1/4f1 ✼ f1=f(XIN) 1 0 : VIIC=1/8f1 1 1 : VIIC=1/2ICCK ✼ ICCK=External I2C clock ICK1 Fig.GC-11 I2C control register 1 Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 194 of 290 R W MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface M16C/6K9 Group I2C control register 2 I2C0, 1 control register 2 (address: 032716, 033716, 031716) control the detection of communication abnormality. In I2C-BUS communication, the data transfer is controlled by the SCL clock signal. The devices will stop in the communication state if SCL stops during transfer. So if the SCL clock stops in “H” state for a period of time, the I2C-BUS interface circuit can detect the time out and request an I2C interrupt. Please see Fig.GC-12. SCL clock stop (“H”) 1 clock SCL 1 bit SDA 2 clock 2 bit 3 clock 3 bit BB flag Internal counter start signal Internal counter stop, reset signal The time of timeout detection Internal counter overflow signal I2C interrupt request signal Fig.GC-12 The timing of timeout detection •Bit0: Time out detection function enable bit (TOE) The bit enables timeout detection function. By setting this bit to “1”, the I2C interrupt request signal will be generated if the SCL clock stops in “H” state for a period of time during bus busy (BB flag =“1”). The time of time out detection which is selected by timeout detection time selection bit (TOSEL) with long time mode or short time mode will be calculated by internal counter. When time out is detected, please set “0” to I2C-BUS interface enable bit (ES0) and then process initialization. •Bit1: Time out detection flag (TOF ) The bit is the flag showing timeout detection status. If the time which is calculated by the internal counter overflows, the time out detection flag (TOF) becomes to “1”, and at the same time the I2C interrupt request signal is generated. •Bit2: timeout detection time selection bit (TOSEL) The bit selects timeout detection time from long time and short time mode. If TOSEL = “0”, the long time mode; TOSEL = “1”, the short mode is selected respectively. The long time is up counted by 16 bits counter and the short time is up counted by 14 bits counter based on I2C system clock (VIIC). Table GC-7 shows examples of the timeout detection time. Table.GC-7 Examples of timeout detection time VIIC(MHz) 4 2 1 Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 Long time mode 16.4 32.8 65.6 page 195 of 290 (Unit: ms) Short time mode 4.1 8.2 16.4 MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface M16C/6K9 Group 2 I Control register 2 AAA b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol S4Di(i=0,1,2) Bit symbol Address 032716,033716,031716 Bit name When reset 000000002 Function TOE Timeout detection function enable bit 0 : Disable 1 : Enable TOF Timeout detection flag 0 : Not detected 1 : Detected Timeout detection time selection bit 0 : Long time 1 : Short time TOSEL R W Nothing is assigned. Can not be written in the value is "0" SCPIN STOP condition detection interrupt request bit 0 : No interrupt request 1 : Interrupt request Fig.GC-13 I2C control register 2 •Bit7: STOP condition detection interrupt request bit (SCPIN) The bit monitors the stop condition detection interrupt. The bit becomes to “1” when I2C-BUS interface interrupt is generated by the detecting of STOP condition. Writing “0” clears the bit and “1” can not be written. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 196 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface I2C START/STOP condition control register I2C START/STOP condition register(address 032516, 033516, 031516) controls the detection of START/STOP condition. •Bit0-Bit4: START/STOP condition setting bits (SSC4-SSC0) Because the release time, set up time and hold time of SCL is calculated on the base of I2C system clock(VIIC). The detecting condition changes depending on the oscillation frequency and I2C system clock selecting bits. It is necessary to set the suitable value of START/STOP condition setting bits (SSC4-SSC0) so that obtain the release time, set up time and hold time corresponding to the system clock frequency. Refer to Table GC-11. Do not set odd number or “000002” to START/STOP condition setting bits. The recommended setting value to START/STOP condition setting bits (SSC4-SSC0) at each oscillation frequency under standard clock mode is shown in Table. GC-8. The detection of START/STOP condition starts immediately after the setting of ES0=1. •Bit5: SCL/SDA interrupt pin polarity selection bit (SIP) The interrupt can be generated by detecting the rising edge or the falling edge of SCL pin or SDA pin. SCL/SDA interrupt pin polarity selection bit selects the polarity of SCL pin or SDA pin for interrupt. •Bit6 : SCL/SDA interrupt pin selection bit (SIS) SCL/SDA interrupt pin selection bit selects either SCL pin or SDA pin as SCL/SDA interrupt enable pin. Note: The SCL/SDA interrupt request may be set when the setting of I2C-BUS interface enable bit ES0 changes. Thus set the interrupt disable before the setting of SCL/SDA interrupt pin polarity selection bit (SIP) and SCL/SDA interrupt selection bit(SIS). After that reset “0” to the interrupt request bit before enabling the interrupt. •Bit7: START/STOP condition generation selecting bit (STSPSEL) The bit selects the length of set up/hold time when START/STOP condition occurs. The length of set up/hold time is based on the I2C system clock cycles. Refer to Table GC-9. Set the bit to “1” if I2C system clock frequency is over 4MHz. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 197 of 290 MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface M16C/6K9 Group 2 I C start/stop condition control register AAA b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol S2Di(i=0,1,2) Bit Symbol SSC0 Address 032516,033516,031516 Bit name START/STOP condition setting bits When reset 000110102 Function R W The setting of the detecting condition of START/STOP condition.Refer to Table GC-8. SSC1 Note: Prohibit the setting of "000002" and odd value SSC2 SSC3 SSC4 SIP SCL/SDA interrupt pin polarity selection bit 0 : Active in falling edge 1 : Active in rising edge SIS SCL/SDA interrupt pin selection bit 0 : SDA enable 1 : SCL enable START/STOP condition generation selection bit 0 : Setup/hold time short mode 1 : Setup/hold time long mode STSP SEL Fig.GC-14 I2C start/stop condition control register Table.GC-8 Recommended setting value (SSC4 - SSC0) start/stop condition at each oscillation frequency Oscillation I2C system I2C system SSC4-SSC0 SCL release Setup time Hold time f(XIN) (MHz) clock selection clock(MHz) time(cycle) (cycle) (cycle) 10 1 / 2f1 5 XXX11110 6.2µs (31) 3.2µs (16) 3.0µs (15) 8 1 / 2f1 4 XXX11010 6.75µs(27) 3.5µs (14) 3.25µs(13) XXX11000 6.25µs(25) 3.25µs(13) 3.0µs (12) 8 1 / 8f1 1 XXX00100 5.0µs (5) 3.0µs (3) 2.0µs (2) 4 1 / 2f1 2 XXX01100 6.5µs (13) 3.5µs (7) 3.0µs (6) XXX01010 5.5µs (11) 3.0µs (6) 2.5µs (5) 2 1 / 2f1 1 XXX00100 5.0µs (5) 3.0µs (3) 2.0µs (2) Note: Do not set odd value or “000002” to START/STOP condition setting bits. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 198 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface START Condition Generation Method When ES0 bit of the I2C control register is “1” and the BB flag of I2C status register is “0”, writing “1” to the MST, TRX, and BB bits and “0” to the PIN and low-order 4 bits of the I2C status register (address 032816, 033816, 031816) simultaneously enters the standby status to generate the start condition. The start condition is generated after writing slave address data to the I2C data shift register. After that, the bit counter becomes “0002” and 1 byte SCL are output. The START condition generation timing is different in the standard clock mode and the high-speed clock mode. Refer to Fig.GC-17 the START condition generation timing diagram, and Table GC-9 the START condition generation timing table. Interrupt disable No BB=0? Yes S1i=E016 S0i=Data Interrupt enable Fig.GC-15 Start condition generation flow chart Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 199 of 290 Start condition standby status setting Start condition trigger occur. ✼ Data=Slave address data M16C/6K9 Group MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface Function of protection of duplicate START condition It is necessary to verify that the bus is not in use via BB flag before setting up a START condition. However, there is a possibility that right after the verification of BB flag, the BB flag becomes to “1” because a START condition is generated by another master device .In this case, the function to interrupt the start condition is built in. When the function starts, it works as follows: •The prohibition of setting up START condition standby If the START condition standby has been set up, releases it and resets the bits of MST and TRX. •The prohibition of writing to the I2C data shift register (The prohibition of generating a START condition trigger) •If the generation of start condition is interrupted, sets the AL flag. The function of protection of duplicate START condition is valid from the falling edge of SDA of START condition to the completion of slave reception. Fig.GC-16 shows the valid period of the function of protection of duplicate START condition. 1 clock SCL SDA 1 bit 2 clock 2 bit 3 clock 3 bit 8 clock 8 bit ACK clock ACK bit BB flag The valid period of protection of duplicate START condition Fig.GC-16 The valid period of the function of protection of duplicate START condition Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 200 of 290 MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface M16C/6K9 Group STOP Condition Generation Method When the ES0 bit of the I2C control register is “1”, writing “1” to the MST and TRX bits, and “0” to the BB, PIN and low-order bits of the I2C status register simultaneously enters the standby status to generate the stop condition. The stop condition is generated after writing dummy data to the I2C data shift register. The STOP condition generation timing is different in the standard clock mode and the high-speed clock mode. Refer to Fig.GC-18, the STOP condition generation timing diagram, and Table GC-9, the STOP condition generation timing table. Do not write data to I2C status register and I2C data shift register, before BB flag becomes to “0” after the instruction to generate the stop condition to avoid the influence on generating STOP condition waveform. I2C data shift register write signal SCL Setup time SDA AA AA Hold time Fig.GC-17 Start condition generation timing diagram I2C data shift register write signal SCL SDA AA AA AAAA Setup time Hold time Fig.GC-18 Stop condition generation timing diagram Table.GC-9 Start/Stop generation timing table Item Start/Stop condition generation selection bit Setup “0” time “1” hold “0” time “1” Note: VIIC = 4MHz Standard clock mode 5.0µs (20 cycle) 13.0µs (52 cycle) 5.0µs (20 cycle) 13.0µs (52 cycle) High-speed clock mode 2.5µs (10 cycle) 6.5µs (26 cycle) 2.5µs (10 cycle) 6.5µs (26 cycle) As mentioned above, Writing “1” to MST and TRX bits. Writing “1” or “0” to BB bit, writing “0” to PIN and low-order 4 bits, simultaneously sets up the START or STOP condition standby. It releases SDA in START condition standby, makes SDA to “L” in STOP condition standby. The signal of writing to data shift register triggers the generation of START/STOP condition. In the case of setting MST, and TRX to “1” but do not want to generate a START/STOP condition. Write “1” to the low-order 4 bits simultaneously. Fig.GC-10 illustrates the function of writing to status register. Table.GC-10 The function of writing to status register The value of the data writing to status register MST TRX BB PIN AL AAS AS0 LRB 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0/1 0/1 0 1 1 1 1 Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 201 of 290 Function Setting up the START condition stand by in master transmission mode Setting up the STOP condition stand by in master transmission mode Setting up the communication mode (refer to the description on I2C status register) M16C/6K9 Group MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface START/STOP Condition Detecting Operation The START/STOP condition detection operations are shown in Fig.GC-19, GC-20 and Table.GC-11 The START/STOP condition is set by the START/STOP condition set bit. The START/STOP condition can be detected only when the input signal of the SCL and SDA pins satisfy with three conditions: SCL release time, setup time, and hold time (see Table.GC-11). The BB flag is set to “1” by detecting the START condition and is reset to “0” by detecting the STOP condition. The BB flag set/reset timing is different in the standard clock mode and the high-speed clock mode. Refer to Table GC-11, the BB flag set/reset time. AAA AA SCL release time SCL SDA Setup time Hold time BB flag set time BB flag Fig.GC-19 Start condition detection timing diagram AAA AA SCL release time SCL SDA Setup time Hold time BB flag reset time BB flag Fig.GC-20 Stop condition detection timing diagram Table.GC-11 Start/Stop generation timing table SCL release time Setup time Hold time BB flag set/reset time Standard clock mode SSC value + 1 cycle (6.25µs) SSC value + 1 cycle < 4.0µs (3.25µs) 2 SSC value cycle < 4.0µs (3.0µs) 2 SSC value - 1 +2 cycle (3.375µs) 2 High-speed clock mode 4 cycle (1.0µs) 2 cycle (0.5µs) 2 cycle (0.5µs) 3.5 cycle (0.875µs) Note: Unit : Cycle number of system clock VIIC SSC value is the decimal notation value of the START/STOP condition set bits SSC4 to SSC0. Do not set “0” or an odd number to SSC value. The value in parentheses is an example when the I2C START/STOP condition control register is set to “1816” at VIIC = 4 MHz. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 202 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface Address Data Communication There are two address data communication formats, namely, 7-bit addressing format and 10-bit addressing format. The respective address communication formats are described below. (1) 7-bit addressing format To adapt the 7-bit addressing format, set the DBIT SAD bit of the I2C control register 0 (address 032316, 033316, 031316) to “0”. The first 7-bit address data transmitted from the master is compared with the highorder 7-bit slave address stored in the I2C address register (address 032216, 033216, 031216). At the time of this comparison, address comparison of the RBW bit of the I2C address register (address 032216, 033216, 031216) is not performed. For the data transmission format when the 7-bit addressing format is selected, refer to Fig.GC-21 (1) and (2). (2) 10-bit addressing format To adapt the 10-bit addressing format, set the DBIT SAD bit of the I2C control register 0 (address 032316, 033316, 031316) to “1”. Also set the WIT bit of I2C control register 1 to “1”. An address comparison is performed between the first-byte address data transmitted from the master and the 8-bit slave address stored in the I2C address register (address 032216, 033216, 031216). At the time of this comparison, an address ____ comparison between the RBW bit of the I2C address register (address 032016, 033016, 031016) and the R/W bit which is the last bit of the address data transmitted from the master is made. In the 10-bit addressing mode, the RBW bit which is the last bit of the address data not only specifies the direction of communication for control data, but also is processed as an address data bit. When the first-byte address data agree with the slave address, the AAS bit of the I2C status register (address 032816, 033816, 031816) is set to “1”. After the second-byte address data is stored into the I2C data shift register (address 32016, 33016, 031016), perform an address comparison between the second-byte data and the slave address by software. When the address data of the 2 bytes agree with the slave address, write “0” to the ACKBIT to I2C clock control register, to return an ACK. When the address data of the 2 bytes do not agree with the slave address, it does not return an ACK so that makes the finish of the communication by writing “1” to the ACKBIT. If the address data agree with each other, set the RBW bit of the I2C address register (address 032216, 033216, 031216) to “1” by software. This processing can make the 7-bit slave ___ address and R/W data agree, which are received after a RESTART condition is detected, with the value of the I2C address register (address 032216, 033216, 031216). For the data transmission format when the 10-bit addressing format is selected, refer to Fig.GC-21(3) and (4). Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 203 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface (1) A master-transmitter transmits data to a slave-receiver S Slave address R/W 7 bits “0” A Data A Data A/A P A P 1 - 8 bits 1 - 8 bits (2) A master-receiver receives data from slave-transmitter S Slave address 7 bits R/W A “1” Data A 1 - 8 bits Data 1 - 8 bits (3) A master-transmitter transmits data to a slave-receiver with a 10-bit address S Slave address 1 st 7 bits 7 bits R/W A “0” Slave address 2nd byte A Data 1 - 8 bits 8 bits Data A A/A P 1 - 8 bits (4) A master-receiver receives data from slave-transmitter with a 10-bit address S Slave address 1 st 7 bits 7 bits S : START condition A : ACK bit Sr : Restart condition R/W “0” A Slave address 2nd byte A Sr 8 bits P : STOP condition R/W : Read/Write bit Fig.GC-21 Address data communication format Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 204 of 290 Slave address 1 st 7 bits 7 bits R/W “1” A Data 1 - 8 bits A Data 1 - 8 bits A P M16C/6K9 Group MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface Example of Master Transmission An example of master transmission in the standard clock mode, at the SCL frequency of 100 kHz and in the ACK return mode is shown below. 1)Set a slave address in the high-order 7 bits of the I2C address register and “0” into the RBW bit. 2)Set the ACK return mode and SCL = 100 kHz by setting “0016” in the I2C control register 1 and “8516” in the I2C clock control register respectively. (f(XIN)=8MHz) 3)Set “0016” in the I2C status register so that transmission/reception mode is initialized. 4)Set a communication enable status by setting “0816” in the I2C control register 0. 5)Confirm the bus free condition by the BB flag of the I2C status register. 6)Set “E016” in the I2C status register to setup a standby of START condition. 7)Set the destination address data for transmission in high-order 7 bit of I2C data shift register and set “0” in the least significant bit. And then a START condition occurs. At this time, SCL for 1 byte and an ACK clock automatically generate. 8)Set transmission data in the I2C data shift register. At this time, an SCL and an ACK clock automatically generate. 9)When transmitting control data of more than 1 byte, repeat step 8). 10)Set “C016” in the I2C status register to setup a STOP condition if ACK is not returned from slave reception side or transmission ends. 11)A STOP condition occurs when writing dummy data to I2C data shift register. Example of Slave Reception An example of slave reception in the high-speed clock mode, at the SCL frequency of 400 kHz, in the ACK return mode and using the addressing format is shown below. 1)Set a slave address in the high-order 7 bits of the I2C address register and “0” in the RBW bit. 2)Set the ACK clock mode and SCL = 400 kHz by setting “0016” in the I2C control register 1 and “A516” in the I2C clock control register respectively. (f(XIN)=8MHz) 3)Set “0016” in the I2C status register so that transmission/reception mode is initialized. 4)Set a communication enable status by setting “0816” in the I2C control register 0. 5)When a START condition is received, an address comparison is performed. 6)•When all transmitted addresses are “0” (general call): AD0 of the I2C status register is set to “1” and an interrupt request signal occurs. •When the transmitted addresses agree with the address set in1): ASS of the I2C status register is set to “1” and an interrupt request signal occurs. •In the cases other than the above AD0 and AAS of the I2C status register are set to “0” and no interrupt request signal occurs. 7)Set dummy data in the I2C data shift register. 8)After receiving 1 byte data, it returns an ACK automatically and an interrupt request signal occurs. 9)In the case of whether returning an ACK or not by the content of the received control data, set the WIT bit of I2C control register 1 to “1”, and after writing dummy data to I2C data shift register, receives the control data. 10)After receiving 1 byte data, an interrupt request signal occurs, set the ACKBIT to “1” or “0” by reading the content of the data shift register, and then returns or does not return an ACK. 11)When receiving control data of more than 1 byte, repeat step 7) 8) or 7) 10). 12)When a STOP condition is detected, the communication ends. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 205 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface Usage precautions (1) Access to the registers of I2C-BUS interface circuit The precaution of read/write to the control registers of I2C-BUS circuit is as follows. •I2C data shift register (S0i : 032016, 033016, 031016) Do not write the register during transfer. The transfer bit counter will be reset and makes data communication incorrect. •I2C address register (S0Di : address 032216, 033216, 031216) After the detection of a STOP condition, RBW is reset by H/W. Do not read/write the register at the time, because data may become undetermined. Fig.GC-22 shows the RBW bit H/W reset timing. 2 •I C control register 0 (S1Di : address 032316, 033316, 031316). After the detection of a START condition or the completion of 1 byte transfer, bit counter (bits BC0 - BC2) is reset by H/W. Do not read/write the register at the time, because data may become undetermined. Fig.GC-23, GC-24 show the bit counter H/W reset timing. 2 •I C clock control register (S2i : address 032416, 033416, 031416) Do not write to this register except ACKBIT during transfer. The I2C clock generator will be reset and makes transfer incorrect. control register 1 (S3Di : address 032616, 033616, 031616) Write I2C system clock selection bits when I2C-BUS interface enable bit (ES0)is in disable state. By reading the data reception completion interrupt enable bit (WIT), the internal WAIT flag will be read. Thus, do not use bit manipulation (read-modify-write instruction) to access the register. 2 •I C status register (S1i : address 032816, 033816, 031816) Do not use bit manipulation (read-modify-write instruction) to access the register because all bits of this register are changed by H/W. Do not read/write during the timing when communication mode setting bits MST and TRX are changed by H/W. Data may become undetermined. Fig.GC-22, GC-23, and GC-24 show the change timing of MST and TRX bits by H/W. •I2C Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 206 of 290 MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface M16C/6K9 Group SCL SDA BB flag AAA AAA Bit reset signal Related bits RBW MST TRX AAAA 1.5VIIC cycle Fig.GC-22 The timing of bit reset (The detection of STOP condition) SCL SDA BB flag AAAAA Bit reset signal Related bits BC0 - BC2 TRX(slave mode) Fig.GC-23 The timing of bit reset (The detection of START condition) SCL AA AAA PIN bit Bit reset signal 2VIIC cycle Bit set signal The bits referring to set 1VIIC cycle Fig.GC-24 Bit set/reset timing ( at the completion of data transfer) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 207 of 290 AAAAA AAAAA AAAAA The bits referring to reset BC0 - BC2 MST(When in arbitration lost) TRX(When in NACK reception in slave transmission mode) TRX(ALS="0" meanwhile the slave reception R/W bit = "1" M16C/6K9 Group MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS Interface (2) Generation of RESTART condition After 1 byte data transfer, a RESTART condition standby can be set up by writing “E016” to I2C status register and the SDA pin will be released. Wait in software until SDA become “H” stable and then owing to writing to I2C data shift register a START condition trigger will be generated. Fig.GC-25 shows the restart condition generation timing. (3) Limitation of internal clock 0 The registers of I2C-BUS interface circuit can not be read from or written to if the internal clock up selected to sub clock (XCIN, XCOUT) by system clock selection bit (system clock control register 0, address 000616, CMO7 bit). Please select main clock (XIN, XOUT) in read/write. SCL ACK clock 8 clock SDA S1i writing signal ( Set the standby of start condition) S0i writing signal (START condition trigger generation) Fig.GC-25 The time of generation of RESTART condition Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 208 of 290 Insert software wait PS2 Interface M16C/6K9 Group PS2 Interface PS2 interface is supported by 3 channels of serial transmission/reception circuit which is based on PS2 standard specifications. There are two signal lines, used by PS2 interface : PS2 data(DAT) and PS2 clock(CLK). The DAT and CLK signal lines are bidirection and should be connected to positive power supply via external pull-up resistors. These two pins are N-channel open drain output. While bus is released, the states of DAT and CLK is “High”. Fig.GK-1 shows the system configuration. Output Output DAT DAT Input Output Input Output CLK CLK Input Control side Fig.GK-1 System configuration Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 209 of 290 Input Device side M16C/6K9 Group PS2 Interface The PS2 interface performs 1 byte data transfer with the format shown in Fig.GK-2. Table GK-1 shows the communication specification. Table GK-1 Communication specification Item Data transfer format *Start bit *Data bit *Parity bit *Stop bit Transfer clock Reception start condition Transmission start condition Transfer abort Interrupt request generation timing Error detection Selection function Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 Specification : 1 bit : 8 bits (LSB first) : 1 bit (Odd) : 1 bit *Acknowledge : 1 bit (Transmission only) *Using the clock, which is synchronized with the sampling clock of PS2 clock (CLK) *The following conditions should be met for reception start 1) Setting reception enable bit to “1” 2) The detection of “L” on both PS2 clock (CLK) and PS2 data (DAT) lines *The following conditions should be met for transmission start 1) Setting transmission data to PS2i shift register 2) Setting transmission enable bit to “1” *The following conditions should be met for transfer abort 1) Setting transfer interruption bit to “1” 2) The transfer completion flag becomes “1” *In reception: At the completion of stop bit reception *In transmission: At the completion of ACK bit reception. *In transfer interruption: At the completion of transfer interruption *Parity error (In reception) It occurs when there is a parity error in data reception *Framing error (In reception) It occurs when the detection of stop bit of reception data fails. *Abnormal acknowledge reception (In transmission) It occurs when NAK is received from a device side after the data transmission *Sampling clock selection Selecting the clock which samples the PS2 clock (CLK) and PS2 data (DAT) page 210 of 290 PS2 Interface M16C/6K9 Group In reception Data :8-bit Parity :Odd Stop :1 bit START D0 10-bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 PARITY STOP D6 D7 PARITY STOP ACK/NAK 1 byte data format In Transmission Data Parity Stop Acknowledge START :8-bit :Odd :1 bit :1 bit D0 11-bit D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 1 byte data format Fig.GK-2 1 byte data format Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 211 of 290 PS2 Interface M16C/6K9 Group Fig.GK-3 shows the PS2 interface overall block diagram. Fig.GK-4 shows the transmission/reception block diagram. Internal data bus PS2 mode register (02AC16) Pin selection Control stop PS2Bi(i=0-2) CLK output DAT output Ch0 Transmission/ reception section "1" Interrupt request 0 "1" CLK input DAT input PS2Ai(i=0-2) Ch1 "1" Transmission/ reception section "1" Interrupt request 1 Port control section 1/4 f1 Divider Sampling clock selection 1/8 1/16 1/32 Fig.GK-3 PS2 interface block diagram Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 212 of 290 Sampling clock Ch2 Transmission/ reception section Interrupt request 2 PS2 Interface M16C/6K9 Group Internal data bus PS2i shift register (02A016,02A416,02A816) DAT output Sampling clock CLK output CLK input Synchronization DAT input Reception start detection circuit Transmission/reception control circuit Shift enable Reception enable Transfer abort Reception completion Reception process section • Completion detection • Parity generation PE & FE Transmission process section Completion detection • Parity generation • Acknowledge reception Transfer completion process circuit Transmission completion Acknowledge result Transmission enable Communication status flags Error flag refresh Transfer completion flag refresh All bits clear Interrupt request PS2i control register (02A216,02A616,02AA16) PS2i status register (02A116,02A516,02A916) Internal data bus Fig.GK-4 Transmission/reception section block diagram (One channel) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 213 of 290 PS2 Interface M16C/6K9 Group (1) Register description ● PS2i shift register • Transmission/reception data (1) Data reception The reception data are stored. (2) Data transmission By writing the transmitted data to the register, data transmission is ready to start. PS2 data (DAT) will become “L” automatically (transmission start). AAA PS2i Shift register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 symbol PS20SR PS21SR PS22SR b0 Bit symbol Fig.GK-5 PS2i shift register Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 214 of 290 Address 02A016 02A416 02A816 Bit name Reset value 0016 0016 0016 Function Transmission/reception data R W PS2 Interface M16C/6K9 Group ● PS2i Control register • Reception enable bit (REN) The data reception is allowed when this bit is set to “1”. The PS2 clock (CLK) will become to “H” (reception enable status) automatically. This bit will be cleared to “0” automatically after the completion of data reception and PS2 clock (CLK) will become “L” (reception disable status) . If this bit is needed wants to be cleared after setting it to “1” but before the transfer completion flag is set, set reception enable bit = “0”, transfer abort request bit = “0” and proccess the transfer abort simultaneously. • Transmission enable bit (TEN) After writing transmission data to the PS2i shift register, setting the bit to “1” makes data transmission enabled and PS2 clock (CLK) will become “H” automatically (transmission enable status). This bit will be cleared to “0” automatically after the completion of data transmission and PS2 clock (CLK) will become “L” (transmission disable status). If this bit is needed to be cleared after setting it to “1” but before the transfer completion flag is set, set reception enable bit = “0”, transfer abort request bit = “0” and proccess the transfer abort simultaneously. • Transfer abort request bit (RSTOP) This bit is used to abort the data transfer procession. At the completion of transfer abort procession, the transfer completion flag and transfer abort flag of PS2i status register are set to “1”, the bit is cleared to “0” automatically and PS2 clock (CLK) will become “L” ( reception disable status). After “L” is output to the PS2 clock (CLK), do not execute the following transmission/reception before the device recognizes the transfer abort request. PS2i control register AAA b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol PS20CON PS21CON PS22CON b0 Bit Symbol Address 02A216 02A616 02AA16 Bit name Reception enable bit 0 : Disable 1 : Enable TEN Transmission enable bit 0 : Disable 1 : Enable RSTOP Transfer abort request bit 0 : No transfer abort 1 : Transfer abort Fig.GK-6 PS2i control register Jun 06, 2003 Function REN Nothing is assigned. Meaningless in writing, "0" in reading. Rev.1.00 Reset Value 0016 0016 0016 page 215 of 290 R W M16C/6K9 Group PS2 Interface ●PS2i status register • Transfer completion flag (TI) The flag is set to “1” at the completion of transmission/reception and the completion of transfer abort. The flag is cleared at read out from PS2i shift register or when the reception enable bit is changed from “0” to “1”. • Receiving flag (RF) The flag is set to “1” during the data reception. The flag is cleared automatically after the data reception or after the transfer abort. • Reception abort incognizable flag (CD) The flag is set in the case that device side can not recognize the abort even if the reception abort is requested. (The flag is set in the period between the completion of data bit 6 reception and the completion of stop bit reception.) The flag is cleared automatically after the completion of data reception or after the completion of transfer abort. ✽ Note that during the period when the flag is set, the device side can not recognize the reception abort request even if the tranfer abort is executed. Thus the data that the transfer abort is requested will not be resent from device side. • Transfer status flag (TS) The flag is set to “1” at the completion of data reception. The flag is cleared at read out from PS2i shift register or when the reception enable bit is changed from “0” to “1”. • Parity error flag (PE) This bit is set to “1” when parity error occurs in received data. The flag is cleared at read out from PS2i shift register or when the reception enable bit is changed from “0” to “1”. • Framing error / NACK reception flag (FE) At the completion of reception: The flag is set when the detection of stop bit of reception data fails. At the completion of transmission: The flag is set when NAK is received from the device side. The flag is cleared at read out from PS2i shift register, the reception enable bit or the transmission bit is changed from “0” to “1”. • Transfer abort completion flag (CC) This bit is set to “1” when transfer abort procession is completed. The flag is cleared at read out from PS2i shift register, or when the reception enable bit or the transmission bit is changed from “0” to “1”. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 216 of 290 PS2 Interface M16C/6K9 Group PS2i status register AAA b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol PS20STS PS21STS PS22STS b0 Bit Symbol Address 02A116 02A516 02A916 Bit name TI Transfer completion flag RF Receiving flag 0 : Waiting for reception, Reception complete 1 : During receiving CD Reception abort incognizable flag 0 : Recognizable 1 : Incognizable TS Transfer status flag 0 : Transmission operation 1 : Reception operation PE Parity error flag 0 : No error 1 : Error FE Framing error / NACK reception flag 0 : No error 1 : Error CC Transfer abort completion flag 0 : Not abort 1 : Abort Fig.GK-7 PS2i status register Jun 06, 2003 Function 0 : Waiting for transfer, During transfer 1 : Communication complete Nothing is assigned. Meaningless in writing, "0" in reading. Rev.1.00 Reset Value 0016 0016 0016 page 217 of 290 R W PS2 Interface M16C/6K9 Group ● PS2 mode register • Sampling clock selection bits (SCK0,1) These two bits select clock frequency for sampling PS2 clock (CLK) and PS2 data (DAT). The relation between main clock (XIN) and sampling cycle is shown in table below. 8MHz Setting value 1/4 0.5µ 1/8 1.0µ 1/16 2.0µ 1/32 4.0µ 5MHz 0.8µ 1.6µ 3.2µ 6.4µ XIN ✽Sampling clock , which samples each line periodically, is used for avoiding the reflection from each line. The sampling clock will be delayed by internal circuit around 1 cycle. Thus, set the samplingclock as fast as possible. • Pin selection bit (PSEL) This bit is for selecting PS2 clock (CLK) or PS2 data (DAT) to connect to PS2Bi (i=0 to 2) .PS2Bi are external interrupt input pins. The bit setting definition is shown in table below. Pin selection bit “0” “1” PS2Bi (i= 0 to 2) PS2 clock (CLK) PS2 data (DAT) • PS2 interface enable bit (PSEN) The PS2Ai (i= 0 to 2) and PS2Bi (i= 0 to 2) will be disconnected to hardware PS2 control section and become GPIO port when the bit is “0”. The PS2Ai and PS2Bi will be connected to hardware PS2 control section when this bit is “1”. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 218 of 290 PS2 Interface M16C/6K9 Group PS2 mode register AAA b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol PS2MOD Bit Symbol SCK0 Address 02AC16 Bit name Sampling clock selection bits SCK1 PSEL Pin selection bit Reset Value 0016 Function 00 : Main clock /4 01 : Main clock /8 10 : Main clock /16 11 : Main clock /32 0 : PS2B connects to PS2 clock(CLK) 1 : PS2B connects to PS2 data(DAT) Nothing is assigned. Meaningless in writing, "0" in reading. PSEN0 Jun 06, 2003 0 : P70,P73 as GPIO 1 : P70,P73 as PS2A0,PS2B0 PSEN1 0 : P71,P74 as GPIO 1 : P71,P74 as PS2A1,PS2B1 PSEN2 0 : P72,P75 as GPIO 1 : P72,P75 as PS2A2,PS2B2 Reserved bit Must be set to "0". Fig.GK-8 PS2 mode register Rev.1.00 PS2 interface enable bits page 219 of 290 R W M16C/6K9 Group PS2 Interface (2) Operation description ● Basic setting The following items should be set for PS2 mode register (address 02AC16) set when PS2 interface is used. • PS2 interface enable bit Set the PS2 interface enable bits (bit4 to 6 of PS2 mode register) to “1” to enable the PS2 channels to be used. At this time PS2 clock goes “Low” (Receiving disable). • Sampling clock selection bit Sampling clock cycle (1/4,1/8,1/16,1/32 of main clock) is selected by setting sampling clock bit (bits 0,1). • External interrupt function support pin (PS2B) selection This bit is used to select PS2 clock (CLK) or PS2 data (DAT) for the external interrupt function support pin (PS2B). Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 220 of 290 PS2 Interface M16C/6K9 Group ● Reception operation Fig.GK-9 shows the reception operation timing. 1 DAT 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 start D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 3 4 5 parity stop CLK (Device side CLK) (Controller side CLK) Reception enable bit Data receiving flag Reception abort incognizable flag Transfer completion flag Interrupt request Fig.GK-9 Reception operation timing (1) Reception enable The reception operation is enabled by writing 0116 (reception enable bit = “1”) to PS2i control register (address : 02A216, 02A616, 02AA16). The PS2 clock (CLK) will become “H”. (2) Reception start The reception operation starts when both PS2 clock (CLK) and PS2 data (DAT) are detected with “L”. (3) Data reception (The reception of data and parity bits) The content PS2 data (DAT) is read into PS2i shift register (address : 02A016, 02A416, 02A816) sequentially by the falling edge of PS2 clock (CLK). The data transfer sequence is data bit (D0 -D7) then parity bit. (4) Reception completion (Stop bit Reception completion) By detecting the falling edge of PS2 clock (CLK), the transfer completion flag (bit 0 of PS2i status register) is set to “1” after the update of error flag (bit 4 - 6 of PS2i status register) and the reception enable bit (bit 0 of PS2i control register) is cleared to “0”. The PS2 clock (CLK) becomes “L” (reception disable status) and interrupt request occurs. (5) Data read out Read out data from PS2i shift register (address : 02A016,02A416,02A816). At this time , the error flags (Bit4 to 6) of and transfer completion flag (bit 0) of PS2i status register (address: 02A116, 02A516, 02A916) will be cleared to “0”. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 221 of 290 PS2 Interface M16C/6K9 Group ● Transmission operation Fig.GK-10 shows the transmission operation timing. 1 DAT 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 start D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 parity stop start D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 parity stop 4 5 6 ack (Device side DAT) (Controller side DAT) CLK (Device side CLK) (Controller side CLK) Transmission enable flag Transfer completion flag Interrupt request Fig.GK-10 Transmission operation timing (1) Data writing Write transmission data to PS2i shift register (address : 02A016, 02A416, 02A816). At this time,PS2 data will become “L” (transmission start). (2) Transmission enable Set 0216 (Transmission enable bit = “1”) to PS2i control register (address : 02A216, 02A616, 02AA16) for enabling transmission operation. At this time , PS2 clock (CLK) will become “H”. (3) Data transmission (The transmission of data, parity and stop bits) The content of PS2i shift register (address : 02A016, 02A416, 02A816) will be output to the PS2 data (DAT) sequentially by the falling edge of PS2 clock (CLK). The sequence of data transfer is data bits (D0 to D7) , Parity bit, and stop bit. (4) Acknowledge reception The content of acknowledge bit will be read by the falling edge of PS2 clock (CLK). (5) Communication completion The communication opeartion is completed by detecting “H” on both PS2 clock (CLK) and PS2 data (DAT). After the update of error flag (bit 4 - 6 of PS2i status register), the transfer completion flag (bit 0 of PS2i status register) is set to “1” and the reception enable bit (bit 0 of PS2i control register) is cleared to “0”. At this time, PS2 clock (CLK) becomes “L” (reception disable status) and the interrupt request occurs. (6) Status clear Read out the data from PS2i shift register (address : 02A016, 02A416, 02A816). At this time , the error flags (bits 4 to 6) and transfer completion flag (Bit0) of PS2i status register (address : 02A116, 02A516, 02A916) will be cleared to “0”. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 222 of 290 PS2 Interface M16C/6K9 Group ● Transfer abort operation Fig.GK-11 shows the transfer abort operation timing. 1 DAT 2 3 3 3 3 start D0 D1 D2 D3 4 5 6 D4 CLK (Device side CLK) (Controller side CLK) Transfer abort request bit Reception abort incognizable flag Transfer abort completion flag Transfer completion flag Interrupt request Fig.GK-11 Transfer abort operation timing ( reception) (1) - (3) Data reception operation (4) Transfer abort request Set 0416 (transfer abort request bit = “1”) to PS2i control register (address : 02A216, 02A616,02AA16). (5) Transfer abort completion The transfer abort completion flag (bit 6) and transfer completion flag (bit 0) of PS2i status register (address : 02A116, 02A516, 02A916) are set to “1”, transfer abort request bit (bit 2) of PS2i control register (address : 02A216, 02A616, 02AA16) is cleared to “0”. At this time, PS2 clock (CLK) becomes “L” (reception disable status) and interrupt request occurs. (6) Status clear By a pseudo read of PS2i shift register (address : 02A016, 02A416, 02A816), the transfer abort completion flag (bit 6) and transfer completion flag (bit 0) of PS2i status register (address : 02A116, 02A516, 02A916) are cleared to “0”. Note: Do not execute the following transmission/reception during the period between the “L” output from PS2 clock (CLK) and the transfer abort request recognition of the device. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 223 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Port Programmable I/O Ports There are 129 programmable I/O ports: P0 to P16 (excluding P85). Each port can be set independently for input or output using the direction register. Pull-up resistances can be set in 4-port unit. (except for P10 and P14). The N channel open drain ports P60 to P63, P70 to P77, P80 to P84, P130 to P137 and P85 (input only port) do not build internal pull-up resistance. Fig.UA-1 to UA-6 show the configurations of programmable I/O ports. Each pin functions as a programmable I/O port and as the I/O for the built-in peripheral devices. To use the pins as the inputs for the built-in peripheral devices, set the direction register of each pin to input mode. When the pins are used as the outputs for the built-in peripheral devices (other than the D-A converter), they function as outputs regardless of the contents of the direction registers. When pins are used as the outputs for the D-A converter, do not set the direction registers to output mode. See the descriptions of the respective functions for how to set up the built-in peripheral devices. (1) Direction registers Fig.UA-7 shows the configurations of direction registers. These registers are used to choose the direction of the programmable I/O ports. Each bit in these registers corresponds one for one to each I/O pin. Note: There is no direction register bit for P85. (2) Port registers Fig.UA-8 shows the configurations of port registers. These registers are used to write and read data for input and output to and from exterior. A port register consists of a port latch to hold output data and a circuit to read the status of a pin. Each bit in port registers corresponds one for one to each I/O pin. (3) Pull-up control registers Fig.UA-9 and UA-10, UA-11 shows the configurations of pull-up control registers. The pull-up control register can be set to apply a pull-up resistance to each block of 4 ports (except for P10 and P14). When ports are set to have a pull-up resistance, the pull-up resistance is connected only when the direction register is set for input. Pull-up resistance can be set to each pin of P10 and P14. (4) Port control register Fig.UA-12 shows the configurations of port control register 0, 1. Fig.UA-13 shows the configuraitons of port control register 2, 3. The bit 0 of port control register 0 is used to read port P1 as follows: 0 : When port P1 is input port, port input level is read. When port P1 is output port , the contents of port P1 register is read. 1 : The contents of port P1 register is read always. (neither input port nor output port) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 224 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Port The P0, P1, P40 to P46, P11 and P14 output type, CMOS or N channel open drain, are set by bit 0 to 6 of port control register 1 and bit 0 to 2 of port control register 3. 0 : CMOS output 1 : N channel open drain output Exception: P42 output type is N channel open drain if either bit 4 of port control register 1 or bit 2 of port control register 3 is set to “1”. Bit 7 of port control register1 functions as below 0 : P40/P43 output is cleared by software only 1 : P40/P43 output is cleared by software or when output buffer 0 is read by host side. The driving ability of N channel output transistors for P140 to P143 can be selected by bit 6 of port control register 2 controls as below: 0 : Driving ability of N channel open drain output transistor is LOW 1 : Driving ability of N channel open drain output transistor is HIGH (5) Port P4/P7 input register Fig.UA-14 shows the configurations of P4 and P7 input register. By reading the registers, the input level of the corresponding pins can be known regardless the input/output mode.These two registers can be read regardless port direction setting. And the ports level will be read out. Port4 : Bit 0 to bit6's level will be read out. And bit7 is always “0”. Port7 : Bit 0 to bit5's level will be read out. And bit6,7 is always “0”. (6) Port function selection register 0,1,2 Fig.UA-15, UA-16 shows the configurations of port function selection register 0,1,2. The port functions of ________ UART0 to UART2 input/output, TimerA0 to TimerA2 output, TimerB3,B4 input or external interrupt INT6 to __________ INT12 input can be switched by setting these two registers. By setting bit0,1 of port function selection register 2, the same frequency clock with f(XIN) can be output from P110 and P111. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 225 of 290 Port M16C/6K9 Group Pull-up selection Direction register P00 to P07 P110 to P117 Output formality selection bit Data bus Port latch (Note) Pull-up selection Direction register P12, P16 P140 to P147 Output formality selection bit Data bus Port latch (Note) Input respective peripheral function Pull-up selection Direction register P13, P43 to P46 "1" Output formality selection bit Data bus Output Port latch (Note) Pull-up selection Direction register P10, P11, P14, P15, P17 P40 to P42 "1" Output formality selection bit Data bus Output Port latch (Note) Input respective peripheral function (Note) Fig.UA-1 Programmable I/O ports (1) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 226 of 290 symbolizes a parasitic diode. Do not apply a voltage higher than Vcc each port. M16C/6K9 Group Port Pull-up selection Direction register P126, P127 P153 to P157 Data bus Port latch (Note) Pull-up selection Direction register P21, P24 to P27, P50 to P57 P91, P97 P120 to P125 P160, P161 Data bus Port latch (Note) Input to respective peripheral function Pull-up selection Direction register P47 "1" Output Data bus Port latch (Note) Pull-up selection P20, P22, P23, P30 to P37 P150 to P152, P64 to P67, P90, P92 Direction register "1" Output Data bus Port latch (Note) Input to respective peripheral function Note. Fig.UA-2 Programmable I/O ports (2) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 227 of 290 symbolizes a parasitic diode. Do not apply a voltage higher than Vcc to each port. M16C/6K9 Group Port Direction register P130 to P137 Data bus Port latch (Note) Direction register P76 to P77, P80 to P84 Data bus Port latch (Note) Input to respective peripheral function Direction register P60 to P63, P70 to P75 "1" Output Data bus Port latch (Note) Input to respective peripheral function Note. Fig.UA-3 Programmable I/O ports (3) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 228 of 290 symbolizes a parasitic diode. M16C/6K9 Group Port Pull-up selection Direction register P100, P101 (Excepting the short dashes line section) P102 to P107 (Including the short dashes line section) Data bus Port latch (Note) Analog input Input to respective peripheral function P102 to P107 only Pull-up selection DA output enable Direction register P93, P94 "1" Output Data bus Port latch (Note) Input to respective peripheral function Analog output DA output enable Pull-up selection Direction register P95 "1" Output Data bus Port latch (Note) Input to respective peripheral function Analog input Pull-up selection Direction register P96 "1" Output Data bus Port latch (Note) Analog input Note Fig.UA-4 Programmable I/O ports (4) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 229 of 290 symbolizes a parasitic diode. Do not apply a voltage higher than Vcc to each port. Port M16C/6K9 Group Pull-up selection Direction register P87 Data bus Port latch (Note) fc Input to respective peripheral function Rf Pull-up selection Rd Direction register P86 "1" Output Data bus Port latch (Note) Note symbolizes a parasitic diode. Do not apply a voltage higher than Vcc to each port. Fig.UA-5 Programmable I/O ports (5) M1 M1 signal input (Note1) M0 M0 signal input (Note1) RESET RESET signal input (Note1) Note1. Fig.UA-6 I/O pins Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 230 of 290 symbolizes a parasitic diode. Do not apply a voltage higher than Vcc to each pin. Port M16C/6K9 Group Port Pi direction register b 7 b6 b 5 b 4 b3 b 2 b 1 Symbol PDi(i=0-15, except 8) b0 Bit symbol Address 03E216,03E316,03E616,03E716,03EA16 03EB16,03EE16,03EF16,03F316,03F616 02E216,02E316,02E616,02E716,02EA16 Bit name PDi_0 Port Pi0 direction register PDi_1 Port Pi1 direction register PDi_2 Port Pi2 direction register PDi_3 Port Pi3 direction register PDi_4 Port Pi4 direction register PDi_5 Port Pi5 direction register PDi_6 Port Pi6 direction register PDi_7 Port Pi7 direction register Function When reset 0016 RW 0 : Input mode (Function as an input port) 1 : Output mode (Function as an output port) (i=0-15, except 8) Port P8 direction register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol PD8 b0 Bit symbol Address 03F216 Bit name PD8_0 Port P80 direction register PD8_1 Port P81 direction register PD8_2 Port P82 direction register PD8_3 Port P83 direction register PD8_4 Port P84 direction register When reset 00X000002 Function RW 0 : Input mode (Function as an input port) 1 : Output mode (Function as an output port) Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to this bit, write "0". The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate. PD8_6 Port P86 direction register PD8_7 Port P87 direction register 0 : Input mode (Function as an input port) 1 : Output mode (Function as an output port) Port P16 direction register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Symbol PD16 b0 Bit symbol Address 02EB16 Bit name PD16_0 Port P160 direction register PD16_1 Port P161 direction register When reset XXXXXX002 Function 0 : Input mode (Function as an input port) 1 : Output mode (Function as an output port) Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to this bit, write "0". The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate. Fig.UA-7 Direction register Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 231 of 290 RW Port M16C/6K9 Group Port Pi register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Pi(i=0 to15, except 8) Bit symbol Address 03E016,03E116,03E416,03E516,03E816 03E916,03EC16,03ED16,03F116,03F416 02E016,02E116,02E416,02E516,02E816 Pi_0 Port Pi0 register Port Pi1 register Pi_2 Port Pi2 register Pi_3 Port Pi3 register Pi_4 Port Pi4 register Pi_5 Port Pi5 register Pi_6 Port Pi6 register Pi_7 Port Pi7 register RW Function Bit name Pi_1 When reset Indeterminate Data is input and output to and from each pin by reading and writing to and from each corresponding bit 0 : "L" level data 1 : "H" level data (i=0-15, except 8) Port P8 register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol P8 Bit symbol Address 03F016 Bit name P8_0 Port P80 register P8_1 Port P81 register P8_2 Port P82 register P8_3 Port P83 register P8_4 Port P84 register P8_5 Port P85 register P8_6 Port P86 register P8_7 Port P87 register When reset Indeterminate RW Function Data is input and output to and from each pin by reading and writing to and from each corresponding bit (except for P85) 0 : "L" level data 1 : "H" level data Port P16 register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol P16 Bit symbol Address 02E916 Bit name PD16_0 Port P160 register PD16_1 Port P161register When reset Indeterminate Function Data is input and output to and from each pin by reading and writing to and from each corresponding bit 0 : "L" level data 1 : "H" level data Nothing is assigned. In an attempt to write to this bit, write "0". The value, if read, turns out to be indeterminate. Fig.UA-8 Port register Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 232 of 290 RW Port M16C/6K9 Group Pull-up control register 0 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol PUR0 Bit symbol Address 03FC16 When reset 0016 Bit name PU00 P00 to P03 pull-up PU01 P04 to P07 pull-up PU02 P10 to P13 pull-up PU03 P14 to P17 pull-up PU04 P20 to P23 pull-up PU05 P24 to P27 pull-up PU06 P30 to P33 pull-up PU07 P34 to P37 pull-up Function R W The corresponding port is pulled high with a pull-up resistor 0: Not pulled high 1: Pulled high Pull-up control register 1 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol PUR1 Bit symbol Address 03FD16 When reset 0016 Bit name Function PU10 P40 to P43 pull-up PU11 P44 to P47 pull-up PU12 P50 to P53 pull-up PU13 P54 to P57 pull-up R W The corresponding port is pulled high with a pull-up resistor 0: Not pulled high 1: Pulled high Nothing is assigned. (Note) Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”. PU15 P64 to P67 pull-up Nothing is assigned. (Note) Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”. Note.Since P60 to P63 and P70 to P77 are N-channel open drain ports, internal pull-up is not available for them. Pull-up control register 2 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol PUR2 Bit symbol Address 03FE16 When reset 0016 Bit name Function R W Nothing is assigned. (Note) Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”. PU21 P86, P87 pull-up(Note) PU22 P90 to P93 pull-up PU23 P94 to P97 pull-up The corresponding port is pulled high with a pull-up resistor 0: Not pulled high 1: Pulled high Nothing is assigned. Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”. Note.Since P80 to P84 are N-channel open drain ports, internal pull-up is not available for them. And P85 is input port only , also no internal pull-up is available. Fig.UA-9 Pull-up control register(1) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 233 of 290 Port M16C/6K9 Group Pull-up control register 3 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol PUR3 Bit symbol Address 02FC16 When reset 0016 Bit name Function PU30 P110 to P113 pull-up PU31 P114 to P117 pull-up PU32 P120 to P123 pull-up PU33 P124 to P127 pull-up R W The corresponding port is pulled high with a pull-up resistor 0 : Not pulled high 1 : Pulled high Nothing is assigned. Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”. Pull-up control register 4 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol PUR4 Bit symbol Address 02FD16 When reset 0016 Bit name Function PU40 P150 to P153 pull-up PU41 P154 to P157 pull-up PU42 P160, P161 pull-up The corresponding port is pulled high with a pull-up resistor 0 : Not pulled high 1 : Pulled high Nothing is assigned. Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”. Fig.UA-10 Pull-up control register(2) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 234 of 290 R W Port M16C/6K9 Group Pull-up control register 5 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol PUR5 Bit symbol Address 02F216 When reset 0016 Bit name Function PU50 P100 pull-up PU51 P101 pull-up PU52 P102 pull-up PU53 P103 pull-up PU54 P104 pull-up PU55 P105 pull-up PU56 P106 pull-up PU57 P107 pull-up R W The corresponding port is pulled high with a pull-up resistor 0 : Not pulled high 1 : Pulled high Pull-up control register 6 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol PUR6 Bit symbol Jun 06, 2003 When reset 0016 Bit name Function PU60 P140 pull-up PU61 P141 pull-up PU62 P142 pull-up PU63 P143 pull-up PU64 P144 pull-up PU65 P145 pull-up PU66 P146 pull-up PU67 P147 pull-up Fig.UA-11 Pull-up control register(3) Rev.1.00 Address 02F316 page 235 of 290 The corresponding port is pulled high with a pull-up resistor 0 : Not pulled high 1 : Pulled high R W Port M16C/6K9 Group Port control register 0 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol PCR0 Bit Symbol PCR00 Address 03FF16 When reset 0016 Bit name Port P1 control register RW Function 0 : When input port, read port input level. When output port, read the contents of port P1 register 1 : Read the contents of port P1 register though input/output port. Nothing is assigned. Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”. Port control register 1 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol PCR1 Bit Symbol Jun 06, 2003 Bit name When reset 0016 Function PCR10 Output type selection bit (P00 to P03) 0 : CMOS 1 : N-channel open drain PCR11 Output type selection bit (P04 to P07) 0 : CMOS 1 : N-channel open drain PCR12 Output type selection bit (P10 to P13) 0 : CMOS 1 : N-channel open drain PCR13 Output type selection bit (P14 to P17) 0 : CMOS 1 : N-channel open drain PCR14 Output type selection bit (P40 to P46) 0 : CMOS 1 : N-channel open drain PCR15 Output type selection bit (P110 to P113) 0 : CMOS 1 : N-channel open drain PCR16 Output type selection bit (P114 to P117) 0 : CMOS 1 : N-channel open drain PCR17 P40,P43 output clear function selection bit 0 : Cleared by software only 1 : Cleared by software or when output buffer is read by host side. Fig.UA-12 Port control register 0, 1 Rev.1.00 Address 02FE16 page 236 of 290 R W Port M16C/6K9 Group Port control register 2 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Symbol PCR2 Address 02FF16 Bit symbol Bit name When reset 0016 Function Reserved bit Must be set to "0" Reserved bit Must be set to "0" Reserved bit Must be set to "0" Reserved bit Must be set to "0" Reserved bit Must be set to "0" Reserved bit Must be set to "0" PCR26 Drive polarity selection bit (P140 to P143) R W 0 : Low side 1 : High side Nothing is assigned. Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”. Port control register 3 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol PCR3 Bit symbol Address 02F716 When reset 0016 Bit name Function PCR30 Output type selection bit (P140 to P143) 0 : CMOS 1 : N-channel open drain PCR31 Output type selection bit (P144 to P147) 0 : CMOS 1 : N-channel open drain PCR32 Output type selection bit (P42) 0 : CMOS 1 : N-channel open drain Nothing is assigned. Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”. Fig.UA-13 Port control register 2, 3 Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 237 of 290 R W Port M16C/6K9 Group Port P4 input register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol P4PIN Bit Symbol Address 02FA16 When reset 0XXXXXXX2 Bit name Function P4PIN_0 Port P40 input register For reading P40 pin level P4PIN_1 Port P41 input register For reading P41 pin level P4PIN_2 Port P42 input register For reading P42 pin level P4PIN_3 Port P43 input register For reading P43 pin level P4PIN_4 Port P44 input register For reading P44 pin level P4PIN_5 Port P45 input register For reading P45 pin level P4PIN_6 Port P46 input register For reading P46 pin level R W Nothing is assigned. Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”. Port P7 input register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol P7PIN Bit Symbol Address 02FB16 When reset 00XXXXXX2 Bit name Function P7PIN_0 Port P70 input register For reading P70 pin level P7PIN_1 Port P71 input register For reading P71 pin level P7PIN_2 Port P72 input register For reading P72 pin level P7PIN_3 Port P73 input register For reading P73 pin level P7PIN_4 Port P74 input register For reading P74 pin level P7PIN_5 Port P75 input register For reading P75 pin level Nothing is assigned. Can't write to this bit. The value, if read, turns out to be “0”. Fig.UA-14 Port P4,P7 input register Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 238 of 290 R W Port M16C/6K9 Group Port function selection register 0 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol PSL0 Address 02F816 When reset 0016 Function Bit name Bit Symbol PSL00 UART0 I/O pin selection bit 0 : P60 to P63 1 : P10 to P13 PSL01 UART1 I/O pin selection bit 0 : P64 to P67 1 : P14 to P17 PSL02 UART2 I/O pin selection bit 0 : P70 to P73 1 : P20 to P23 PSL03 INT7 input pin selection bit 0 : P103 1 : P14 PSL04 INT8 I/O pin selection bit 0 : P104 1 : P15 PSL05 INT9 I/O pin selection bit 0 : P105 1 : P16 PSL06 INT10 I/O pin selection bit 0 : P106 1 : P17 PSL07 (Note) P110 output clock selection bit 0 : f(XIN) 1 : fC R W Note. Enabled only if bit 0 of port function selection register 2 is set to "1". If fc is selected, the phase of output clock is reversed to XCIN. Port function selection register 1 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol PSL1 Address 02F916 Bit Symbol When reset 0016 Function Bit name PSL10 TA0 output pin selection bit 0 : P40 1 : P150 PSL11 TA1 output pin selection bit 0 : P41 1 : P151 PSL12 TA2 output pin selection bit 0 : P42 1 : P152 PSL13 TB3 output pin selection bit 0 : P93 1 : P160 PSL14 TB4 output pin selection bit 0 : P94 1 : P161 PSL15 (Note) INT6-INT11 input pin switching bit 0 : P97, P103 to P107 1 : P120, P121 to P125 R W Nothing is assigned. Meaningless in writing, "0" in reading. Note. If this is set to "1" then port function selection register 1 (address 02F816) bit 3 to bit6 setting will be ignored. Fig.UA-15 Port function selection register 0,1 Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 239 of 290 Port M16C/6K9 Group Port function selection register 2 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol PSL2 Address 02F116 Bit Symbol Bit name P110 : f1 output function selection bit 0 : P110 as GPIO 1 : P110 as f1 output PSL21 P111 : f1 output function selection bit 0 : P111 as GPIO 1 : P111 as f1 output PSL22 S I/O3 I/O pin selection bit 0 : P90 to P92 1 : P150 to P152 PSL23 S I/O4 I/O pin selection bit 0 : P95 to P97 1 : P155 to P157 Fig.UA-16 Port function selection register 2 Jun 06, 2003 Function PSL20 Nothing is assigned. Meaningless in writing, "0" in reading. Rev.1.00 When reset 0016 page 240 of 290 R W M16C/6K9 Group Port Table.UA-1 Example connection of unused pins in single-chip mode Pin name Connection Ports P0 to P10 (excluding P85) After setting for input mode, connect every pin to VSS or VCC via a resistor; or after setting for output mode, leave these pins open. Ports P11 to P16 After setting for input mode, connect every pin to VSS or VCC via a resistor; or after setting for output mode, leave these pins open. XOUT (Note) Open NMI Connect via resistor to VCC (pull-up) FVCC Apply 0V to 3.6V AVCC Connect to VCC AVSS, VREF, M1 Connect to VSS Note: With external clock input to XIN pin. Microcomputer Port P0 to P16 (input mode) (except for P85) (input mode) (output mode) open NMI XOUT open VCC AVCC 0.47 mF M1 AVSS VREF M0 VSS In single-chip mode Fig.UA-17 Example connection of unused pins Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 241 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Usage precaution Usage Precaution Timer A (timer mode) (1) Reading the timer Ai register while a count is in progress allows reading, with arbitrary timing, the value of the counter. But, reading the timer Ai register with the reload timing gets “FFFF16”. Reading the timer Ai register after setting a value in the timer Ai register with a count halted but before the counter starts counting gets a setting value to the timer. Timer A (event counter mode) (1) Reading the timer Ai register while a count is in progress allows reading, with arbitrary timing, the value of the counter. But, reading the timer Ai register with the reload timing gets “FFFF16” by underflow or “000016” by overflow. Reading the timer Ai register after setting a value in the timer Ai register with a count halted but before the counter starts counting gets a setting value to the timer. (2) When stop counting in free run type, set timer again. Timer A (one-shot timer mode) (1) Setting the count start flag to “0” while a count is in progress causes as follows: • The counter stops counting and a content of reload register is reloaded. • The TAiOUT pin outputs “L” level. • The interrupt request generated and the timer Ai interrupt request bit goes to “1”. (2) The timer Ai interrupt request bit goes to “1” if the timer's operation mode is set using any of the following procedures: • Selecting one-shot timer mode after reset. • Changing operation mode from timer mode to one-shot timer mode. • Changing operation mode from event counter mode to one-shot timer mode. Therefore, to use timer Ai interrupt (interrupt request bit), set timer Ai interrupt request bit to “0” after the above listed changes have been made. Timer A (pulse width modulation mode) (1) The timer Ai interrupt request bit becomes “1” if setting operation mode of the timer in compliance with any of the following procedures: • Selecting PWM mode after reset. • Changing operation mode from timer mode to PWM mode. • Changing operation mode from event counter mode to PWM mode. Therefore, to use timer Ai interrupt (interrupt request bit), set timer Ai interrupt request bit to “0” after the above listed changes have been made. (2) Setting the count start flag to “0” while PWM pulses are being output causes the counter to stop counting. If the TAiOUT pin is outputting an “H” level in this instance, the output level goes to “L”, and the timer Ai interrupt request bit goes to “1”. If the TAiOUT pin is outputting an “L” level in this instance, the level does not change, and the timer Ai interrupt request bit does not becomes “1”. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 242 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Usage precaution Timer B (timer mode, event counter mode) (1) Reading the timer Bi register while a count is in progress allows reading , with arbitrary timing, the value of the counter. But, reading the timer Bi register with the reload timing gets “FFFF16”. Reading the timer Bi register after setting a value in the timer Bi register with a count halted but before the counter starts counting gets a setting value to the timer. Timer B (pulse period/pulse width measurement mode) (1) If changing the measurement mode select bit is set after a count is started, the timer Bi interrupt request bit goes to “1”. (2) When the first effective edge is input after a count is started, an indeterminate value is transferred to the reload register. At this time, timer Bi interrupt request is not generated. A-D Converter (1) Write to each bit (except bit 6) of A-D control register 0, to each bit of A-D control register 1, and to bit 0 of A-D control register 2 when A-D conversion is stopped (before a trigger occurs). In particular, when the Vref connection bit is changed from “0” to “1”, start A-D conversion after an elapse of 1 µs or longer. (2) When changing A-D operation mode, select analog input pin again. (3) Using one-shot mode or single sweep mode Read the correspondence A-D register after confirming A-D conversion is finished. (It is known by A-D conversion interrupt request bit.) (4) Using repeat mode, repeat sweep mode 0 or repeat sweep mode 1 Use the undivided main clock as the internal CPU clock. Stop Mode and Wait Mode ____________ (1) When returning from stop mode by hardware reset, RESET pin must be set to “L” level until main clock oscillation is stabilized. (2) When switching to either wait mode or stop mode, instructions occupying four bytes either from the WAIT instruction or from the instruction that sets the every-clock stop bit to “1” within the instruction queue are prefetched and then the program stops. So put at least four NOPs in succession either to the WAIT instruction or to the instruction that sets the every-clock stop bit to “1”. Interrupts (1) Reading address 0000016 • When maskable interrupt is occurred, CPU read the interrupt information (the interrupt number and interrupt request level) in the interrupt sequence. The interrupt request bit of the certain interrupt written in address 0000016 will then be set to “0”. Reading address 0000016 by software sets enabled highest priority interrupt source request bit to “0”. Though the interrupt is generated, the interrupt routine may not be executed. Do not read address 0000016 by software. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 243 of 290 Usage precaution M16C/6K9 Group (2) Setting the stack pointer • The value of the stack pointer immediately after reset is initialized to 000016. Accepting an interrupt before setting a value in the stack pointer may become a factor of runaway. Be sure to set a value in the stack pointer before accepting an interrupt. _______ When using the NMI interrupt, initialize the stack point at the beginning of a program. Concerning the first _______ instruction immediately after reset, generating any interrupts including the NMI interrupt is prohibited. _______ (3) The NMI interrupt _______ • As for the NMI interrupt pin, an interrupt cannot be disabled. Connect it to the VCC pin via a resistor (pull-up) if unused. Be sure to work on it. _______ • Do not get either into stop mode with the NMI pin set to “L”. (4) External interrupt _______ _________ • When the polarity of the INT0 to INT11 pins is changed, the interrupt request bit is sometimes set to "1". After changing the polarity, set the interrupt request bit to "0". (5) Rewrite the interrupt control register • To rewrite the interrupt control register, do so at a point that does not generate the interrupt request for that register. If there is possibility of the interrupt request occur, rewrite the interrupt control register after the interrupt is disabled. The program examples are described as follow: Example 1: INT_SWITCH1: FCLR I AND.B #00h, 0055h NOP NOP FSET I ; Disable interrupts. ; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit. ; Four NOP instructions are required when using HOLD function. ; Enable interrupts. Example 2: INT_SWITCH2: FCLR I AND.B #00h, 0055h MOV.W MEM, R0 FSET I ; Disable interrupts. ; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit. ; Dummy read. ; Enable interrupts. Example 3: INT_SWITCH3: PUSHC FLG FCLR I AND.B #00h, 0055h POPC FLG ; Push Flag register onto stack ; Disable interrupts. ; Clear TA0IC int. priority level and int. request bit. ; Enable interrupts. The reason why two NOP instructions (four when using the HOLD function) or dummy read are inserted before FSET I in Examples 1 and 2 is to prevent the interrupt enable flag I from being set before the interrupt control register is rewritten due to effects of the instruction queue. • When a instruction to rewrite the interrupt control register is executed but the interrupt is disabled, the interrupt request bit is not set sometimes even if the interrupt request for that register has been generated. This will depend on the instruction. If this creates problems, use the below instructions to change the register. Instructions : AND, OR, BCLR, BSET Noise (1) Insert the by-pass condencer to the Vcc-Vss line for preventing a noise and latch-up. Connect the by -pass condencer (about 0.1µF) between Vcc pin and Vss pin. It is distance must be shortest rather sicker line. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 244 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Usage precaution DMAC The write to DMAC bit of DMAiCON register (i= 0-1) If (a) conditions are matched, follow (b) as wirte procedure. (a) Conditions Write "1" to DMAE bit again when DMAE bit is "1" (DMAi active status). The possibility that the write to DMAE bit and DMA request occur at the same time. . (b) Write procedure (1) Write "1" to both DMAE bit and DMAS bit at the same time (Note 1). (2)Confirm with program that DMAi is at initial condition (Note 2). Note 1: The DMAS will be "0" if writing "0" to it. However, there is no change if writing "1" to the bit. Hence, if "1" is to be written to DMAE by writing DMAiCON register, setting the value of DMAS to "1", DMAS will remain the same status before the writing. If read modify write command is used to write to DMAE bit, setting the value of DMAS to "1", the DMA request will be retained during the execution of the command. Note 2: Comfirm it with TCRi register. If the value read from TCRi register becomes the same with that, which was written to TCRi register before the start of DMA transfer (the TCRi value will be 1 decremented after writing to DMAE bit), it is at initial condition. Otherwise, DMA is still under transfer. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 245 of 290 Electrical characteristics M16C/6K9 Group Electrical characteristics Table.ZA-1 Absolute maximum ratings Symbol Parameter Condition Rated value Unit Vcc Supply voltage VCC=AVCC -0.3 to 4.6 V AVcc Analog Supply voltage VCC=AVCC -0.3 to 4.6 V FVcc Supply voltage for program/erase -0.3 to 4.6 V Input voltage VI RESET,M0,M1,VREF,XIN, P00 to P07,P10 to P17,P20 to P27,P30 to P37, P40 to P47,P50 to P57,P64 to P67,P86,P87, P90 to P97,P100 to P107,P110 to P117, P120 to P127,P140 to P147,P150 to P157, P160,P161 -0.3 to Vcc+0.3 P60 to P63,P70 to P77,P80 to P84,P85, P130 to P137 output voltage VO P00 to P07,P10 to P17,P20 to P27,P30 to P37, P40 to P47,P50 to P57,P64 to P67,P86,P87, P90 to P97,P100 to P107,P110 to P117, P120 to P127,P140 to P147,P150 to P157, P160,P161,XOUT P60 to P63,P70 to P77,P80 to P84, P130 to P137 Pd Power dissipation Ta=25 C V -0.3 to 5.8 V -0.3 to Vcc+0.3 V -0.3 to 5.8 V 300 mW Topr Operating ambient temperature -20 to 85 C Tstg Storage temperature -40 to 125 C Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 246 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Electrical characteristics Table.ZA-2 Recommended operating conditions (referenced to Vcc=3.0V to 3.6V,Ta= -20 to 85oC) Parameter Symbol Vcc AVcc Supply voltage Analog Supply voltage FVcc Supply voltage for program/erase Vss Supply voltage Analog Supply voltage AVss Min. 3.0 "H" input voltage VIH During flash memory read Jun 06, 2003 V 3.6 V V V 0 V 0 V P00 to P07, P10 to P17,P20 to P27, P30 to P37,P40 to P47, P50 to P57, P64 to P67,P86,P87,P90 to P97, P100 to P107, P110 to P117, P120 to P127,P140 to P147, P150 to P157, P160,P161,XIN, RESET, M0,M1 0.8Vcc Vcc V P60 to P63, P70 to P77,P80 to P84,P85,P130 to P137, PSA0 to PSA2, PSB0 to PSB2 0.8Vcc 5.5 V 0.6Vcc Vcc V 0.7Vcc 1.4 5.5 5.5 V V P00 to P07, P10 to P17,P20 to P27, P30 to P37,P40 to P47, P50 to P57, P64 to P67,P86,P87,P90 to P97, P100 to P107, P110 to P117, P120 to P127,P140 to P147, P150 to P157, P160,P161,XIN, RESET, M0,M1 0 0.2Vcc V P60 to P63, P70 to P77,P80 to P84,P85,P130 to P137, PSA0 to PSA2, PSB0 to PSB2 0 0.2Vcc V LAD0 to LAD3,LFRAME,LCLK,SERIRQ,CLKRUN 0 0.2Vcc V 0 0 0.3Vcc V 0.6 V SDA0,SCL0,SDA1,SCL1,SDA2,SCL2 P60 to P63,P76,P77,P81 to P84 Rev.1.00 Unit Max. 3.6 3.6 3.0 LAD0 to LAD3,LFRAME,LCLK,SERIRQ,CLKRUN VIL 3.3 Vcc 0 During program/erase SDA0,SCL0,SDA1,SCL1,SDA2,SCL2 P60 to P63,P76,P77,P81 to P84 "L" input voltage Standard Typ. page 247 of 290 I2C-BUS input level selected SMBUS input level selected I2C-BUSes input level selected SMBUS input level selected M16C/6K9 Group Electrical characteristics Table.ZA-3 Recommended operating conditions (referenced to Vcc=3.0V to 3.6V,Ta= -20 to 85oC) Symbol Parameter Min. I OH (peak) "H"peak output current P00 to P07, P10 to P17,P20 to P27,P30 to P37,P40 to P47, P50 to P57,P64 to P67,P86 to P87,P90 to P97,P100 to P107, P110 to P117, P120 to P127,P140 to P147,P150 to P157, P160,P161 I OL (peak) "L"peak output current P00 to P07, P10 to P17,P30 to P37,P40 to P47, P50 to P57,P60 to P67,P76 to P77,P80 to P84, P86 to P87, P90 to P97,P100 to P107, P110 to P117,P120 to P127, P130 to P137,P144 to P147, P150 to P157,P160,P161 Standard Typ. P20 to P27 I OL (peak) I OH (avg) I OL (avg) I OL (avg) "L"peak output current P140 to P143 Driven ability:High Driven ability:Low "H" average output P00 to P07, P10 to P17,P20 to P27,P30 to P37, P40 to P47,P50 to P57,P60 to P67,P86 to P87,P90 to P97, current P100 to P107, P110 to P117, P120 to P127,P140 to P147, P150 to P157,P160,P161 P00 to P07, P10 to P17,P30 to P37, P40 to P47, P50 to P57,P60 to P67,P76 to P77,P80 to P84, P86 to P87, P90 to P97,P100 to P107,P110 to P117,P120 to P127, P130 to P137,P140 to P147,P150 to P157,P160,P161 P20 to P27 Driven ability:High "L"average output P140 to P143 Driven ability:Low current "L"average output current f (XIN) Main clock input oscillation frequency f (XcIN) Subclock oscillation frequency 0 32.768 Max. -10.0 mA 10.0 mA 20.0 20.0 10.0 mA mA mA -5.0 mA 5.0 mA 15.0 15.0 5.0 mA mA mA 16 MHz 50 Note1 : The average output current is the average value during the 100ms period limited current. Note2 : The value are as follow: The sum of IOL (peak) of P0,P1,P2,P86 to P87,P9,P10,P11,P120 to P126,P153 to P157 P16 should be under 80mA. The sum of IOH (peak) of P0,P1,P2,P86 to P87,P9,P10,P11,P120 to P126,P153 to P157 P16 should be under 80mA. The sum of IOL (peak) of P3,P4,P5,P6,P7,P80 to P84,P13,P14,P150 to P152 should be under 80mA. The sum of IOH (peak) of P3,P4,P5,P64 to P67,P14,P150 to P152 should be under 80mA. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 248 of 290 Unit kHz M16C/6K9 Group Electrical characteristics Table.ZA-4 Electrical characteristics (referenced to Vcc=3.0V, Vss=0V, Ta=25oC, f(XIN)=16MHz with 0 wait unless otherwise specified) Symbol Parameter VOH High output voltage R fXIN R fXCIN Feedback resistance P00 to P07, P10 to P17, P20 to P27, P30 to P37, P40 to P47, P50 to P57, P64 to P67, P86, P87, P90 to P97, P100 to P107, P110 to P117, P120 to P127, P140 to P147, P150 to P157, P160, P161 XOUT HIGH POWER LOWPOWER HIGHPOWER XCOUT LOWPOWER P00 to P07, P10 to P17, P30 to P37, P40 to P47,P50 to P57, P60 to P67, P70 to P77, P80 to P84, P86, P87, P90 to P97, P100 to P107, P110 to P117, P120 to P127, P130 to P137, P140 to P147, P150 to P157, P160, P161 P20 to P27 P140 to P143 HIGH POWER LOWPOWER XOUT HIGH POWER LOWPOWER HIGHPOWER XCOUT LOWPOWER _______ _________ TA0IN to TA4IN, TB0IN to TB5IN, INT0 to INT11, __________ ________ ________ ________ ADTRG, CTS0, CTS1, CTS2, CLK0, CLK1, CLK2, CLK3, CLK4, SIN3, SIN4, RXD0, RXD1, _______ ________ ________ RXD2, ICCK, NMI, KI00 to KI07 ____________ RESET P00 to P07, P10 to P17, P20 to P27, P30 to P37, P40 to P47, P50 to P57, P60 to P67, P70 to P77, P80 to P87, P90 to P97, P100 to P107, P120 to P127, P130 to P137, P140 to P147, ____________ P150 to P157, P160, P161, XIN, RESET, M0, M1 P00 to P07, P10 to P17, P20 to P27, P30 to P37, P40 to P47, P50 to P57, P60 to P67, P70 to P77, P80 to P87, P90 to P97, P100 to P107, P110 to P117, P120 to P127, P130 to P137, P140 to P147, P150 to P157, P160, P161, ____________ XIN, RESET, M0, M1 P00 to P07, P10 to P17, P20 to P27, P30 to P37, P40 to P47, P50 to P57, P64 to P67, P86, P87, P90 to P97, P100 to P107, P110 to P117, P120 to P127, P140 to P147, P150 to P157, P160, P161 XIN VOH High output voltage High output voltage Low output voltage Feedback resistance XCIN V RAM I CC RAM retention voltage VOL VOL VOL VT+VT- VT+VTIIH IIL R PULLUP Low output voltage Low output voltage Low output voltage Hysteresis Hysteresis HIGH input current Low input current Pull-up resistance Power supply current When reset, the output pins are opened , the other pins are connected to Vss. Note1 : Under the state that a timer is operating with fc32. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 249 of 290 Standard Measuring condition IOH=-1mA IOH= -0.1mA IOH= -50µA With no load applied With no load applied Min. 2.5 Typ. Unit Max. V 2.5 2.5 V V 3.0 1.6 IOL=1mA 0.5 V VCC=3V, IOL=3mA IOL=3mA IOL=1mA IOH=0.1mA IOH=50µA With no load applied With no load applied 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 V V V V 0 0 0.2 0.8 V 0.2 1.8 V VI=3V 4.0 µA VI=0V -4.0 µA 500.0 kΩ VI=0V 66.0 120.0 MΩ 3.0 10.0 When clock is stopped f(XIN)=16MHZ, Square wave without division f(XCIN)=32kHZ, Square wave When operation under RAM f(XCIN)=32kHZ, Square wave When operation under Flash memory f(XCIN)=32kHZ, With WAIT oscillation capacity High (Note1) f(XCIN)=32kHZ, With WAIT oscillation capacity Low (Note1) Ta=25°C When clock is stopped Ta=85°C When clock is stopped 2.0 16.0 24.0 MΩ V mA 35.0 µA 450.0 µA 4.5 µA 2.5 µA 100.0 µA 300.0 µA M16C/6K9 Group Electrical characteristics Table.ZA-5 DC characteristics (referenced to Vcc=3.0 to 3.6V, Ta=25oC unless otherwise specified) Standard (Typ.) Parameter Symbol Ipp Measuring condition FVcc=3.0 to 3.6V FVcc power current Program Erase 60mA 30mA Table.ZA-6 A-D conversion characteristics (referenced to Vcc=AVcc=VREF=3V,Vss=AVss=0V at Ta=25oC unless otherwise specified) Symbol Measuring condition Parameter Min. Standard Typ. Max. Unit 10 ±2 Bits LSB ±6 LSB VREF =VCC Resolution Absolute accuracy RLADDER Ladder resistance tCONV Conversion time VREF VIA Reference voltage 8 bit 10 bit VREF =VCC=3V, ØAD=fAD VREF =VCC 10 40 kW ms ms VCC VREF V 6.125 7.375 8 bit 10 bit 2.7 Analog input voltage 0 V Table.ZA-7 D-A conversion characteristics (referenced to Vcc=AVcc=VREF=3V,Vss=AVss=0V at Ta=25oC unless otherwise specified) Symbol Parameter Resolution Absolute accuracy Setup time Output resistance Reference power supply input current tsu RO IVREF Measuring condition (Note1) Standard Typ. Max. 8 1.0 3 4 20 10 1.0 Min. Unit Bits % ms kW mA Note1: This applies when using one D-A converter, with the D-A register for the unused D-A converter set to "0016". The A-D converter's ladder resistance is not included. When the content of D-A register is not "00", the IVREF will also be sent even if VREF is disconnected. Table.ZA-8 Comparator characteristics (referenced to Vcc=AVcc=VREF=3V to 3.6V,Vss=AVss=0V at Ta=25oC) Parameter Symbol Resolution Absolute accuracy TCONV Conversion time VIA IIA RLADDER Analog input voltage Analog input current Ladder resistance Rev.1.00 Measuring condition Jun 06, 2003 page 250 of 290 when f(XIN) = 16MHz when f(XIN) = 8MHz Standard Typ. Max. 4 1/2 1.75 3.5 VCC 0 5.0 50 20 40 Min. Unit Bits LSB ms ms V ms kW M16C/6K9 Group Electrical characteristics Timing requirements (referenced to Vcc=3V,Vss=0V at Ta=25oC unless otherwise specified) Table.ZA-9 External clock input Parameter Symbol tc tw(H) tw(L) tr tf Rev.1.00 External clock input cycle time External clock input HIGH pulse width External clock input LOW pulse width External clock rising time External clock falling time Jun 06, 2003 page 251 of 290 Standard Min. Max. Unit 62.5 ns 25 ns 25 ns ns ns 9 9 M16C/6K9 Group Electrical characteristics Timing requirements (referenced to Vcc=3V,Vss=0V at Ta=25oC unless otherwise specified) Table.ZA-10 Timer A input (The count input of event counter mode) Parameter Symbol tc(TA) TAiIN input cycle time tw(TAH) tw(TAL) Standard Min. Max. Unit ns TAiIN input "H" pulse width 150 60 TAiIN input "L" pulse width 60 ns ns Table.ZA-11 Timer A input (The gating input of timer mode) Parameter Symbol Standard Min. tc(TA) TAiIN input cycle time 600 tw(TAH) tw(TAL) TAiIN input "H" pulse width TAiIN input "L" pulse width 300 300 Max. Unit ns ns ns Table.ZA-12 Timer A input (The external trigger input of one shot timer mode) Parameter Symbol Standard Min. tc(TA) TAiIN input cycle time 300 tw(TAH) tw(TAL) TAiIN input "H" pulse width TAiIN input "L" pulse width 150 150 Max. Unit ns ns ns Table.ZA-13 Timer A input (The external trigger input of pulse width modulation mode) Parameter Symbol Standard tw(TAH) TAiIN input "H" pulse width Min. 150 tw(TAL) TAiIN input "L" pulse width 150 Max. Unit ns ns Table.ZA-14 Timer A input (The up down input of event counter mode) Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tc(UP) TAiOUT input cycle time 3000 ns tw(UPH) tw(UPL) TAiOUT input "H" pulse width TAiOUT input "L" pulse width 1500 ns ns tsu(UP-TIN) th(TIN-UP) TAiOUT input setup time Rev.1.00 TAiOUT input hold time Jun 06, 2003 page 252 of 290 1500 600 600 ns ns M16C/6K9 Group Electrical characteristics Timing requirements (referenced to Vcc=3V,Vss=0V at Ta=25oC unless otherwise specified) Table.ZA-15 Timer B input (The count input of event counter mode) Symbol Parameter tc(TB) TBiIN input cycle time (single edge count) tw(TBH) tw(TBL) TBiIN input "H" pulse width (single edge count) TBiIN input "L" pulse width (single edge count) Standard Min. Max. Unit 150 ns 60 60 ns ns tc(TB) TBiIN input cycle time (double edge count) 300 ns tw(TBH) TBiIN input "H" pulse width (double edge count) 160 ns tw(TBL) TBiIN input "L" pulse width (double edge count) 160 ns Table.ZA-16 Timer B input (Pulse period measurement mode) Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tc(TB) TBiIN input cycle time 600 ns tw(TBH) tw(TBL) TBiIN input "H" pulse width 300 300 ns TBiIN input "L" pulse width ns Table.ZA-17 Timer B input (Pulse width measurement mode) Parameter Symbol Standard Min. Max. Unit tc(TB) tw(TBH) TBiIN input cycle time TBiIN input "H" pulse width 600 300 ns ns tw(TBL) TBiIN input "L" pulse width 300 ns Table.ZA-18 A-D trigger input Parameter Symbol tc(AD) tw(ADL) ADTRG input cycle time (The Min. of trigger) ADTRG input "L" pulse width Standard Min. Max. Unit 1500 ns 200 ns Table.ZA-19 Serial I/O Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tc(CK) CLKi input cycle time 300 ns tw(CKH) tw(CKL) td(C-Q) CLKi input "H" pulse width 150 CLKi input "L" pulse width TxDi output delay time 150 ns ns ns th(C-Q) tsu(D-C) th(C-D) TxDi hold time RxDi input setup time RxDi input hold time 160 ns 0 50 90 ns ns ______ Table.ZA-20 External interrupt INTi input Symbol tw(INH) tw(INL) Rev.1.00 Parameter Standard Min. INTi input "H" pulse width 380 INTi input "L" pulse width 380 Jun 06, 2003 page 253 of 290 Max. Unit ns ns Electrical characteristics M16C/6K9 Group Timing requirements (referenced to Vcc = 3.0 to 3.6V, Vss = 0V, Ta =25 °C) Table. ZA-21 Multi-master I2C-BUS line Symbol Standard clock mode Min. Max. 4.7 4.0 Parameter tBUF Bus free time tHD;STA tLOW The hold time in start condition The hold time in SCL clock "0" status tR tHD;DAT SCL, SDA signals' rising time Data hold time tHIGH tF The hold time in SCL clock "1" status SCL, SDA signals' falling time tsu;DAT tsu;STA Data setup time The setup time in restart condition tsu;STO Stop condition setup time 4.7 1000 High-speed clock mode Min. Max. 1.3 0.6 1.3 20+0.1Cb µs µs µs 0 0.6 0.9 ns µs 300 µs ns 250 20+0.1Cb 100 4.7 4.0 0.6 0.6 0 4.0 300 300 Unit ns µs µs Table. ZA-22 PS2 interface (referenced to Vcc = 3.0 to 3.6V, Vss = 0V, Ta =25 °C) Standard Parameter Symbol Min. 30 30 twL twH PS2 clock "L" pulse width PS2 clock "H" pulse width tsu th PS2 data setup time PS2 data hold time 5 0 td tv PS2 data delay time PS2 data valid time 0 Typ. Unit Max. 50 50 µs µs µs ns twL-5 twL-5 µs µs Table. ZA-23 LPC bus interface/serial interrupt output Standard Parameter Symbol tC(CLK) tWH(CLK) tWL(CLK) LCLK clock input cycle time LCLK clock input "H" pulse width LCLK clock input "L" pulse width tsu(D-C) LAD3-LAD0,SERIRQ,CLKRUN,LFRAME Input setup time th(C-D) LAD3-LAD0,SERIRQ,CLKRUN , LFRAME input hold time tV(C-D) LAD3-LAD0,SERIRQ,CLKRUN , LFRAME valid delay time toff(A-F) LAD3-LAD0,SERIRQ,CLKRUN floating output delay time Min. 30 11 11 Typ. Max. ∞ Unit ns ns ns _______________ _______________ _______________ _______________ 7 ns 0 ns _______________ _______________ 2 11 ns 28 ns _______________ Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 254 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Timing P0 P1 P2 P3 P4 P5 P6 P7 P8 P9 P10 P11 P12 P13 P14 P15 P16 Fig.ZA-1 The measuring circuit for port 0 to port 16 Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 255 of 290 30pF Timing M16C/6K9 Group tc(TA) tw(TAH) TAiIN input tw(TAL) tc(UP) tw(UPH) TAiOUT input tw(UPL) TAiOUT input (Up down input) Inevent counter mode TAiIN input (when selecting the fulling edge count) th(TIN-UP) tsu(UP-TIN) TAiIN input (when selecting the rising edge count) tc(TB) tw(TBH) TBiIN input tw(TBL) tc(AD) tw(ADL) ADTRG input tc(CK) tw(CKH) CLKi tw(CKL) th(C-Q) TxDi td(C-Q) tsu(D-C) RxDi tw(INL) INTi input tw(INH) Fig.ZA-2 Timing diagram (1) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 256 of 290 th(C-D) Timing M16C/6K9 Group SDA tHD:STA tBUF tLOW SCL tR tF S p tsu:STO Sr tHD:STA tHD:DTA tHIGH tsu:DAT p tsu:STA Fig.ZA-3 Timing diagram (2) PS/2 interface timing diagram In receiving tWH tWL 0.8VCC 0.8VCC CLK 0.2VCC 0.2VCC th tsu DATA 0.8VCC 0.8VCC 0.2VCC 0.2VCC In transmitting tWL tWH 0.8VCC CLK 0.2VCC td DATA Fig.ZA-4 Timing diagram (3) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 257 of 290 0.2VCC 0.8VCC 0.2VCC tv 0.8VCC 0.8VCC 0.2VCC 0.2VCC M16C/6K9 Group Timing LPC bus interface/serial interrupt output timing tC(CLK) tWH(CLK) LCLK tWL(CLK) VIH VIL tsu(D-C) LAD[3:0] SERIRQ,CLKRUN,LFRAME (Input) tv(C-D) LAD[3:0] SERIRQ,CLKRUN,LFRAME (Active output) toff(A-F) LAD[3:0] SERIRQ,CLKRUN,LFRAME (Floating output ) Fig.ZA-5 Timing diagram (4) Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 258 of 290 th(C-D) Flash memory version M16C/6K9 Group Feature Outline Table AB-1 shows the feature outline of M16C/6K9 (build-in NEW DINOR flash memory version). Table.AB-1 Feature outline of M16C/6K9 (build-in NEW DINOR flash memory version) Item Feature Power supply voltage Power supply voltage for program/erase 3.0-3.6V (f(XIN)=16MHz, 0 wait) 3.0-3.6V (CPU reprogram mode, f(XIN)=8MHz with 0 wait or 16MHz Flash memory operation mode with 1 wait) 3 modes (parallel I/O, standard serial I/O, CPU reprogram) Erase block division User ROM area Boot ROM area See Fig.AB-1 1 division (4K bytes) (Note1) Program method Erase method 2-byte unit Block erase Program/ erase control method Number of command Program/ erase controlled by s/w commands 5 commands Program/ erase count ROM code protect 100 times Support for parallel I/O and standard serial I/O modes Note1: The control program for standard serial I/O mode is stored in boot ROM area when shipping from factory. The area can only be erased or programmed by parallel I/O mode. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 259 of 290 Flash memory version M16C/6K9 Group Flash Memory The M16C/6K9 (build-in flash memory version) contains the NEW DINOR type flash memory, which is applied 2 power supplies VCC=3.3V when using CPU reprogram or standard serial I/O mode. For the flash memory, 3 flash memory modes are available in which to read, program and erase. They are parallel I/O mode, standard serial I/O mode and CPU reprogram mode. For parallel I/O mode, a programmer is used. For standard serial I/O and CPU reprogram modes, the flash memory is manipulated by CPU. Each mode is detailed in the pages to follow. Fig. AB-1 shows that flash memory is divided into several blocks. Erasing is in block unit. In addition to the ordinary user ROM area there is a boot ROM area to store the control program for the CPU reprogram and standard serial I/O modes. The control program for standard serial I/O mode is stored in boot ROM area when shipping from factory. User can reprogram the program to suit its own application system. The area can only be erased or programmed by parallel I/O mode. 0E000016 Chip name The start address of the flash memory M306K9FCL 0E000016 Block 3 : 32K bytes M306K9F8L 0F000016 Block 6 : 64K bytes 0F000016 Block 5 : 32K bytes 0F800016 Block 4 : 8K bytes 0FA00016 Block 3 : 8K bytes 0FC00016 0FE00016 0FF00016 0FFFFF16 Block 2 : 8K bytes 0FF00016 0FFFFF16 4K bytes Boot block area Block 1 : 4K bytes Block 0 : 4K bytes User block area Note 1: Boot ROM area can be reprogrammed only in parallel I/O mode. (Access to any other areas is inhibited.) Note 2: To specify a block, use the maximum even address in the block. Fig.AB-1 Block diagram of flash memory version Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 260 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group CPU Reprogram Mode CPU reprogram mode In CPU reprogram mode, the on-chip flash memory can be operated on (read, program or erase) under the control of CPU. In CPU reprogram mode, only the user ROM area shown in Fig.AB-1 can be reprogrammed. The boot ROM area cannot be reprogrammed. Make sure the program and block erase commands are issued only for each block of the user ROM area. The control program for CPU reprogram mode can be stored in either user ROM or boot ROM area. In CPU reprogram mode, because the flash memory cannot be read form CPU, the control program must be transferred to the RAM area before execution. Microcomputer mode and Boot mode The control program for CPU reprogram mode must be written into the user ROM or boot ROM area in parallel I/O mode beforehand. (If the control program is written into the boot ROM area, the standard serial I/ O mode becomes disable.) See Fig.AB-1 for details about the boot ROM area. Normal microcomputer mode is entered when reset with pulling “L” of M0. In this case, the CPU starts operating the control program in user ROM area. If the microcomputer is reset with M0 being “H” and M1 being “L”, the CPU starts operating the control program in boot ROM area. This mode is called as “boot” mode. Block address Block address refers to the maximum even address of each block. The address is used in block erase command. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 261 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group CPU Reprogram Mode Feature Outline (CPU reprogram mode) In CPU reprogram mode, the CPU erases, programs and reads the on-chip flash memory as instructed by S/W commands. The reprogram control program must be transferred to the RAM area before it can be executed. The CPU reprogram mode is accessed by writing “1” to the CPU reprogram select bit (bit 1 in address 03B716). S/W commands are accepted once the mode is accessed. In CPU reprogram mode, the writing and reading of the commands and data should be in even address (“0” for byte address A0) in 16-bit unit, so the 8-bit unit S/W commands should be written in even address. Commands are ignored with odd address. Use S/W commands to control flash memory programming and erasing. Whether the programming and erasing operation terminates correctly or in error can be verified by reading the status register. Fig.BB-1 shows the flash control register. _____ Bit 0 is the RY/BY status flag exclusively used to read the operating status of the flash memory. During programming and erasing operation, it is “0”, otherwise it is “1”. Bit 1 is the CPU reprogram mode select bit. When the bit is set to “1”, CPU reprogram mode is entered S/W commands then can be accessed. In CPU reprogram mode, the CPU cannot access the on-chip flash memory directly. Therefore, use the control program in RAM to write the bit to “1”. To set the bit, it is necessary to write “0” and then write “1” in succession. The bit can be cleared to “0” by only writing the “0”. Bit 3 is the flash memory reset bit used to reset the control circuit of the on-chip flash memory. The bit is used when exiting the CPU reprogram mode and when flash memory access has failed. When the CPU reprogram mode select bit is “1”, writing “1” to the bit resets the control circuit. To release the reset, it is necessary to set the bit to “0”. If the control circuit is reset while erasing is in progress, the wait for 5 ms is needed so that the flash memory can restore to the normal operation. Bit 5 of the flash control register 0 is the user ROM select bit. It is enabled only in boot mode. When the bit is set to “1”, the accessed area is switched from boot ROM to user ROM. When CPU reprogram mode is entered in boot mode, please set this bit to “1”. The bit is disabled when program starts in user ROM. Please write the bit with the program that is not located in on-chip flash memory area. Fig.BB-2 shows a flowchart for the setting/ releasing the CPU reprogram mode. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 262 of 290 CPU Reprogram Mode M16C/6K9 Group Flash memory control register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol Address When reset FMR 03B716 XX0000012 0 Bit name Bit symbol Function FMR0 RY/BY signal status bit 0: Busy (be written and erased) 1: Ready FMR1 CPU reprogram mode select bit (Note 1) 0: Normal mode 1: CPU reprogram mode Reserved bit FMR3 Must be “0”. Flash memory reset bit (Note 2) 0: Normal operation 1: Reset Reserved bit FMR5 Must be “0”. User ROM area select bit 0: Access to boot ROM area (Note 3) (Only enabled in boot mode) 1: Access to user ROM area Nothing is assigned. When write, set “0”. When read, value is indeterminate. A AA A A A AA A AA A A AA R WW R Note 1: To write “1” to the bit, it is necessary to write “0” and “1” in succession. Otherwise the bit will not be “1”. Please do not enter interrupt and DMA. Note 2: It is enabled only CPU reprogram mode select bit is “1”. After setting to “1”(reset), please write “0” in succession. Note 3: Please write this bit with program that is not located in on-chip flash memory area. Flash memory identification register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address When reset FTR 03B416 XXXXXX102 Function The value after reset XXXXXX102 : M16C/6K9 Group 000000002 XXXX00012 : M16C/6K7 Group : M16C/6K5 Group (Note) A R W Note: Address 03B416 of M16C/6K5 Group is the flash memory control register. Fig.BB-1 The structure of flash memory control register and flash memory identification register Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 263 of 290 CPU Reprogram Mode M16C/6K9 Group Program located in ROM Program located in RAM Start *1 Single-chip mode or boot mode (Only for boot mode) Set user ROM area select bit to "1" Set processor mode register (Note 1) Set CPU reprogram mode select bit="1" (write "0" and then write "1") (Note 2) Transfer CPU reprogram mode control program to RAM area Jump to the program that is transferred to RAM (the operation hereafter is on RAM) Operate with S/W commands to erase and program. Reset with read array command or the setting of the flash memory reset bit (write "1" and then write "0") (Note 3) *1 Write "0" to CPU reprogram mode select bit. (Only for boot mode) Write user ROM area select bit to "0". (Note 4) End Note 1: Set the main clock frequency as shown below using the main clock divide ratio select bits (bit 6 at address 000616 and bit 6 and 7 at address 000716): (1) Not exceeding 8 MHz if wait bit (bit 7 of address 000516) = "0". (No wait for internal accessing) (2) Not exceeding 16 MHz if wait bit (bit 7 of address 000516) = "1". (1 wait for internal accessing) Note 2: For writing "1" to the bit, it is necessary to write "0" and "1" in succession. Otherwise the bit will not be "1". Please do not enter interrupt and DAM. The write to the bit should be executed other than the flash memory area and the NMI pin should be in "H" state. Note 3: Be sure to execute a read command or to set flash memory reset bit before exiting the CPU reprogram mode after completing erasing or programming operation. Note 4: The bit can remain "1" too. If it is "1", user ROM area will be accessed. Fig.BB-2 CPU reprogram mode set/reset flowchart Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 264 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group CPU Reprogram Mode Precautions on CPU reprogram mode Described below are the precautions to be observed in programming the flash memory in CPU reprogram mode. (1) Operation speed During CPU reprogram mode, set the main clock frequency as shown below using the main clock divide ratio select bits (bit 6 at address 000616 and bit 6 and 7 at address 000716): Not exceeding 8MHz if wait bit (bit 7 of address 000516) = “0”. (No wait for internal accessing) Not exceeding 16MHz if wait bit (bit 7 of address 000516) = “1”. (1 wait for internal accessing) (2) Instructions inhibited against use The instructions listed below cannot be used during CPU reprogram mode because they refer to the internal data of the flash memory: UND instruction, INTO instruction, JMPS instruction, JSRS instruction and BRK instruction (3) Interrupts inhibited against use _______ The NMI, address match and WDC interrupts cannot be used during CPU reprogram mode because they refer to the internal data of the flash memory. If interrupts have their vectors in the variable vector table, they can be used by transferring the vector into the RAM area. (4) Reset The reset is always receivable. (5) The reprogram in user ROM area When CPU reprogram mode is entered and the block that the flash reprogram control program is located is being reprogramming, the block may not be reprogrammed correctly if the power supply is suddenly down. It is possible that the flash reprogram cannot be executed again in this case. Thus, it is recommended to use standard serial I/O mode and parallel I/O mode. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 265 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group CPU Reprogram Mode Software commands Table BB-1 lists the S/W commands available. After setting the CPU reprogram mode select bit to “1”, the S/W commands can be used to specify the erasing or programming operation. Note that when entering a S/W command, the upper byte (D15–D8) is ignored. The content of each S/W command is explained below. Table BB-1 List of software commands (CPU reprogram mode) The 1st bus cycle Cycle Command Data Mode Address number (D15–D0) Read array 1 Write X (Note 5) FF16 Read status register 2 Write X 7016 Clear status register 1 Write X 5016 Program 2 Write X 4016 Block erase 2 Write X 2016 The 2nd bus cycle Data Mode Address (D15–D0) Read X SRD(Note 2) Write Write WA(Note 3) BA(Note 4) WD(Note 3) D016 Note 1: When a S/W command is input, the high-order byte of the data(D15–D8) is ignored. Note 2: SRD = Status Register Data. The address should be even and within the user ROM area. Note 3: WA = Write Address, WD = Write Data Note 4: BA = Block Address (the maximum even address of the block) Note 5: “X” can be any even address in user ROM area. Read Array Command (FF16) Issuing the command code “FF16” in the 1st bus cycle enters the read array mode. When an even address is issued in one of the bus cycle that follows, the content of the address is read out at the data bus (D15–D0), 16 bits at a time. The read array mode is retained intact until another command is written. Read Status Register Command (7016) When the command code “7016” is issued in the 1st bus cycle, the content of the status register is read out at the data bus (D7–D0) by a read in the 2nd bus cycle. The status register is explained in the next section. Clear Status Register Command (5016) The command is used to clear the bits SR4 and SR5 of the status register after they have been set. These bits indicate that operation has ended in error. To use this command, issue the command code “5016” in the 1st bus cycle. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 266 of 290 CPU Reprogram Mode M16C/6K9 Group Program Command (4016) Program operation starts when the command code “4016” is issued in the 1st bus cycle. If the address and data are issued in the 2nd bus cycle, program operation (data programming and verification) will start. _____ Whether the program operation is completed can be conformed by reading the status register or the RY/BY status flag. When the program starts, the read status register mode is accessed automatically and the content of the status register can be read on the date bus (D7–D0). The status register bit 7 (SR7) is set to “0” at the same time when the program operation starts and is returned to “1” upon the completion of the program operation. In this case, the read status register mode remains active until the Read Array Command (FF16) is issued. _____ The RY/BY status flag is “0” during program operation and “1” when the program operation is completed same as the status register bit 7. After the program, reading the status register can check the result. Refer to the section where the status register is detailed. Start Write 4016 Write Write address Write data (The address for reading the status register should be even and within the user ROM area.) Status register read SR7=1? or RY/BY=1? NO YES NO SR4=0? YES Program completed Fig.BB-3 Program flowchart Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 267 of 290 Program error M16C/6K9 Group CPU Reprogram Mode Block Erase Command (2016/D016) By issuing the command code “2016” in the 1st bus cycle and the conformation command code “D016” and block address in the 2nd bus cycle, the erase operation specified by the block address starts (erase and erase verification). _____ Whether the block erase command is terminated can be conformed by reading the status register or the RY/BY status flag. When the block erase operation starts, the read status register mode is accessed automatically and the content of the status register can be read out. The status register bit 7 (SR7) is set to “0” at the same time when the erase operation starts and is returned to “1” upon the completion of the erase operation. In this case, the read status register mode remains active until the Read Array Command (FF16) is written. _____ The RY/BY status flag is “0” during erase operation and “1” when the erase operation is completed the same as the bit 7 of status register. After the block erase, reading the status register can check the result. Refer to the section where the status register is detailed. Start Write 2016 Write D016 Block address (The address for reading the status register should be even and within the user ROM area.) Status register read SR7=1? or RY/BY=1? NO YES Full status check (Note 1) Erase completed Note 1: Refer to Fig. BB-5. Fig.BB-4 Erase flowchart Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 268 of 290 Error Erase error M16C/6K9 Group CPU Reprogram Mode Status register The status register shows the operation status of the flash memory and whether program and erase operations end successfully or not. It can be read in the following conditions. (1) By reading an arbitrary address from the user ROM area after issuing the read status register command (7016) (2) By reading an arbitrary address from the user ROM area in the period from the start of program or erase operation to the execution of read array command (FF16). Table BB-2 shows the status register. The status register can be cleared in the following condition. (1) By issuing the clear status register command (5016). (2) After reset, the status register is set to “8016”. Each bit of the register is shows below. Sequencer status (SR7) After power-on, the sequencer status is set to “1” (ready). The bit is set to “0” (busy) during program and erase operations and is set to “1” upon the completion of these operations. Erase status (SR5) Erase status indicates the status of erase operation. When erase error occurs, it is set to “1”. The bit becomes “0” when it is cleared. Program status (SR4) Program status indicates the status of program operation. When program error occurs, it is set to “1”. The bit becomes “0” when it is cleared. If “1” is set to SR5 or SR4, the program and block erase operations are not accepted. Before execution of these commands, it is necessary to execute the clear status register command (5016) to clear the status register. If any S/W commands are not correct, both the SR5 and SR4 are set to “1”. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 269 of 290 CPU Reprogram Mode M16C/6K9 Group Table BB-2 Definition of each bit of status register Each bit of SRD Status name Definition "1" "0" Ready Busy - - SR7 (bit7) Sequencer status SR6 (bit6) Reserved SR5 (bit5) Erase status Terminated in error Terminated normally SR4 (bit4) Program status Terminated in error Terminated normally SR3 (bit3) Reserved - - SR2 (bit2) Reserved - - SR1 (bit1) Reserved - - SR0 (bit0) Reserved - - Full status check By performing full status check, the execution result of erase and program operations can be known. Fig.BB-5 shows the full status check flowchart and the method to deal with the error. Read status register SR4=1 and SR5=1? YES Command sequence error NO SR5=0? NO Execute the clear status register command (5016) to clear the status register. Try to perform the operation again after conforming that the command is entered correctly. Block erase error Should block erase error occur, the block cannot be used. Program error Should program error occur, the block cannot be used. YES SR4=0? NO YES End (block erase, program) Note: When SR5 or SR4 is set to “1”, neither of the program nor block erase commands are accepted. Execute the clear status register command (5016) before executing these commands. Fig.BB-5 Full status check flowchart and the method to deal with errors Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 270 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Functions To Inhibit Rewriting Flash Memory Functions to inhibit rewriting to the on-chip flash memory To prevent flash memory from being miss-read or miss-written, ROM code protect function for parallel I/O mode and ID code check function for standard serial mode are introduced. ROM code protect function ROM code protect function can inhibit readout from or modification to the flash memory by setting the content in ROM code protect control address (0FFFFF16) for parallel I/O mode. Fig.BB-6 shows the content of ROM code protect control address (0FFFFF16). (The address exists in user ROM area.) If one of the pair of ROM code protect bits is set to “0”, ROM code protect is turned on, so that the flash memory is protected against the readout or modification. ROM code protect is implemented in two levels. If level 2 is selected, the flash memory is protected even against readout by a shipment inspection LSI tester, etc. When both level 1 and level 2 are set, level 2 will be selected. If both of the two ROM code protect reset bits are set to “00”, ROM code protect is turned off, so that the flash memory can be read out or modified. Once ROM code protect is turned on, the ROM code protect reset bits cannot be modified in parallel I/O mode. Use the serial mode or other to rewrite these two bits. ROM code protect control address b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address When reset 1 1 ROMCP 0FFFFF16 FF16 Bit name Bit symbol Reserved bits Function Always set these bits to “1” b3 b2 ROMCP2 ROM code protect level 2 set bits (Note 1,2) 0 0: Protect enabled 0 1: Protect enabled 1 0: Protect enabled 1 1: Protect disabled b5 b4 ROMCR 0 0: Protect removed ROM code protect reset 0 1: Protect set bits effective bits (Note 3) 1 0: Protect set bits effective 1 1: Protect set bits effective b7 b6 0 0: Protect enabled ROMCP1 ROM code protect level 0 1: Protect enabled 1 0: Protect enabled 1 set bits (Note 1) 1 1: Protect disabled Note 1: When ROM code protect is turned on, the on-chip flash memory is protected against readout or modification in parallel I/O mode. Note 2: When ROM code protect level 2 is turned on, ROM code readout by a shipment inspection LSI tester,etc. is also inhibited. Note 3: The ROM code protect reset bits can be used to turn off ROM code protect level 1 and level 2. However,Since these bits can not be modified in parallel I/O mode, they should be rewritten in serial I/O mode or other modes. Fig.BB-6 ROM code protect control address Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 271 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Functions To Inhibit Rewriting Flash Memory ID code check function The function is used in standard serial I/O mode. If the flash memory is not blank, the ID code sent from serial burner is compared with that inside flash memory to check the agreement. It the ID codes do not match, the commands from serial burner are not accepted. Each ID code consists of 8-bit data, the areas of which, beginning from the 1 st byte, are 0FFFDF16, 0FFFE316, 0FFFEB16, 0FFFEF16, 0FFFF316, 0FFFF716, 0FFFFB16. Write a program with the ID code at these addresses to the flash memory. Address 0FFFDC16 to 0FFFDF16 ID1 Undefined instruction vector 0FFFE016 to 0FFFE316 ID2 Overflow vector 0FFFE416 to 0FFFE716 BRK instruction vector 0FFFE816 to 0FFFEB16 ID3 Address match vector 0FFFEC16 to 0FFFEF16 ID4 Single step vector 0FFFF016 to 0FFFF316 ID5 Watchdog timer vector 0FFFF416 to 0FFFF716 ID6 DBC vector 0FFFF816 to 0FFFFB16 ID7 NMI vector 0FFFFC16 to 0FFFFF16 Reset vector 4 bytes Fig.BB-7 ROM ID code addresses Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 272 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Parallel I/O Mode Parallel I/O mode Parallel I/O mode is to input and output the software command, address and data in parallel to access the on-chip flash memory (read, program, erase etc.). Please use the specific device (programmer) supported for M16C/6K9 Group. Referring to the guideline etc. of each device manufacture for the usage. User ROM area and boot ROM area In parallel I/O mode, both user ROM area and boot ROM area showed in Fig.AB-1 can be reprogrammed. The access method to both areas is the same. The size of boot ROM area is 4K bytes. The addresses are allocated in 0FF00016– 0FFFFF16. Make sure program and block erase operations are always performed within this address range. (Access to any location outside this address range is prohibited.) In the boot ROM area, erase block operation is applied to only one 4K bytes block. The boot ROM area has had a standard serial I/O mode control program stored in it when shipped from Renesas factory. Therefore, if the standard serial I/O mode is used, the rewriting to the boot ROM area is not necessary. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 273 of 290 Standard Serial I/O Mode M16C/6K9 Group Table EE-1 Pin function (Flash memory standard serial I/O mode) Pin name Name I/O VCC, VSS Power supply Apply 3.3 ± 0.3V to VCC, apply 0V to VSS M0 M0 I Connect to VCC ____________ RESET Reset input I Reset input pin. While reset is "L", 20 cycles or more clocks input to XIN pin are needed. XIN Clock input I Connect a ceramic resonator or crystal oscillator XOUT Clock output O between XIN and XOUT. If external clock is used, input it to XIN pin and open the XOUT pin. M1 M1 I Connect to VSS FVCC Power supply input Apply 3.0V to 3.6V for flash program AVCC, AVSS Analog power supply Connect AVSS to VSS, AVCC to VCC VREF Reference voltage I The input pin of reference voltage of AD converter P00–P07 P10–P17 P20–P27 P30–P37 P40–P47 P50–P57 P60–P63 P64 P65 P66 P67 P70–P77 P80–P84 P86,P87 P85 P90–P97 P100–P107 Input port P0 Input port P1 Input port P2 Input port P3 Input port P4 Input port P5 Input port P6 BUSY output SCLK input RXD input TXD input Input port P7 Input port P8 P110–P117 P120–P127 P130–P137 P140–P147 P150–P157 P160,P161 Rev.1.00 I I I I I I I O I I O I I Input "H", "L" or open Input "H", "L" or open Input "H", "L" or open Input "H", "L" or open Input "H", "L" or open Input "H", "L" or open Input "H", "L" or open The output pin of BUSY signal The input pin of serial clock The input pin if serial data The output pin of serial data Input "H", "L" or open Input "H", "L" or open NMI input Input port P9 Input port P10 I I I Connect to VCC The input pin of serial data The input pin of serial data Input port P11 Input port P12 Input port P13 Input port P14 Input port P15 Input port P16 I I I I I I The input pin of serial data The input pin of serial data The input pin of serial data The input pin of serial data The input pin of serial data The input pin of serial data ______ Jun 06, 2003 page 274 of 290 Standard Serial I/O Mode 79 78 77 76 75 74 73 71 70 69 68 67 66 111 112 113 114 115 116 117 118 119 120 121 122 123 M306K9FCLRP M306K9F8LRP (144PFB) 124 125 126 127 128 129 130 131 132 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 133 48 134 135 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 136 137 138 139 140 141 142 40 39 38 37 143 144 6 7 8 P42/TA20OUT/GATEA20 P43/OBF01 P44/PWM01/OBF1 P45/PWM11/OBF2 P46/PWM21/OBF3 FVCC P47/PWM31 VSS P140/KI10 P141/KI11 P142/KI12 P143/KI13 P144/KI14 P145/KI15 P146/KI16 P147/KI17 P50/KI00 P51/KI01 P52/KI02 P53/KI03 P54/KI04 P55/KI05 P56/KI06 P57 /CLKOUT/KI07 P150 /TA01OUT P151 /TA11OUT P152 /TA21OUT P60/CTS00/RTS00/SDA0 P61/CLK00/SCL0 P62/RXD00/SDA1 P63/TXD00/SCL1 P64/CTS10/RTS10 /CTS00/CLKS10 P65/CLK10 P66/RXD10/TA3OUT P67/TXD10/TA4OUT P70/TXD20/PS2A0 FVCC BUSY RXD 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 RESET M1 M0 P96/ANEX1/SOUT40/PWM30 P95/ANEX0/CLK40/PWM20 P94/DA1/TB40IN/PWM10 P93/DA0/TB30IN/PWM00 2 3 4 5 Fig.EE-1 Pin connections for serial I/O mode Jun 06, 2003 82 81 80 72 110 1 Rev.1.00 84 83 109 VSS P92/SOUT30/INT5 P91/SIN30/INT4 P90/CLK30/INT3 P161/TB41IN/PWM50 P160/TB31IN/PWM40 P157/SIN41 P156/SOUT41 P155/CLK41 P154 P153 M1 M0 P87/XCIN P86/XCOUT RESET XOUT VSS XIN VCC P85/NMI P84/TB2IN P83/TB1IN P82/TB0IN P81/TA4IN P80/ICCK P77/TA3IN/SCL2 P76/SDA2 P75/TA2IN/INT2/PS2B2 P74/INT1/PS2B1 P73/CTS20/RTS20/TA1IN/INT0/PS2B0 P72/CLK20/PS2A2 P71/RXD20/TA0IN/TB5IN/PS2A1 P10/CTS01/RTS01 P126 P125/INT111 P124/INT102 P123/INT92 P122/INT82 P121/INT72 P120/INT61 P07 P06 P05 P04 P03 P02 P01 P00 P117 P116 P115 P114 P113 P112 P111/F1OUT1 P110/F1OUT0 P107/AN7/INT110 P106/AN6/INT100 P105/AN5/INT90 P104/AN4/INT80 P103/AN3/INT70 P102/AN2 P101/AN1 AVSS P100/AN0 VREF AVcc P97/ADTRG/SIN40/INT60 98 97 96 95 94 93 92 91 90 89 88 87 86 85 108 107 106 105 104 103 102 101 100 99 P11/CLK01 P12/RXD01 P13/TXD01 P14/INT71/CTS11/RTS11/CTS01/CLKS11 P15/INT81/CLK11 P16/INT91/RXD11 P17/INT101/TXD11 P20/TXD21 P21/RXD21 P22/CLK21 P23/CTS21/RTS21 P24 P25 P26 P27 VSS P30/LAD0 VCC P127 P31/LAD1 P32/LAD2 P33/LAD3 P34/LFRAME P35/LRESET P36/LCLK P37 P130 P131 P132 P133 P134 P135 P136 P137 P40/ TA00OUT/OBF00/PWM41 P41/TA10OUT/PWM51 M16C/6K9 Group page 275 of 290 Connect to oscillation circuit VCC Mode setting method Name of signal line Value M0 VCC M1 VSS FVCC 3.0V to 3.6V RESET VSS → VCC SCLK TXD M16C/6K9 Group Standard Serial I/O Mode Standard serial I/O mode The standard serial I/O mode inputs and outputs the S/W commands, addresses and data needed to operate (read, program, erase etc.) the on-chip flash memory with a dedicated serial programmer. Different from parallel I/O mode, in standard serial mode, CPU controls the flash memory reprogramming (uses the CPU reprogram mode) and the input of serial reprogram data etc. The standard serial I/O mode is started by connecting M0 to “H”, M1 to “L” and applying 3.0V to 3.6V externally to FVCC with the release of reset. (To connect M0 to “L” in normal microcomputer mode.) This control program is written in boot ROM area when the product is shipped from Renesas factory. Make sure that the standard serial I/O mode cannot be used if boot ROM area is written in parallel I/O mode. Fig EE-1 shows the pin connections for standard serial I/O mode. The input and output of serial data are processed in CLK10, RxD10, TxD10, RTS10 (BUSY) 4 pins of the UART1. The CLK10 is clock input pin, which clock is input externally. The TxD10 is CMOS output pin. The RTS10 (BUSY) pin outputs “L” when ready for reception and outputs “H” when reception starts. The serial data are transferred in 8-bit unit. In standard serial I/O mode, only the user ROM area shown in Fig.AB-1 can be reprogrammed. Boot ROM area cannot be reprogrammed. In the standard serial I/O mode, a 7-byte ID code is used. If the flash memory is not blank, commands sent from programmer are not accepted unless the ID code matches. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 276 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Standard Serial I/O Mode Outline (standard serial I/O mode) In standard serial I/O mode, S/W commands, addresses, and data etc. are input and output with the peripheral device (serial programmer) using 4-wire clock-synchronized serial I/O (UART1). In reception, S/W commands, addresses and program data are read from RxD10 pin synchronized with the rising edge of the transfer clock that is input to the CLK10 pin. In transmission, the read data and status are output to TxD10 pin synchronized with the falling edge of the transfer clock. The TxD10 is CMOS output pin. Transfer is in 8-bit unit with LSB first. During transmission, reception, erasing and programming, the RTS10 (BUSY) pin is “H”. Accordingly, always start the next transfer after the RTS10 (BUSY) pin becomes “L”. The read after the input of S/W commands can get memory data and status register. Reading the status register can check the flash memory operation status, the normal/error end of erasing or programming operation. The following are the explanation of S/W commands, status register etc. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 277 of 290 Standard Serial I/O Mode M16C/6K9 Group S/W commands Table EE-2 lists the S/W commands. In standard serial I/O mode, the S/W commands, which transferred from RxD pin, control of erase, program and read etc. The S/W commands in standard serial I/O mode are similar with that in parallel I/O mode. ID check function, download function, version information output function, boot ROM area output function and read check data, 5 commands are added. Table EE-2 The list of S/W commands (standard serial I/O mode) 1 2 3 Control 1st byte command Page read transfer FF16 Address Address Data Data 4116 (middle) Address (high) Address output Data output Data (high) Address input D016 input input data input 2016 (middle) Address 7016 (middle) SRD (high) SRD1 output output Page program Block erase 2nd byte 3rd byte 4th byte 5th byte 6th byte – If ID Data 259th byte unmatched Not acceptable output Data data output 259th byte Not acceptable Not acceptable 4 Read 5 status register Clear 5016 6 status register ID check F516 Address Address Address ID size ID1 –ID7 Acceptable 7 function Download FA16 (low) Address (middle) Address (high) Check Data No. of –ID7 Not acceptable 8 function Version information FB16 (low) Version (high) Version sum Version input Version times required Version –9th byte Acceptable 9 output function Boot ROM area FC16 data output Address data output Address data output data output Data Data data output Data Version data output –259th byte Not acceptable (high) Check data output output data output FD16 (middle) Check data (low) (high) output function 10 Read check data Acceptable Not acceptable output Not acceptable Note 1: Shading indicates transfer from flash memory on chip microcomputer to serial programmer. The else indicates transfer from serial programmer to flash memory on chip microcomputer. Note 2: SRD means status register data. SRD1 means status register 1 data. Note 3: All commands are acceptable if the flash memory is blank. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 278 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Standard Serial I/O Mode The following are the descriptions of S/W commands Page read command The command reads the specified page (256 bytes) of the flash memory sequentially one byte at a time. Execute the page read command as following: (1) Transfer the “FF16” command code in the 1st byte. (2) Transfer addresses A8– A15 and A16– A23 in the 2nd and 3rd byte respectively. (3) From the 4th byte onward, data (D7–D0) of the page specified by the address (A23–A8) will be output sequentially from the smallest address sync with the falling edge of the clock. CLK10 RxD10 (M16C reception data) FF16 A8 to A15 A16 to A23 Data255 Data0 TxD10 (M16C transmit data) RTS10(BUSY) Fig.EE-2 Timing of page read Read status register command The command is for reading status information. When command code “7016” is sent in the 1st byte, the contents of status register (SRD) and status register 1 (SRD1) will be output in the 2nd and 3rd byte respectively sync with the falling edge of the clock. CLK10 RxD10 (M16C reception data) TxD10 (M16C transmit data) RTS10(BUSY) Fig.EE-3 Timing of read status register Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 279 of 290 7016 SRD output SRD1 output M16C/6K9 Group Standard Serial I/O Mode Clear status register command The command clears the bits (SR4–SR5), which are set when operation ended in error. When command code “5016” is sent in the 1st byte, the aforementioned bits are cleared. When the clear status register operation ends, the RTS10 (BUSY) signal changes from “H” to “L”. CLK10 RxD10 (M16C reception data) 5016 TxD10 (M16C transmit data) RTS10(BUSY) Fig.EE-4 Timing of clear status register Page program command The command programs the specified page (256 bytes) of flash memory sequentially one byte a time. Execute the command as follows: (1) Transfer the command code “4116” in the 1st byte. (2) Transfer addresses A15–A8 and A23–A16 in the 2nd and 3rd bytes respectively. (3) From the 4th byte onward, after inputting 256 bytes program data (A7–A0) from the smallest address of the specified page, the page program operation will be executed automatically. When the reception for the next 256 bytes is setup, the RTS10 (BUSY) signal changes from “H” to “L”. The result of the page program can be known by reading the status register. For more detail, see the section on the status register. CLK10 RxD10 (M16C reception data) TxD10 (M16C transmit data) RTS10(BUSY) Fig.EE-5 Timing of page program Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 280 of 290 4116 A8 to A15 A16 to A23 Data0 Data255 Standard Serial I/O Mode M16C/6K9 Group Block erase command The command erases the data in the specified block. Execute the command as follows: (1) Transfer the command code “2016” in the 1st byte. (2) Transfer addresses A15–A8 and A23–A16 in the 2nd and 3rd bytes respectively. (3) After transferring the verify command code“D016” in the 4th byte, the erase operation starts for the specified block of the flash memory. Issue the biggest address of th2e specified block to A23–A8. After the completion of block erase, the RTS10 (BUSY) signal changes from “H” to “L”. The result of the block erase can be know by reading the status register. For more detail, see the section on the status register. CLK10 RxD10 (M16C reception data) TxD10 (M16C transmit data) RTS10(BUSY) Fig.EE-6 Timing of block erase Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 281 of 290 2016 A8 to A15 A16 to A23 D016 Standard Serial I/O Mode M16C/6K9 Group Download function The command downloads an execution program to RAM. Execute the command as follows: (1) Transfer the command code “FA16” in the 1st byte. (2) Transfer the program size in the 2nd and 3rd bytes. (3) Transfer the checksum in the 4th byte. Check sum is calculated from all transferred data from the 5th byte onward. (4) The execution program is transferred from 5th byte onward. After the entire program data have been transferred, the downloaded execution program will be executed if the checksum matches. The program size allowed to transfer varies according to the size of on-chip RAM. CLK10 RxD10 (M16C reception data) FA16 TxD10 (M16C transmit data) RTS10(BUSY) Fig.EE-7 Timing of download function Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 282 of 290 Data size Data size (low) (high) Check sum Program data Program data Standard Serial I/O Mode M16C/6K9 Group Version information output function The version information of the control program stored in boot ROM area can be output by the function. Execute the command as follows: (1) Transfer the command code “FB16” in the 1st byte. (2) From the 2nd byte onward, the version information will be output. The information is composed of 8 ASCII character code. CLK10 RxD10 (M16C reception data) FB16 TxD10 (M16C transmit data) 'V' 'E' 'R' 'X' RTS10(BUSY) Fig.EE-8 Timing of version information output function Boot ROM area output function The control program stored in boot ROM area can be read out in page (256 bytes) unit by the function. Execute the command as follows: (1) Transfer the command code “FC16” in the 1st byte. (2) Transfer addresses A15–A8 and A23–A16 in the 2nd and 3rd bytes respectively. From the 4th byte onward, the data (D7–D0) specified in page (256 bytes) address A23–A8 will be output sequentially from the smallest address in sync with the rising edge of the clock. CLK10 RxD10 (M16C reception data) FC16 A8 to A15 A16 to A23 TxD10 (M16C transmit data) RTS10(BUSY) Fig.EE-9 Timing og boot ROM area output function Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 283 of 290 Data0 Data255 Standard Serial I/O Mode M16C/6K9 Group ID check function The command checks the ID code. Execute the command as follows: (1) Transfer the command code “F516” in the 1st byte. (2) Transfer addresses A 7–A0, A15–A8 and A23–A16 of 1st ID code (ID1) in the 2nd, 3rd and 4th bytes respectively. (3) Transfer the number of the ID code in the 5th byte. (4) From the 6th byte onward, transfer the IDs from the 1st ID code (ID1). CLK10 RxD10 (M16C reception data) F516 DF16 FF16 0F16 IDsize ID1 ID7 TxD10 (M16C transmit data) RTS10(BUSY) Fig.EE-10 Timing of ID check function ID code If the flash memory is not blank, the input ID codes are compared with that written in flash memory. If they do not match, the input commands will not be accepted. Each ID code contains 8 bits data. Beginning from the 1st ID byte, the address of each ID code is 0FFFDF16, 0FFFE316, 0FFFEB16, 0FFFEF16, 0FFFF316, 0FFFF716 and 0FFFFB16 respectively. Write the program with the ID codes in these addresses to the flash memory. Address 0FFFDC16 to 0FFFDF16 ID1 Undefined instruction vector 0FFFE016 to 0FFFE316 ID2 Overflow vector 0FFFE416 to 0FFFE716 BRK instruction vector 0FFFE816 to 0FFFEB16 ID3 Address match vector 0FFFEC16 to 0FFFEF16 ID4 Single step vector 0FFFF016 to 0FFFF316 ID5 Watchdog timer vector 0FFFF416 to 0FFFF716 ID6 DBC vector 0FFFF816 to 0FFFFB16 ID7 NMI vector 0FFFFC16 to 0FFFFF16 Reset vector 4 bytes Fig.EE-11 ID code addressed Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 284 of 290 M16C/6K9 Group Standard Serial I/O Mode Read check data Read check date command is for conforming if the reprogram data sent after page program command have been received correctly. (1) Transfer the command code “FD16” in the 1st byte. (2) Transfer check data (low) and check data (high) in the 2nd and 3rd bytes respectively. When using read check data command, the command should be issued at first to initialize the check data. The next is to issue the page program command and related reprogram data. After that, by issuing the read check data command again, the check data for the reprogram data issued between the two read check data command can be read out. Adding the reprogram data in byte unit and then calculating the lower 2 bytes of the added data in two's complement gives out the check data. CLK10 RxD10 (M16C reception data) TxD10 (M16C transmit data) RTS10(BUSY) Fig.EE-12 Timing of read check dt command Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 285 of 290 FD16 Check data (low) Check data (high) Standard Serial I/O Mode M16C/6K9 Group Status register Status register indicates if the operation to the flash memory ends successfully or in error. It can be read by issuing the read status register command (7016). The status register can be cleared by issuing the clear status register command (5016). Table EE-3 shows the definition of each bit of the register. After reset, status register outputs “8016”. Table EE-3 Status register (SRD) Definition Symbol Status "1" "0" Ready Busy - - SR7 (D7) Sequencer status SR6 (D6) Reserved SR5 (D5) Erase status Terminated in error Terminated normally SR4 (D4) Program status Terminated in error Terminated normally SR3 (D3) Reserved - - SR2 (D2) Reserved - - SR1 (D1) Reserved - - SR0 (D0) Reserved - - Sequencer status (SR7) After power-on, the sequencer status is set to “1” (ready). The bit is set to “0” (busy) during program and erase operations and is set to “1” upon the completion of these operations. Erase status (SR5) Erase status indicates the status of erase operation. When erase error occurs, it is set to “1”. The bit becomes “0” when it is cleared. Program status (SR4) Program status indicates the status of program operation. When program error occurs, it is set to “1”. The bit becomes “0” when it is cleared. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 286 of 290 Standard Serial I/O Mode M16C/6K9 Group Status register 1 (SRD1) Status register 1 indicates the status of serial communication, the result of ID codes comparison, the result of checksum comparison etc. It can be read after SDR by issuing the read status register command (7016). The register can be cleared by issuing the clear status register command (5016). Table EE-4 shows the definition of each bit of the register. After power on, status register 1 outputs “0016”. Table EE-4 Status register (SRD1) Definition Each bit of SRD Status name "1" "0" SR15 (bit7) Boot update completed bit SR14 (bit6) Reserved - - SR13 (bit5) Reserved - - SR12 (bit4) Check sum match bit Match SR11 (bit3) ID check completed bits 00 01 10 11 SR9 (bit1) Timeout of data reception Timeout SR8 (bit0) Reserved SR10 (bit2) Update completed Not update Mismatch Not verified Verified with mismatch Reserved Verified with match Normal operation - - Boot update completed bit (SR15) The flag indicates that if the control program has been downloaded to RAM with download function. Check sum match bit (SR12) The flag indicates if the check sum is matched when downloading the control program with download function. ID check completed bits (SR11, SR10) These bits indicate the result of ID checks. Some commands cannot be accepted without the ID checks. Timeout of data reception bit (SR9) The flag indicates if timeout occurs during data reception. If the bit is set to “1” during data reception, microcomputer will discard the received data and return to wait state. Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 287 of 290 Standard Serial I/O Mode M16C/6K9 Group Full status check By performing full status check, the execution result of erase and program operations can be known. Fig.EE13 shows the full status check flowchart and the method to deal with the error. Read status register SR4=1 ? and YES SR5=1 ? Command sequence error NO SR5=0? NO Execute the clear status register command (5016) to clear the status register. Try to perform the operation again after conforming that the commands is entered correctly. Block erase error Should block erase error occur, the block can not be used. Program error Should program error occur, the block can not be used. YES SR4=0? NO YES End (block erase, program) Note: When SR5 or SR4 is set to "1", neither of the program nor block erase commands are accepted. Execute the clear status register command (5016) before executing these commands. Fig.EE-13 Full status check flowchart and the method to deal with errors Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 288 of 290 Standard Serial I/O Mode M16C/6K9 Group Circuit applied for standard serial I/O mode (example) The figure below shows a circuit applied for standard serial I/O mode. The control pins bary by different programmer. Refer to programmer manual for the detail. Clock input CLK10 BUSY output RTS10(BUSY) Data input RXD10 Clock output TXD10 M16C/6K9 (NEW DINOR type flash memory) M0 M1 NMI The control pins and external circuitry vary by different programmer. Refer to programmer manual for the detail. Fig.EE-14 Example circuit applied for the standard serial I/O mode Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 page 289 of 290 Package M16C/6K9 Group Package MMP 144PFB-A Plastic 144pin 16 16mm body TQFP Weight(g) 0.62 JEDEC Code – Lead Material Cu Alloy MD ME e EIAJ Package Code TQFP144-P-1616-0.40 b2 HD D 144 109 I2 Recommended Mount Pad 1 108 36 A A1 A2 b c D E e HD HE L L1 Lp HE E Symbol 73 37 A 72 L1 F A3 y Rev.1.00 Jun 06, 2003 b x M page 290 of 290 L Detail F Lp c A1 A3 A2 e x y b2 I2 MD ME Dimension in Millimeters Min Nom Max – – 1.2 0.05 0.1 0.15 1.0 – – 0.13 0.18 0.23 0.105 0.125 0.175 15.9 16.0 16.1 15.9 16.0 16.1 0.4 – – 17.8 18.0 18.2 17.8 18.0 18.2 0.4 0.5 0.6 1.0 – – 0.45 0.6 0.75 – 0.25 – – – 0.07 0.08 – – 0 8 – 0.225 – – 1.0 – – – 16.4 – – 16.4 – M16C/6K9 Group Data Sheet REVISION HISTORY Rev. Date Description Summary Page 1.00 Jun. 6, 2003 – First edition issued (1/1) Sales Strategic Planning Div. Nippon Bldg., 2-6-2, Ohte-machi, Chiyoda-ku, Tokyo 100-0004, Japan Keep safety first in your circuit designs! 1. Renesas Technology Corporation puts the maximum effort into making semiconductor products better and more reliable, but there is always the possibility that trouble may occur with them. Trouble with semiconductors may lead to personal injury, fire or property damage. Remember to give due consideration to safety when making your circuit designs, with appropriate measures such as (i) placement of substitutive, auxiliary circuits, (ii) use of nonflammable material or (iii) prevention against any malfunction or mishap. Notes regarding these materials 1. These materials are intended as a reference to assist our customers in the selection of the Renesas Technology Corporation product best suited to the customer’s application; they do not convey any license under any intellectual property rights, or any other rights, belonging to Renesas Technology Corporation or a third party. 2. Renesas Technology Corporation assumes no responsibility for any damage, or infringement of any third-party’s rights, originating in the use of any product data, diagrams, charts, programs, algorithms, or circuit application examples contained in these materials. 3. All information contained in these materials, including product data, diagrams, charts, programs and algorithms represents information on products at the time of publication of these materials, and are subject to change by Renesas Technology Corporation without notice due to product improvements or other reasons. It is therefore recommended that customers contact Renesas Technology Corporation or an authorized Renesas Technology Corporation product distributor for the latest product information before purchasing a product listed herein. The information described here may contain technical inaccuracies or typographical errors. Renesas Technology Corporation assumes no responsibility for any damage, liability, or other loss rising from these inaccuracies or errors. Please also pay attention to information published by Renesas Technology Corporation by various means, including the Renesas Technology Corporation Semiconductor home page (http://www.renesas.com). 4. When using any or all of the information contained in these materials, including product data, diagrams, charts, programs, and algorithms, please be sure to evaluate all information as a total system before making a final decision on the applicability of the information and products. Renesas Technology Corporation assumes no responsibility for any damage, liability or other loss resulting from the information contained herein. 5. Renesas Technology Corporation semiconductors are not designed or manufactured for use in a device or system that is used under circumstances in which human life is potentially at stake. Please contact Renesas Technology Corporation or an authorized Renesas Technology Corporation product distributor when considering the use of a product contained herein for any specific purposes, such as apparatus or systems for transportation, vehicular, medical, aerospace, nuclear, or undersea repeater use. 6. The prior written approval of Renesas Technology Corporation is necessary to reprint or reproduce in whole or in part these materials. 7. If these products or technologies are subject to the Japanese export control restrictions, they must be exported under a license from the Japanese government and cannot be imported into a country other than the approved destination. Any diversion or reexport contrary to the export control laws and regulations of Japan and/or the country of destination is prohibited. 8. Please contact Renesas Technology Corporation for further details on these materials or the products contained therein. http://www.renesas.com © 2002, 2003. Renesas Technology Corp., All rights reserved. Printed in Japan.